CA 7 Complete Commands
CA 7 Complete Commands
CA 7 Complete Commands
Commands Guide
3.3
This documentation and related computer software program (hereinafter referred to as the “Documentation”) is for
the end user's informational purposes only and is subject to change or withdrawal by Computer Associates Interna-
tional, Inc. (“CA”) at any time.
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, CA PROVIDES THIS DOCUMENTATION “AS IS”
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY IMPLIED WARRAN-
TIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR NONINFRINGEMENT. IN
NO EVENT WILL CA BE LIABLE TO THE END USER OR ANY THIRD PARTY FOR ANY LOSS OR
DAMAGE, DIRECT OR INDIRECT, FROM THE USE OF THIS DOCUMENTATION, INCLUDING WITHOUT
LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, GOODWILL, OR LOST DATA, EVEN IF CA IS
EXPRESSLY ADVISED OF SUCH LOSS OR DAMAGE.
THE USE OF ANY PRODUCT REFERENCED IN THIS DOCUMENTATION AND THIS DOCUMENTATION
IS GOVERNED BY THE END USER'S APPLICABLE LICENSE AGREEMENT.
Provided with “Restricted Rights” as set forth in 48 C.F.R. Section 12.212, 48 C.F.R. Sections 52.227-19(c)(1) and
(2) or DFARS Section 252.227.7013(c)(1)(ii) or applicable successor provisions.
All trademarks, trade names, service marks, or logos referenced herein belong to their respective companies.
Contents
Contents iii
2.3.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
2.4 /CHANGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
2.4.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
2.4.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2.4.3 Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
2.5 /CLOSE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
2.5.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
2.5.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
2.6 /COPY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
2.6.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
2.6.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
2.6.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
2.7 /DISPLAY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
2.7.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
2.7.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
2.8 /DMP1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.8.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.9 /DUMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
2.9.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
2.9.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
2.10 /ECHO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
2.10.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
2.10.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
2.11 /FETCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.11.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.12 /JCL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
2.12.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
2.13 /LOG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
2.13.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
2.13.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
2.13.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
2.14 /LOGOFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
2.14.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
2.15 /LOGON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
2.15.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
2.15.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
2.15.3 Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
2.16 /MSG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
2.16.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
2.16.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
2.16.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
2.17 /MVS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.17.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.17.2 Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.17.3 Special Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.18 /NXTMSG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
2.18.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
2.19 /OPEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
2.19.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
2.19.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
Contents v
2.34.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71
2.35 /UID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
2.35.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
2.35.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
2.36 /WLB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
2.36.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
2.37 /WTO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75
2.37.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75
2.37.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75
2.38 ADDRQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
2.38.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
2.38.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-77
2.38.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-77
2.39 ADDSCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78
2.39.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78
2.39.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-79
2.39.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-79
2.40 AL/ALC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-80
2.40.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-80
2.40.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-81
2.41 ALLOC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-82
2.41.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-82
2.41.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-82
2.42 APA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-83
2.42.1 APA Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-83
2.42.1.1 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-83
2.42.2 APA Prompt Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
2.42.2.1 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
2.42.2.2 Fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-85
2.43 ARFP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-88
2.43.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-88
2.43.2 Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-88
2.44 ARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-89
2.45 AR.3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-90
2.46 BLDG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-91
2.46.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-91
2.46.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-92
2.47 CALMOD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-93
2.47.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-93
2.48 CANCEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-94
2.48.1 Input Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-94
2.48.1.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-94
2.48.2 Request, Ready or Active Queue Jobs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-95
2.48.2.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-95
2.48.3 Output Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-96
2.48.3.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-96
2.48.3.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-97
2.48.3.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-97
2.49 CAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-98
2.49.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-98
Contents vii
2.62 FALL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-125
2.62.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-125
2.62.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-127
2.63 FIND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-129
2.63.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-129
2.63.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-130
2.64 FJOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-131
2.64.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-131
2.64.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-133
2.64.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-134
2.65 FLOWD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-137
2.65.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-137
2.65.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-137
2.66 FLOWL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-138
2.66.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-138
2.66.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-139
2.67 FPOST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-140
2.67.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-140
2.67.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-141
2.68 FPRE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-142
2.68.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-142
2.68.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-143
2.69 FQALL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-145
2.69.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-145
2.69.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-146
2.70 FQJOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-148
2.70.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-148
2.70.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-150
2.71 FQPOST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-151
2.71.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-151
2.71.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-152
2.72 FQPRE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-153
2.72.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-153
2.72.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-154
2.73 FQRES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-155
2.73.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-156
2.73.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-158
2.74 FQSTN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-159
2.74.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-159
2.74.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-160
2.75 FQTAPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-161
2.75.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-161
2.75.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-162
2.76 FRES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-163
2.76.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-163
2.76.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-165
2.77 FRJOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-169
2.77.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-169
2.77.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-170
2.77.3 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-171
Contents ix
2.90.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-226
2.91 LARF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-227
2.91.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-227
2.91.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-228
2.91.2.1 Example 1. Output: LARF With Generic ARFSET . . . . . . . . 2-228
2.91.2.2 Example 2. Output: LARF With Specific ARFSET . . . . . . . 2-230
2.92 LARFQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-233
2.92.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-233
2.92.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-234
2.93 LCTLG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-236
2.93.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-236
2.93.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-236
2.94 LDSN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-242
2.94.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-242
2.94.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-244
2.95 LDTM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-247
2.95.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-247
2.95.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-250
2.95.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-251
2.96 LIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-254
2.96.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-254
2.96.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-255
2.97 LISTDIR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-257
2.97.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-257
2.97.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-258
2.98 LJCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-259
2.98.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-259
2.99 LJCL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-262
2.99.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-262
2.99.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-263
2.100 LJES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-264
2.100.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-264
2.100.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-265
2.100.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-266
2.101 LJOB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-268
2.101.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-268
2.101.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-280
2.102 LJOBR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-288
2.102.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-288
2.102.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-288
2.102.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-288
2.103 LLIB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-290
2.103.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-290
2.103.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-291
2.104 LLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-292
2.104.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-292
2.104.2 Required Action for a Locked Job . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-294
2.104.3 Suspended Scheduling Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-294
2.104.4 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-295
2.105 LNTWK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-296
Contents xi
2.119.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-357
2.119.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-360
2.120 LREQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-361
2.120.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-361
2.120.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-365
2.121 LREQP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-368
2.121.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-368
2.121.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-369
2.122 LREQR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-370
2.122.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-370
2.122.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-373
2.123 LRES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-374
2.123.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-374
2.123.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-375
2.124 LRLOG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-376
2.124.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-376
2.124.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-382
2.125 LRMD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-385
2.125.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-385
2.125.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-387
2.126 LSCHD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-388
2.126.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-388
2.126.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-392
2.127 LSYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-396
2.127.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-396
2.127.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-397
2.128 LWLB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-399
2.128.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-399
2.128.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-400
2.129 MAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-403
2.129.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-403
2.129.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-404
2.129.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-404
2.130 MENU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-405
2.131 NOPRMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-406
2.131.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-406
2.131.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-407
2.131.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-407
2.132 NXTCYC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-408
2.132.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-408
2.132.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-409
2.132.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-409
2.133 OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-410
2.133.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-410
2.133.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-411
2.133.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-411
2.134 POST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-412
2.134.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-412
2.134.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-414
2.134.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-415
Contents xiii
2.147.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-447
2.147.2 QM.4-X CPU Job In Restart Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-448
2.147.2.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-448
2.148 QM.5 Queued JCL Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-451
2.148.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-452
2.149 QM.6 Input Networks Prompt Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-453
2.149.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-454
2.149.2 QM.6-X Input Networks (1-Up Display) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-455
2.149.2.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-455
2.149.2.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-457
2.149.3 QM.6-S Input Networks (2-Up Display) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-457
2.149.3.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-458
2.149.3.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-458
2.150 QM.7 Output Networks Prompt Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-459
2.150.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-460
2.150.2 QM.7-X Output Networks (1-Up Display) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-461
2.150.2.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-461
2.150.2.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-463
2.150.3 QM.7-S Output Networks (2-Up Display) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-464
2.150.3.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-464
2.150.3.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-465
2.151 RELEASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-466
2.151.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-466
2.151.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-467
2.151.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-467
2.152 REMIND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-468
2.152.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-468
2.152.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-469
2.152.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-469
2.153 RENAME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-470
2.153.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-470
2.153.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-470
2.154 REQUEUE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-471
2.154.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-471
2.154.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-473
2.154.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-473
2.155 RESANL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-474
2.155.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-474
2.156 RESCHNG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-476
2.156.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-476
2.156.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-476
2.156.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-477
2.157 RESOLV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-478
2.157.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-479
2.157.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-481
2.157.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-482
2.158 RESTART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-484
2.158.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-484
2.159 RM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-488
2.160 RQMT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-489
Contents xv
2.176 TRIG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-522
2.176.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-522
2.176.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-522
2.176.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-522
2.177 UNC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-523
2.177.1 Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-523
2.177.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-523
2.178 UT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-524
2.178.1 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-525
2.178.2 PF Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-525
2.179 UT.1 - Allocate/Catalog Dataset Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-526
2.179.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-526
2.179.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-528
2.180 UT.2 - Catalog Dataset Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-529
2.180.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-530
2.180.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-530
2.181 UT.3 - Rename Dataset Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-531
2.181.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-532
2.181.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-532
2.182 UT.4 - Scratch Dataset Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-533
2.182.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-534
2.182.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-534
2.183 UT.5 - Uncatalog Dataset Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-535
2.183.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-536
2.183.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-536
2.184 UT.6 - Build GDG Index Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-537
2.184.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-538
2.184.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-538
2.185 UT.7 - Delete Index Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-539
2.185.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-540
2.185.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-540
2.186 UT.8 - Connect a Catalog Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-541
2.186.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-542
2.186.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-542
2.187 UT.9 - Disconnect a Catalog Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-543
2.187.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-544
2.187.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-544
2.188 UT.10 - Find DSN on DASD Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-545
2.188.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-546
2.188.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-546
2.189 UT.11 - Allocate Volume Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-547
2.189.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-548
2.189.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-548
2.190 UT.12 - Deallocate Volume Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-549
2.190.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-550
2.190.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-550
2.191 UT.13 - Display Format 1 DSCB Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-551
2.191.1 Field Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-552
2.191.2 Usage Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-553
2.192 UT.14 - Display Directory Info Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-554
Contents xvii
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . X-1
The CA-7 Commands Guide is intended as a reference guide for production and oper-
ations personnel and for users with scheduling and operations responsibilities. This guide
describes general system commands, workstation network commands, workload balancing
commands, forecasting, general inquiry facilities, work flow control, online and interface
utilities.
Technical changes are identified by a revision bar (|) in the left margin. Revision bars
are not used for editorial changes and new manuals.
The formats of all statements and some basic language elements are illustrated using
syntax diagrams. Read syntax diagrams from left to right and top to bottom.
The following terminology, symbols, and concepts are used in syntax diagrams.
If punctuation marks or arithmetic symbols are shown with a keyword or variable, they
must be entered as part of the statement or command. Punctuation marks and arithmetic
symbols can include:
COMMAND
Required parameters appear on the same horizontal line (the main path of the diagram) as
the command or statement. The parameters must be separated by one or more blanks.
Where you see a vertical list of parameters as shown below, you must choose one of the
parameters. This indicates that one entry is required and only one of the displayed
parameters is allowed in the statement.
You can choose one of the parameters from the vertical list, such as in the examples
below:
COMMAND PARM1
COMMAND PARM2
COMMAND PARM3
A single optional parameter appears below the horizontal line that marks the main path.
When a required parameter in a syntax diagram has a default value, it indicates the value
for the parameter if the command is not specified. If you specify the command, you
must code the parameter and specify one of the displayed values.
If you specify the command, you must write one of the following:
Optional Parameter
──COMMAND──┬───────────┬────────────────────────────────────────
└─PARAMETER─┘
You can choose (or not) to use the optional parameter, as shown in the examples below:
COMMAND
COMMAND PARAMETER
If you have a choice of more than one optional parameter, the parameters appear in a
vertical list below the main path.
You can choose any of the parameters from the vertical list, or you can write the state-
ment without an optional parameter, such as in the examples below:
COMMAND
COMMAND PARM1
COMMAND PARM2
For some statements, you can specify a single parameter more than once. A repeat
symbol (a backward-pointing arrow above the main horizontal line) indicates that you can
specify multiple parameters. Below are examples which include the repeat symbol.
In the above example, the word “variable” is in lowercase italics, indicating that it is a
value you supply, but it is also on the main path, which means that you are required to
specify at least one entry. The repeat symbol indicates that you can specify a parameter
more than once. Assume that you have three values named VALUEX, VALUEY, and
VALUEZ for the variable. Some of your choices are:
COMMAND VALUEX
COMMAND VALUEX VALUEY
COMMAND VALUEX VALUEX VALUEZ
If the repeat symbol contains punctuation such as a comma, you must separate multiple
parameters with the punctuation. Below is an example which includes the repeat symbol,
a comma, and parentheses.
In the above example, the word “variable” is in lowercase italics, indicating that it is a
value you supply. It is also on the main path, which means that you must specify at least
one entry. The repeat symbol indicates that you can specify more than one variable and
that you must separate the entries with commas. The parentheses indicate that the group
of entries must be enclosed within parentheses. Assume that you have three values
named VALUEA, VALUEB, and VALUEC for the variable. Some of your choices are:
COMMAND (VALUEC)
COMMAND (VALUEB,VALUEC)
COMMAND (VALUEB,VALUEA)
COMMAND (VALUEA,VALUEB,VALUEC)
The following example shows a list of parameters with the repeat symbol.
COMMAND PARM1
COMMAND PARM1 PARM2 PARM3
COMMAND PARM1 PARM1 PARM3
When a parameter in a syntax diagram is above the line, for example, YES in the
diagram below, its special treatment indicates it is the default value for the parameter. If
you do not include the parameter when you write the statement, the result is the same as
if you had actually specified the parameter with the default value.
COMMAND PARM2
Choices you can make from this syntax diagram therefore include (but are not limited to)
the following:
COMMAND PARM1
COMMAND PARM3
COMMAND PARM3 PARM4
Note: Before you can specify PARM4 or PARM5 in this command, you must specify
PARM3.
A note in a syntax diagram is similar to a footnote except that the note appears at the
bottom of the diagram box.
──COMMAND──┬─────────┬──────────────────────────────────────────
(1)
└─PARM1─── ┘
Note:
1 This is a note about the item.
1.3 Commands
See Chapter 2, “Commands” for command syntax, optional parameters, command usage,
and screen examples for these commands.
You may restrict some of these commands to particular terminals or operators. Check
with the CA-7 coordinator within the data center for any command restrictions which
may exist.
General system commands are top line commands used by the CA-7 terminal operator to
perform various functions.
The general inquiry facility provides information about the system, its various compo-
nents and operations. Information available includes reference information on commands
and applications, database contents, queue information, job status, and schedule informa-
tion.
The general inquiry commands are also useful in batch mode to obtain hardcopy output
of the information provided.
Once a job has been scheduled from the CA-7 database, job flow control is accomplished
through a group of queues. Normally, job flow control is performed automatically by
CA-7; however, it is sometimes necessary for the user to manually intervene for unusual
situations or on-request scheduling needs.
This table illustrates the top line commands which address manual job flow control
requirements.
Workstation networks define tasks which you must perform manually (a non-CPU
activity). Although such tasks may be any manual tasks, they are normally performed in
support of CPU jobs. They may be performed either before or after the job is run.
These manual tasks are termed input or output networks. Each task in the network is
performed at what is known as a workstation. Each workstation must have its own
unique station name.
Each workstation may have its own terminal; or, multiple workstations may share a single
terminal. When networks are scheduled, either manually or automatically, CA-7 interacts
with personnel at the appropriate terminal(s) to ensure that manual workstation tasks are
performed in the correct sequence and at the proper time. Besides the CA-7 messages
used to accomplish this, inquiry commands are also available for further examining any
related data which may assist the user in performing the necessary tasks.
All terminal sessions are performed between /LOGON and /LOGOFF commands which
must be entered by the terminal user. During terminal sessions, any number of work-
station sessions may occur. Workstation sessions provide CA-7 with the beginning and
ending time-of-day for each task defined in a network. (The tasks must be performed in
the predefined sequence.)
Task beginning times are entered by logging into the station (as opposed to logging onto
a terminal) with a LOGIN, IN, or IO command or using one of these functions on a
QM.6 or QM.7 screen.
Task ending times are entered by logging out of the station (as opposed to logging off of
a terminal) with a LOGOUT, IO, or OUT command or using one of these functions on a
QM.6 or QM.7 screen.
As each terminal logs into the workstation, the work for that specific workstation is avail-
able for viewing. Messages for that workstation are also routed to the terminal.
1.8 Forecasting
Further, forecast displays the projected workload for successive short time intervals
throughout the forecast time period. This representation can be used to detect bottlenecks
in the system. Workload can be rearranged if needed and resources scheduled properly.
Forecast also reports jobs involved with tapes and/or JCL overrides well ahead of their
actual submission time in two ways:
By preparing a pull list for the tapes indicating the volume serial number of the input
tapes, and the approximate number of scratch tapes for the output data sets.
By determining which jobs need JCL overrides. The Forecast report indicates jobs
that need JCL overrides. The override JCL can be stored in a special JCL override
library and retrieved automatically. This satisfies the JCL override requirement
without any further intervention required.
Basically, two options are provided throughout the forecast application. For the first
option, workload is projected only from the CA-7 database. No existing workload is
projected from the CA-7 queues. This option requires a beginning time and is generally
used for nonspecific long range requests.
The second option takes the workload existing in both the database and/or the CA-7
queues into account in the forecast. This option uses the current time as the beginning of
the time interval so that current and future workload can be forecasted. It is generally
used for shorter and more specific requests.
Capability Commands
Forecast report for CPU workload with optional worksheets FJOB or FQJOB
Forecast report for input workstation workload FPRE or FQPRE
Forecast report for output workstation workload FPOST or FQPOST
Forecast report for input and output workstation workload FSTN or FQSTN
Forecast report for CPU and input/output workstation work- FALL or FQALL
load
Graphic display of workload FRES or FQRES
Tape pull list report FTAPE or FQTAPE
Job flow structure FSTRUC
A forecast can be done online or in batch mode for any time interval from one minute to
one year. It can be for all of the data center's work, work for a specific CPU, or work
for a specific job or workstation. Selection criteria are provided for flexibility in tailoring
a forecast run to meet specific needs.
Note: Depending on the selection criteria used, Forecast may produce a large volume of
output. For such large volume runs, it is advisable to use a batch terminal rather
than an online terminal. It may also be necessary to increase the allocated space
for the CA-7 scratch queue or change the SWFTRK option.
The following parameters are used throughout the forecast commands and are defined
here and referred to later as needed.
INT
See RINT
JOB
Specifies the job(s) to be forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs are to be forecast.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name terminated with an asterisk.
(jobname1,jobname2,...,jobname10)
Indicates up to 10 specific job names.
JOBNET
Specifies the job network field as the selection criteria for the jobs to be forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Specifies all names.
name
Specifies a specific name.
name*
Specifies a generic name terminated with an asterisk.
Note: If value contains a blank, comma, or quote, it is not possible to specify the
value through batch input.
LVL
Indicates the number of triggering levels to display. If not specified, the forecast
stops after 100 levels or the value specified in the FCMAXLEV keyword in the
CA-7 initialization file.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric (from 1-999)
Default: 100 (or CA-7 initialization file override)
Required: No
MAINID
Indicates that only those jobs set to run on the specified MAINID appear in the fore-
cast.
Size/Type: 1 numeric character from 1 to 7 preceded by SY
Required: No
NW
Specifies the network(s) as a selection criteria for the stations to be forecast. A com-
bination of STN and NW values governs the final selection of a station to be fore-
cast. If STN=T*,NW=N* is specified, only the stations whose names start with T
and belong to networks whose names start with N are selected for the forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all networks to be forecast.
network
Indicates a specific network name.
network*
Indicates a generic network name terminated with an asterisk.
NWOPT
Specifies if the forecast should include the output networks and their individual
stations for the jobs. If NWOPT is omitted, no connected networks are included.
Required: No
N
Indicates output networks are to be included, but individual workstations in the
networks are not listed.
S
Indicates individual workstations in the network are to be included.
RINT|INT
Specifies the interval time for the forecast of resources needed for the workload. The
entire forecast span is divided into successive time intervals of the value specified to
forecast the number of jobs running and percent of CPU use during each interval.
Size/Type: 4 numeric characters specified as hhmm from 0010 (10 minutes) to
2400 (24 hours)
Required: No
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID value as the selection criteria for jobs to be forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 255
except for FSTRUC 1-255
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
except for FSTRUC the default is 1
Required: Only if job has no defined schedule
SEG
Is specified only with LIST=WP or LIST=WPS to indicate which segment and sub-
segment of prose is to be included in the worksheet. If omitted, LIST=WP and
LIST=WPS produce all prose associated with a particular job. If only segment
selection is desired, the parentheses may be omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters segment
1 to 8 alphanumeric characters subsegment
Required: No
SEQ
Specifies the sequence in which forecast reports are presented.
Default: DLDT
Required: No
DLDT
Indicates the sequence is in the ascending order of deadline or starting date and
time of job, ending date and time of job, and job name.
DODT
Indicates the sequence is in the ascending order of due-out or ending date and
time of job, starting date and time of job, and job name.
JOB
Indicates the sequence is in the ascending order of job name, starting date and
time of job, and ending date and time of job.
STN
Indicates the sequence is in the ascending order of station name, starting date
and time of station, and ending date and time of station.
STN
Specifies the workstation(s) to be forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all workstations are to be forecast.
station
Indicates a specific workstation name.
station*
Indicates a generic workstation name terminated with an asterisk.
(station1,...,station10)
Indicates up to 10 specific workstations names. The workstation name specified
by the first positional value can be a specific workstation name or a generic
workstation name.
SYS
Specifies the system(s) as a selection criteria for the jobs to be forecast. A combina-
tion of JOB and SYS values governs the final selection of a job to be forecast. If
JOB=J*,SYS=S* is specified, only the jobs whose names start with J and which
belong to systems whose names start with S are selected for the forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all system names.
system
Indicates a specific system name.
system*
Indicates a generic system name terminated with an asterisk.
Note: If value contains a blank, comma, or quote, it is not possible to specify
the value through batch input.
TRIG
Specifies if the forecast should include the job-triggered and/or data set-triggered
jobs.
Default: J (except JD for FSTRUC)
Required: No
J
Only the job-triggered jobs are to be included.
D
Only the data set-triggered jobs are to be included.
DJ
Both job-triggered and data set-triggered jobs are to be included.
JD
Same as DJ.
N
Neither job triggers nor data set triggers are to be included.
Any data set which can be created by a forecasted job and which has a data set
trigger defined, is assumed to be created thus triggering the other job.
TYPE
Specifies whether the "dont schedule before/after" criteria defined on the DB.1 screen
is to be honored when generating a forecast.
Default: ACTUAL
Required: No
ACTUAL
Specifies honor "dont schedule before/after" criteria.
ALL
Specifies show all jobs as scheduled. Also indicates jobs that have
NXTCYC,SET=OFF and NXTCYC,SET=SKP specified.
1.8.2.1 Commands
This group of commands selects work only from the database according to the start time.
Start time is either explicitly specified or implied by due-out time minus average elapsed
time. Job (data) selection is made if the start time falls within the time interval of the
forecast. Any jobs triggered by the selected jobs, or any workstation in the output net-
works connected to these jobs, are also displayed. As a result, the start time of these
subsequent jobs or workstations may fall beyond the specified time interval. The group
includes:
FJOB Forecasts for jobs
FSTN Forecasts for workstations
FPRE Forecasts for input workstations
FPOST Forecasts for output workstations
FALL Forecasts for jobs and workstations (in both input and output networks)
A forecast can be done for any time interval and it may be done in online or batch mode.
However, as the forecast time interval is increased, the response time in online mode may
lengthen and/or the output volume may become larger. These forecast functions use the
CA-7 scratch queue. The allocated space for this file may have to be increased,
depending on the size of the database and the forecast's time interval.
Forecast selection can be made from the database by job, system, workstation, or network
and can be indicated by specific or generic names. Specific names must be specified in
up to 8 characters, and generic names must be specified in up to 7 characters and termi-
nated with an asterisk (*).
Specify the forecast interval for these commands by a beginning and ending date in the
format:
──FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬────────────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
Where:
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Required. Leading zeros are required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted, 01 is assumed for FROM, last
day of month for TO. A leading 0 is required if less than 10.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If omitted, the current year is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If omitted, 0000 is assumed for FROM, 2359 for TO.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
SPAN=hhhh
As an alternate to specifying an ending date and time (TO), a time interval may be
requested using SPAN=hhhh where:
hhhh
Is the interval span in hours. Minimum value is 1 and maximum value is 8784
(approximately one year).
Note: A job (or network) is only considered by the forecast if the FROM time of the
forecast falls within the job's (or network's) schedule period (January-December or
July-June).
1.8.2.3 Examples
1.8.3.1 Commands
These commands select work from the CA-7 queues and from the database. The
selection for work is made from the CA-7 queues first. Then, if the forecast time period
is large enough, further selection is made from the database according to the start time.
Start time is either explicitly specified or implied by due-out time minus average elapsed
time. The data selection is made if the start time falls within the time interval of the
forecast. Any jobs triggered by selected jobs, or any workstation in the output networks
connected to these jobs, are also displayed. As a result, the start time of these subsequent
jobs or workstations may fall beyond the specified time interval.
A forecast can be done for any time interval in online or batch mode. However, as the
forecast time interval is increased, the response time in online mode may lengthen and/or
the output volume may become larger. These forecast functions use the CA-7 scratch
files. The allocated space for these files may have to be increased, depending on the size
of the database and the forecast time interval.
Forecast selection can be made from the database by job, system, workstation, or network
and can be indicated by specific or generic names. Specific names are specified in up to
8 characters, and generic names are specified in up to 7 characters and terminated by an
asterisk (*).
The beginning time for the forecast interval for these functions is always the command
initiation (current) time. The ending time for the forecast interval is optional. If omitted,
selection is based on the CA-7 queues only. You can specify the ending time either
explicitly by a keyword TO or implicitly by SPAN.
─────TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)───────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Required. Leading zeros are required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted, last day of month is assumed.
A leading 0 is required if less than 10.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If omitted, the current year is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If omitted, 2359 is assumed.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
──SPAN=hhhh─────────────────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
hhhh
Specifies hours from 1 to 8784 (1 year).
1.8.4.1 Commands
FSTRUC Reports on an entire CPU job flow structure from the database along with
starting and ending times.
FRJOB Produces a reverse job flow structure from the database to identify trigger
chains and header jobs.
FRQJOB Produces a reverse job flow structure from the database and the status queues
to identify trigger chains and realtime header jobs.
These commands produce reports which display the structures of job flows defined in the
CA-7 database. They are used to deal with individual structures within the database defi-
nitions rather than the entire workload.
The FSTRUC command can be used to produce a forward forecast of a job structure
from a starting job with a specific or implied starting date and time.
You can use the FRJOB and FRQJOB commands to produce reverse job structures which
display the path(s) of control which cause the target job to be brought into the system
through job, data set, and network trigger definitions. That is, answer the question "How
does this job get into the system?". The queue variation of this command (FRQJOB)
checks the status queues to determine if a job in the trigger chain currently resides in the
queues.
1.8.5.1 Commands
FRES Forecasts for resources needed for CPU and workstation workload.
FQRES Forecasts for resources needed for CPU and workstation workload including the
existing workload in the CA-7 queues.
These commands display, in reports and graphs, resource forecasts for successive short
time intervals throughout the forecast time period. These resources include percentage of
CPU, number of tapes (for each type), and number of workstations.
In the case of the FQRES function, the work for resource forecasting is selected from the
CA-7 queues and from the database. The selection is made from the queues first. Subse-
quently, if the forecast time period is large enough, further selection is made from the
database.
In the case of the FRES function, the work is selected only from the database.
In both cases, selection from the database is done according to the start time. Start time
is either explicitly specified or implied by due-out time minus average elapsed time. The
selection is made if the start time falls within the time interval of the forecast. Any jobs
triggered by the selected jobs or any workstation in the output networks connected to
these jobs are also included at the user's option.
A forecast can be done for any resolved time interval and it may be in online or batch
mode. However, as the forecast time interval is increased, the response time in online
mode may lengthen and/or the output volume may become larger. These forecast func-
tions use the CA-7 scratch queue. The allocated space for this file may have to be
increased, depending on the size of the database and the forecast's time interval. See
SWFTRK parameter on the DAIO initialization file statement.
Forecast selection can be made from the database by job, system, workstation, or network
and can be indicated by specific or generic names. Specific names are specified in up to
8 characters, and generic names are specified in up to 7 characters and terminated with an
asterisk (*).
The beginning time of the forecast for the FRES command can be any valid time. For
FQRES, it is always the command initiation (current) time. The ending time for the
forecast for FRES must be specified. For FQRES it is optional. If omitted, the selection
is based on the CA-7 queues only. The ending time can be specified either explicitly by
the keyword TO or implicitly by SPAN. For the formats of the FROM and TO
keywords, see 2.73, “FQRES” on page 2-155 and 2.76, “FRES” on page 2-163.
1.8.6.1 Commands
These commands produce reports indicating the volume serial numbers of the input tapes
needed for jobs during the specified forecast time period. The jobs used for FTAPE are
selected only from the CA-7 database. In the case of the FQTAPE, the jobs used to
produce tape pull lists are selected from the CA-7 queues and from the database, but
selection is made from the queues first. Then, if the forecast period is large enough,
further selection is made from the database.
The selection from the database in both cases is done according to the start time. Start
time is either explicitly specified or implied by due-out time minus average elapsed time.
The selection is made if the start time falls within the time interval of the forecast. Any
jobs triggered by the selected jobs are also optionally included. Once the job is selected,
the database is searched for any data set residing on tape. CA-7 entries, and system
catalog entries, are searched to find the appropriate volume serial numbers of the tapes.
Forecast selection can be made from the database by either job name or system name.
These can be specific or generic. Specific names are specified in up to 8 characters, and
generic names are specified in up to 7 characters and terminated with an asterisk (*).
Note: The JCL for selected jobs is not examined, only the database information. There-
fore, temporary changes made to JCL regarding VOLSER values are not reflected
in the forecast unless the job is reloaded.
The order of the JCL within a step is important to whether a particular tape data set is
forecasted. Consider two DD statements referring to the same data set (for example, a
GDG), one for input and the other for output. If the input DD statement comes before
the output DD statement, the data set is considered as a requirement and does forecast.
Otherwise, it does not.
The beginning time for the FTAPE command can be any valid time. For FQTAPE,
however, it is always the command initiation (current) time. You must specify the ending
time for FTAPE. For FQTAPE it is optional; if omitted, the selection is based on the
CA-7 queues only. You can specify the ending time either explicitly by the keyword TO
or implicitly by SPAN. For the formats of the FROM and TO keywords, see 2.75,
“FQTAPE” on page 2-161 and 2.81, “FTAPE” on page 2-185.
1.8.7 Worksheets
The worksheet options from forecast provide conveniently formatted checklists for
projected CPU job activities. When requested, the output can be used by production
control personnel as status, planning, or even recovery documentation.
Worksheets for jobs are requested using the LIST option of the FJOB or FALL
command. This option is most useful when requested through the Batch Terminal Inter-
face facility because the output is in hardcopy format and can be filed or distributed as
desired.
See the LIST option of the FJOB command in FJOB on page 2-132 and to FJOB Screen
on page 2-136 for a sample worksheet.
< FJOB,FROM=333633,TO=333633,LIST=W
=
DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
< FJOB,FROM=333633,TO=333633,LIST=WP
=
DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
THIS IS THE FIRST JOB IN THE TESTNTWK TO BE EXECUTED AND IS A SCHEDULED JOB.
IT CONSISTS OF TWO STEPS. THE FIRST STEP RECEIVES A SET OF CONTROL CARDS AS
INPUT, CREATES A DATASET U7TEST31 AS OUTPUT AND DEMANDS THE NEXT JOB DUCCXX32
TO BE STARTED AFTER THE SUCCESSFUL COMPLETION OF THE STEP. THE SECOND STEP
RECEIVES ANOTHER SET OF CONTROL CARDS AS INPUT AND CREATES A DATASET U7TEST32
AS OUTPUT. IN TURN, U7TEST32 AUTO-TRIGGERS JOB DUCCXX33.
#QDESC
MMM JOB DUCCXX31
MMM SCHEDULED JOB, FIRST IN THE NETWORK
MMM FIRST STEP
MMM INPUT-CONTROL CARDS OUTPUT-U7TEST31
MMM SECOND STEP
MMM INPUT-CONTROL CARDS OUTPUT-U7TEST32
#END,QDESC
K L
CA-7 user commands are described in alphabetical sequence, with all slash (/) commands
appearing first.
In this chapter, user commands are shown with command description format, parameter
and option descriptions, examples, and typical terminal display screens.
As with all CA-7 commands, these must be authorized by security before a terminal user
can perform any of them.
2.1 /ASSIGN
2.1.1 Format 1
/ASSIGN
──/ASSIGN──,─┬─LT────┬─=station──,─┬─T────┬─=terminal───────────
└─LTERM─┘ └─TERM─┘
2.1.2 Format 2
/ASSIGN
──/ASSIGN──,─┬─MA─────┬─=─┬─SYn─┬───,CPU=ddname─────────────────
└─MAINID─┘ └─SYM─┘
2.1.3 Format 3
/ASSIGN
──/ASSIGN──,CPU=ddname──,BARR=barrier───────────────────────────
Where:
LTERM
Identifies the logical terminal (station) which is to be reassigned. Required for
format 1. You may use LT or LTERM interchangeably, but format 1 requires one or
the other.
TERM
Identifies the physical terminal to which the logical terminal is being assigned. You
may use T or TERM interchangeably, but format 1 requires one or the other.
MAINID
Identifies the current MAINID assigned to a submit data set on the CPU statement in
the initialization file. Required for format 2. You may use MA or MAINID inter-
changeably, but format 2 requires one or the other.
SYn
Indicates a single digit number (from 0 to 7 as determined from the initialization
file definitions).
SY*
Indicates that a MAINID is not specified.
CPU
Identifies the submit data set assigned to a CPU. The value is the ddname for the
data set which is defined in the CA-7 JCL and the initialization file CPU statement.
Required for formats 2 and 3.
BARR
Indicates the maximum number of jobs which can be submitted at one time to a
CPU. The value specified may be up to 4 digits. Required for format 3.
When reassigning a logical terminal, you must assign it to the same type of physical
device as that originally assigned (3270 to batch, 3270 to browse, and so forth, are not
allowed).
If a MAINID is defined as associated with more than one CPU and the MAINID is reas-
signed using /ASSIGN, CA-7 changes only the first occurrence of the MAINID to the
new CPU.
If a CPU goes down (fails) and the MAINIDs associated with it are reassigned, jobs that
were already submitted and active on the failed CPU must be requeued and resubmitted
by CA-7. If in a shared-spool JES environment, you may reroute such jobs through JES
instead of CA-7.
2.1.5 Examples
/ASSIGN,LT=KEYPNCH,TERM=RTERM1
/ASSIGN,MA=SY3,CPU=UCC7SUB1
/ASSIGN,MAINID=SYM,CPU=UCC7SUB2
/ASSIGN,CPU=UCC7SUB1,BARR=53
2.2 /AUTO
2.2.1 Syntax
/AUTO
──/AUTO──┬────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──,─┬─M───┬─=text────
│ ┌─5───┐ │ └─,COUNT=ccc─┘ └─MSG─┘
└─,INT=─┴─iii─┴──┘
Where:
INT
Identifies the number of seconds between each time the command is to be issued.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 3 to 300
Default: 5
Required: No
COUNT
Identifies the number of repetitions for the command. This limits the number of
times that the command is issued.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 1 to 500
Default: No limit
Required: No
MSG
Identifies the command text that is issued. M and MSG may be used interchange-
ably, but one or the other must be specified. If commas are part of the text, enclose
the message in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
If a new command is being entered when the time interval expires, the terminal is taken
out of /AUTO mode, but the last output is sent to the terminal when Enter is pressed
(not the output from the new command).
2.2.3 Examples
/AUTO,INT=3,MSG=(LQ,ST=RSTR)
/AUTO,COUNT=5,INT=123,M=(DEMAND,JOB=XYZ)
/AUTO,M=XWLB
2.3 /BRO
Use the /BRO command to broadcast a message to terminals on the CA-7 system. The
message is queued until the receiving terminal user requests display. See 2.16, “/MSG”
on page 2-37 for sending a message to one specific terminal.
For a CA-7 virtual terminal to receive a broadcast message, the TERM option must be
specified or the terminal must be connected.
2.3.1 Syntax
/BRO
──/BRO──,─┬─M───┬─=text──┬─────────────────┬────────────────────
└─MSG─┘ └─,─┬─T────┬─=ALL─┘
└─TERM─┘
Where:
MSG
Specifies the text of the broadcast message. MSG and M may be used interchange-
ably, but one or the other is required. If commas are included as part of the text,
enclose the entire message text in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
TERM
In general this parameter should not be used. This parameter affects the way a
broadcast message is sent to the VTAM virtual terminals. If not specified, then only
those virtual terminals that are connected to CA-7 get the message. If specified, then
all the VTAM virtual terminals get the message. This can cause excessive space
usage of the scratch queue.
Size/Type: 3 alphabetic characters
Default: Virtual terminals that are connected to CA-7 only
Required: No
2.3.2 Examples
2.4 /CHANGE
Use the /CHANGE command to modify the security definition for a given operator by
changing the level of authorization which controls an operator's ability to use the com-
mands of CA-7 applications.
Note: This command is only applicable if CA-7 native security is being used for
command access.
2.4.1 Syntax
/CHANGE
──/CHANGE──,─┬─A────┬─=application──,─┬─O──────┬─=operid─────────
└─APPL─┘ └─OPERID─┘
──,─┬─P────┬─=nn──,─┬─T────┬─=─┬─term────┬───────────────────────
└─PRTY─┘ └─TERM─┘ └─MMALLMM─┘
Where:
APPL
Identifies the CA-7 application for which a different level of authorization is to be
assigned. A and APPL may be used interchangeably, but one or the other must be
specified. The value must be the driver program suffix specified in the SECURITY
macro (for example, SFC0, SDM0, and so forth).
Size/Type: 1 to 4 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
OPERID
Identifies the operator ID for which the authorization is to be changed. O and
OPERID may be used interchangeably, but one or the other must be specified. The
value must be the operator ID defined in the SECURITY macro.
PRTY
Specifies the new level of authorization for the designated CA-7 application. P and
PRTY may be used interchangeably, but one or the other must be specified. The
value must be numeric and must be between 0 and 15 (refer to the CA-7 Security
Guide for default authorization values).
TERM
Identifies the physical terminal at which the change in authorization applies. T and
TERM may be used interchangeably, but one or the other must be specified.
term
Specifies the symbolic terminal name defined by the NAME parameter on the
TERM statement in the initialization file.
**ALL**
Must be specified to change authorization levels for an OPID that is defined in
the Security macro with a TRMD=**ALL**.
When changing level of authorization, the application for which level of authorization is
being changed must be specified on the SECURITY macro for the designated operator.
Access to a CA-7 application must be initially authorized by the SECURITY macro.
2.4.3 Example
/CHANGE,OPERID=OPER3331,TERM=RTERM1,A=SDM3,PRTY=13
2.5 /CLOSE
A /CLOSE command with no parameters disconnects the issuing terminal from CA-7.
Caution
Production users should use the command with no parameters. Only system users
should use the parameters.
2.5.1 Syntax
/CLOSE
──/CLOSE──┬──────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬────────────
└─,GROUP=group─┘ └─,─┬─T────┬─=terminal─┘
└─TERM─┘
Where:
GROUP
Indicates a line group is to be closed and identifies which group. Value must be the
group name defined by the NAME parameter on the GROUP statement in the initial-
ization file. If GROUP specifies a VTAM group, all CA-7 connected VTAM termi-
nals are disconnected, not just the identified group.
If /CLOSE is used with a group defined as DEVICE=CCI it will force termination of
the CA-7 CCI Terminal session that is active on that group. This should not be
needed in normal operation.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
TERM
Indicates to disconnect a VTAM terminal from CA-7. Value must be the NAME
value on the TERM statement in the initialization file for the VTAM terminal to be
disconnected. T and TERM may be used interchangeably.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.5.2 Examples
/CLOSE,GROUP=BGROUP1
/CLOSE,T=VTERM1
/CLOSE
2.6 /COPY
Use the /COPY command to send a currently displayed page of output to another logical
terminal (station) in the CA-7 terminal network. (Logical terminals are identified by the
STANIDS= parameter of the STATIONS statement in the CA-7 initialization file.)
2.6.1 Syntax
/COPY
──/COPY──┬──────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─LT────┬─=station─┘
└─LTERM─┘
Where:
LTERM
Identifies a specific logical terminal (station) to which the currently displayed page of
output is to be copied. LTERM and LT may be used interchangeably. Value must
be a logical terminal name which is the same device type as the terminal issuing the
command. If omitted, the output is routed to the first hardcopy printer (if one is
defined) in the same LINE as the sending terminal.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
If PF2 has not been assigned to another function, its use has the same effect as entering
/COPY with no logical terminal name specified.
After the page of output has been copied, the next page of output is displayed on the
requesting terminal.
The sending terminal receives an error message if any of the following occurs:
If the specified logical terminal does not exist.
If /COPY or PF2 is used without a logical terminal being specified and there is no
hardcopy device on the line.
If the sending and receiving terminals are not the same device type.
If the specified logical terminal does not exist or if /COPY was used and there is no
hardcopy device on the line, the sending terminal receives a message indicating this situ-
ation.
2.6.3 Examples
/COPY,LT=KEYPUNCH
/COPY,LTERM=MAILROOM
/COPY,LTERM=PRINT1
/COPY
2.7 /DISPLAY
Use the /DISPLAY command to obtain internal information and/or status of various com-
ponents of CA-7. As an information command, it has a large group of keywords avail-
able to designate specific information for display. You may specify certain combinations
of keywords on a single /DISPLAY command, but at least one must be selected.
2.7.1 Syntax
/DISPLAY
──/DISPLAY──┬─────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
└─,─┬─A────┬─=programname─┘
└─APPL─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬────────────────┬─────────────────────
└─,CPU=─┬─ALL──────┬──┘ └─,DB=─┬─LOG──┬──┘
├─UCC7IRDx─┤ └─VSAM─┘
└─UCC7SUBn─┘
──┬──────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────┬────────────
└─,─┬─FM─────┬─=module─┘ └─,─┬─L────┬─=─┬─line─┬──┘
└─FMTBLK─┘ └─LINE─┘ └─ALL──┘
──┬────────────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────
└─,─┬─LT────┬─=─┬─station─┬──┘ └─,─┬─PL────┬─=pools─┘
└─LTERM─┘ └─ALL─────┘ └─POOLS─┘
──┬───────────────────┬──┬──────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─PR────┬─=scan─┘ └─,Q=queue─┘
└─PRINT─┘
──┬──────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────┬───────
└─,─┬─ST─────┬─=status─┘ └─,─┬─T────┬─=─┬─terminal─┬──┘
└─STATUS─┘ └─TERM─┘ ├─ALL──────┤
├─M────────┤
└─?────────┘
Where:
APPL
Identifies the CA-7 application program(s) whose status is to be displayed. A and
APPL may be used interchangeably.
SASSxxxx
Displays a specific CA-7 module. The xxxx must be the last 4 characters of the
module suffix (for example, SLI0).
SASSxxx|SASSxx|SASSx
Displays a generic group of modules belonging to the same CA-7 application.
All modules beginning with the characters specified are displayed (for example,
SASSSLI displays all general listing modules).
ALL
Displays all CA-7 modules that are defined in the initialization file.
CPU
Identifies the submit data set or internal reader associated with the CPU(s) for which
status is to be displayed.
UCC7SUBn|UCC7IRDn
Indicates the ddname which defines the desired submit data set.
ALL
Indicates all submit data sets and their related MAINIDS are to be displayed.
DB
Specifies the data set(s) for which status is to be displayed.
LOG
Displays status of the log data set currently in use.
VSAM
Displays VSAM database values in effect.
FMTBLK
Identifies the CA-7 format or calendar block(s) whose status is to be displayed. FM
and FMTBLK may be used interchangeably.
SFMxyyyy|SFMxyyy|SFMxyy
Displays a generic group of format blocks belonging to the same CA-7 applica-
tion. The x portion of the name must be A for batch format blocks, H for 3270
format blocks or X for both. The yyyy portion of the name must be the
4-character module suffix (for example, SLI0). All format blocks beginning with
the characters specified are displayed.
SCALyyzz|SCALyyz|SCALyy
Displays a generic group of base calendar blocks. The yy portion of the name
represents the calendar year (that is, 00 for 2000). The zz portion of the name
represents the unique calendar identifier. All calendar blocks beginning with the
characters specified are displayed.
ALL
Displays all format and base calendar blocks that are defined in the initialization
file with a FMTBLK or CALBLK statement.
LINE
Identifies the line(s) for which status is to be displayed. L and LINE may be used
interchangeably.
Required: No
line
Specifies a single line name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
ALL
Displays all lines in the CA-7 network. (The line name is defined by the NAME
parameter on the LINE statement in the CA-7 initialization file.)
LTERM
Identifies the logical terminal(s) for which status is to be displayed. LT and LTERM
may be used interchangeably.
station
Specifies a single logical terminal name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
ALL
Displays status for all logical terminals in the CA-7 network. (The logical ter-
minal name is defined by the STANIDS or LTERM parameter on the
STATIONS statement in the CA-7 initialization file.)
POOLS|PL
Identifies the main memory storage pool(s) for which status is to be displayed. PL
and POOLS may be used interchangeably. Value must be one of the following:
APG
CA-7 application pool which provides main memory for storing nonresident and
nonpermanent programs while they are in use.
DSN
Dataset data set buffer pool which provides main memory for activity involving
the dataset data set.
JOB
Job data set buffer pool which provides main memory for activity involving the
Job data set.
MSG
Message pool which provides main memory for CA-7 format blocks and their
input/output activity. Values displayed are the same as those for NSP because
they are a shared pool.
NSP
Nonspecific pool which provides main memory for all requests not specifically
directed to one of the other pools. Values displayed are the same as those for
MSG because they are a shared pool.
RES
Resident pool which contains the CA-7 control blocks and all resident CA-7 pro-
grams.
ALL
All storage pools previously listed.
PRINT
Requests a display of schedule scan control values. PR and PRINT may be used
interchangeably. If used, value may be either SCH or ALL.
Q
Identifies the queue data sets for which status is to be displayed. The display
includes initialization file FORMAT statement INDEX options taken and device
types for the queue data sets. The count shown as tracks available for status queues
(REQ, RDY, ACT, PRN, PST, and PRE) indicates an amount never used since the
last COLD start of CA-7 (COLD, FORM, MOVQ). For the SCR, DQT, and TRL
queues, the values shown are current levels and fluctuate up and down based on
actual usage. The INDEX options for the SCR and DQT are set to a dash (-)
because the INDEX keyword in the initialization file has no effect on these queues.
The TRL entry is set dynamically based on the environment where CA-7 is exe-
cuting.
ACT
Active queue.
DQT
Disk queue table which is used to control output messages for CA-7 terminals.
PRE
Preprocess queue.
PRN
Prior-run queue.
PST
Postprocess queue.
REQ
Request queue.
RDY
Ready queue.
SCR
Scratch queue which provides temporary work space for the CA-7 applications
and messages for the terminals.
TRL
Trailer queue which is used to store JCL and requirement data for jobs in the
request, ready, active, and prior-run queues.
ALL
All of the queue data sets previously listed.
STATUS
Indicates which status is to be displayed. STATUS and ST may be used interchange-
ably.
CA7
Information about the CA-7 system such as local SMF ID, CA-7 VTAM applica-
tion ID, CA-7 subsystem name, and CA-7 SVC number.
DPROC
CA-Driver procedure libraries associated with CA-7 JCL libraries.
JCL
Data sets containing CA-7 submitted JCL and their associated numeric index
values. Data sets referenced by a symbolic index display numeric index 255.
JCLVAR
Data sets containing CA-7 submitted JCL and their associated numeric or sym-
bolic index values.
KEY
Program function and program access key settings.
Note: If key information is desired on a specific terminal, a combination of
STATUS=KEY and the TERM parameter may be used.
SEC
Displays current CA-7 security environment. See the CA-7 Security Guide for
details.
TERM
Identifies the physical terminal(s) for which status is to be displayed. T and TERM
may be used interchangeably. (The symbolic terminal name is defined by the NAME
parameter on the TERM statement in the CA-7 initialization file.)
terminal
Specifies a terminal name.
ALL
Specifies all physical terminals.
*
Results in a condensed form of the ALL display.
?
Produces an interpreted display for the issuing terminal.
2.7.2 Examples
/DISPLAY Command CPU=ALL Screen
< /DISPLAY,CPU=ALL
=
MMM CPU DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
DDNAME BARRIER SUBMIT-COUNT MAINID
K L
DDNAME Name of the DD statement in the CA-7 JCL which defines this submit data
set or internal reader.
BARRIER
The maximum number of CA-7 jobs to be submitted to the host system job
queue at any one time.
SUBMIT-COUNT
Reflects the current number of jobs submitted to the host system job queue at
this time.
MAINID The CA-7 main ID(s) which are assigned to this submit data set or internal
reader.
< /DISPLAY,LT=ALL
=
MMM LTERM DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
WORKHOURS DISP FLAGS
LTERM TERM CALENDAR FROM TO #MSGS CUR NEXT 1 2 3 STATUS
HTERM1 HTERM1 SCALyy31 3833 1733 331 3328 3328 A3 33 33 OUTPUT,
CONTROL1 HTERM1 SCALyy31 3833 1733 333 3333 3333 33 33 33
CONTROL2 HTERM1 SCALyy31 3833 1733 333 3333 3333 33 33 33
CONTROL3 HTERM1 MNONEM 3333 2433 333 3333 3333 33 33 33
HTERM2 HTERM2 SCALyyPE 3633 1833 333 3328 3328 33 33 33
RECOVER1 HTERM2 SCALyyPE 3633 1833 333 3333 3333 33 33 33
K L
LTERM The logical terminal or workstation name. This is either the value entered on
the STATIONS statement in the initialization file (keyword STANIDS=) or a
system-generated name for virtual terminals.
TERM The terminal name, either specified on the TERM statement in the initializa-
tion file (keyword NAME=), or a system-generated name for virtual termi-
nals.
CALENDAR
The calendar specified on the STNCAL statement in the initialization file
(keyword CAL=) for this workstation.
WORKHOURS
The FROM= and TO= values entered on the STNCAL statement in the
initialization file for this workstation.
#MSGS The number of currently queued messages for this workstation.
DISP The relative displacement into the scratch queue where current messages
reside.
FLAGS Bit settings that relate to LTFLAG1, LTFLAG2, and LTFLAG3 as defined in
the DSECT SASSTBLK.
STATUS A one-word description of the flag settings.
< /DISPLAY,PR=SCH
=
MMM SCHEDULE SCAN DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
----------MINUTES----------- ---STATUS----
NEXT SCAN SPAN INCR QDWL REPR LDTM RTRY REQ/Q RDY/Q ABR HOLD
yy.163 AT 1633 3243 3123 3333 3333 3333 3332 ACTIVE STOPPED NO NO
K L
NEXT SCAN
The date and time of the next scheduled wake up for schedule scan.
SPAN The value in minutes of how far ahead to look for calendar scheduled jobs
and networks with a deadline date and time that correspond to the time frame
being scanned.
INCR Number of minutes between wake-ups of schedule scan.
QDWL Number of minutes added to the SPAN value to ensure timely scheduling of
work into the queues.
REPR Number of minutes between prompt cycles for late tasks or jobs, or jobs
awaiting restart.
LDTM A global value to be added to all jobs' lead time.
RTRY Number of minutes between the retry of attachment of JCL after a dynamic
allocation failure.
STATUS The indication for the request and ready queues as to whether they are
ACTIVE or STOPPED (see the STOP and START commands).
ABR Indication of whether the initial queue entry message is to be issued in abbre-
viated form (see the SSCAN command SCAN=ABR).
HOLD Indication of whether jobs enter the request queue with an initial hold
requirement (see the SSCAN command SCAN=HLD).
< /DISPLAY,T=ALL
=
MMM TERM DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
--I/O COUNTS--- OUT -LIMIT- ---FLAGS---
TERM TYPE ADDR READS WRITE ERR Q'D TIM MON 3 1 2 V STATUS/(VTAMID)
HTERM1 3273R 3334 33341 33342 333 331 323 323 D3 28 32 34 MSTR,
HTERM2 3273R 3334 33375 33375 333 333 323 323 D4 33 32 34 ALT,SKIP,
PTERM1 3273R 3334 33333 33315 333 333 333 332 54 24 32 34 LOFF,SKIP,
TTERM1 TRAILR 3334 33333 33333 333 333 333 332 D3 23 33 34 LOFF,
CTERM1 CONSOL 3334 33333 33331 333 333 333 332 D3 23 33 34 LOFF,
BTERM1 BATCH 3334 33333 33333 333 333 333 332 33 23 33 34 LOFF,STOP
K L
TERM The terminal name from the initialization file TERM statement (keyword
NAME=). For virtual terminals this is a system-generated name.
TYPE The device type for this terminal defined by the DEVICE= on the TERM
statement in the initialization file.
ADDR The relative address for local BTAM terminals.
READS Number of reads for this terminal during this session of CA-7.
WRITE Number of writes for this terminal during this session of CA-7.
ERR Number of errors during this session of CA-7. There should be messages
produced as WTOs (for example, CA-7.V001 messages) to explain the errors.
Q'D Number of messages currently queued for this terminal.
TIM The number of minutes of inactivity before the terminal is automatically dis-
connected from CA-7.
MON The number of minutes of inactivity in the interface of CA-1 or CA-11
before the terminal is automatically returned to CA-7.
FLAGS For an explanation of the flags fields, use the /DISPLAY command with the
T=? parameter.
STATUS For an explanation of the status fields, use the /DISPLAY command with the
T=? parameter.
/DISPLAY,DB=ALL
< /DISPLAY,DB=VSAM
=
DDNAME=CA7JLIB DSNAME=USER.CA7.JOBLIB
DSORG=VSAM BUFND=99 BUFNI=99 ALLOCJCL=YES ALLOCDYN=NO
TYPE/STRINGS VALUES:
JBD/33 JBM/33
DDNAME=CA7DLIB DSNAME=USER.CA7.DSLIB
DSORG=VSAM BYFND=99 BUFNI=99 ALLOCJCL=YES ALLOCDYN=NO
TYPE/STRINGS VALUES:
DSD/33 DSM/33 NWD/312 NWM/32 PPD/33 PPM/33 SID/32 SIM/32
SJD/33 SJM/33 SOD/32 SOM/32
DDNAME=CA7IDS DSNAME=USER.CA7.INDEXDS
DSORG=VSAM BUFND=99 BUFNI=99 ALLOCJCL=YES ALLOCDYN=NO
TYPE/STRINGS VALUES:
I /33
K L
< /DISPLAY,L=ALL
=
MMM LINE DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
I/O COUNTS FLAGS
LINE TYPE READS WRITES ERRORS 3 1 STATUS
< /DISPLAY,T=M =
MMM TERM DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
--I/O COUNTS--- OUT TIM MON
NAME ID/TYPE READS WRITE ERR Q'D LIM LIM STATUS
/DISPLAY,T=?
< /DISPLAY,T=? =
TIM MON SIM
TERM--- ID------ TYPE---- ADDR READS WRITE ERR MSGS LIM LIM LOG LOGGED
HTERM A46L6316 3273V 3333 33353 33349 333 333 333 332 YES ON
K L
/DISPLAY,Q=ALL Command
< /DISPLAY,Q=ALL
=
MMM QUEUE DISPLAY MMM (3383) PAGE 3331
QUEUE TRACKS AVAIL. INDEX
< /DISPLAY,ST=JCL
=
MMM JCL DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
DATASET NAME INDEX ALT DSORG VOLSER LTERM
/DISPLAY,ST=JCLVAR Command
< /DISPLAY,ST=JCLVAR =
MMM SYMBOLICALLY INDEXED LIBRARY DEFS FROM VSAM FILE MMM PAGE 3331
VARIABLE/INDEX DATASET NAME ALT DSORG VOLSER LTERM
333 CA337.JCLDS1
253 PDS M83338 MASTER
233 SYS2.PROCLIB
N/A PDS M83PP1 MASTER
253 D463RV1.PROC.CLIST
N/A PDS M83T82 MASTER
&HELP CA337.R333.HELP
N/A PDS M83338 MASTER
&PAYROLL CA337.R333.PAYROLL
N/A PDS M83338 MASTER
&PAYABLE CA337.R333.ACCTS.PAYABLE
N/A PDS M83338 MASTER
&RECEIVABLE CA337.R333.ACCTS.RECEIVBL
N/A PDS M83338 MASTER
K L
< /DISPLAY,ST=KEY
=
MMM KEY DISPLAY MMM (VTERM1) PAGE 3331
KEY FUNCTION
< /DISPLAY,PL=ALL
=
MMM POOL DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
POOL SIZE AVAIL.
2.8 /DMP1
Use of the /DMP1 command is the same as the 2.9, “/DUMP” on page 2-27, except it
does not generate a storage dump. It also causes a user 444 (U0444) abend.
2.8.1 Syntax
/DMP1
──/DMP1─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.9 /DUMP
Use the /DUMP command to cause an abnormal termination of CA-7. A user 444 abend
results and a storage dump is generated.
Note: Extreme CAUTION is advised before using this command because a loss of data
may result.
2.9.1 Syntax
/DUMP
──/DUMP─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.10 /ECHO
Use the /ECHO command either to echo input data back to the sending terminal or to
format a 3270-type terminal with constant data so that additional data may then be
entered to complete an input command. This command is especially useful in combina-
tion with the /PF and /PA commands to allow a lengthy command format to be called up
onto a terminal with a single keystroke.
2.10.1 Syntax
/ECHO
──/ECHO──,─┬─M───┬─=text────────────────────────────────────────
└─MSG─┘
Where:
MSG
Specifies a character string to be echoed back to the terminal. MSG and M may be
used interchangeably, but one or the other is required. If commas are included as
part of the text, enclose the entire message text in parentheses.
If the last character of the MSG text is a # sign, the cursor is moved to that location
when the command is echoed to the terminal. This is provided to allow preformat-
ting of command input.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.10.2 Examples
/ECHO,M=(LJOB,JOB=#)
2.11 /FETCH
Use the /FETCH command to retrieve top line commands entered since the last /LOGON.
Commands entered on the top line are stored in a buffer known as a command ring. The
command ring can hold up to five top line commands. When the sixth command is
entered, the oldest command in the ring is erased so that the new one can be stored. In
this way, the five most recent commands are saved.
Repeated executions of /FETCH will retrieve commands in the order that they are stored
in the ring, from most recent to the oldest.
2.11.1 Syntax
/FETCH
──/FETCH────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.12 /JCL
Use the /JCL command to add, update, or delete a JCL statement referenced by a sym-
bolic index.
Changes made to JCL statements with the /JCL command are stored in the CA-7 database
and remain in effect when CA-7 is reinitialized if JCLDEFS=VSAM is specified on the
RESIDENT statement in the initialization file.
See the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide for more information on using symbolic
indexes to refer to JCL data sets.
Note: Any changes to JCL library definitions are LOST when CA-7 is recycled unless
JCLDEFS=VSAM is specified on the RESIDENT statement in the CA-7 initial-
ization file. Please refer to the discussion of this keyword on the RESIDENT
statement in the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide.
2.12.1 Syntax
/JCL
──/JCL──,OPT=─┬─ADD─┬─,INDEX=jcllib──,DSN=dsname─────────────────
├─UPD─┤
└─DEL─┘
──┬───────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬──────────────────
└─,ALT=─┬─nnn────┬──┘ └─,DPROC=─┬─dsname─┬──┘
├─xx...x─┤ ├─NO─────┤
└─NO─────┘ └─MNONEM─┘
──┬───────────────────────┬──────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─MASTER───┐ │
└─,LTERM=─┴─xxxxxxxx─┴──┘
Where:
OPT
Specifies the type of JCL statement change to be performed.
ADD
Adds a symbolic JCL data statement reference.
UPD
Updates a symbolic JCL data statement reference.
DEL
Deletes a symbolic JCL data statement reference.
INDEX
Specifies the symbolic index associated with the JCL statement. A symbolic index is
referred to as a JCLLIB on the DB.1 screen. A symbolic index consists of an amper-
sand (&) followed by up to 15 alphanumeric characters. Symbolic value &HELP is
reserved for the HELP data set.
DSN
Specifies the fully qualified name of a data set containing execution JCL to be sub-
mitted by CA-7. The data set must be a PDS. A data set name may not be specified
with OPT=DEL.
Note: JCL libraries added with the /JCL command are automatically assigned an
attribute of DYN=2.
ALT
Specifies JCL library destination.
nnn
xx...x
Specifies the INDEX value from a previously defined JCL library that is
searched prior to this one. This works exactly like DD statement concatenation
where the ALT is first in the sequence, but is supported for only one level.
Since validation of this parameter is done while the internal table of JCL
libraries is being built, the alternate library must be defined in the initialization
file prior to the statement which references it as an alternate. ALT and INDEX
values cannot be equal in any one JCL statement. Refer to the Alternate JCL
Libraries section of the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide for a discussion of
how this option may be used. ALT is optional.
NO
Indicates that an ALT destination is to be removed from an existing JCL library
destination, as in the following:
/JCL,INDEX=index,OPT=UPD,ALT=NO
DPROC
Specifies CA-Driver JCL libraries.
dsname
Specifies the name of the PDS that is to be concatenated above the libraries in
the CARPROC DD allocation whenever CA-Driver is invoked for JCL in the
associated JCL library.
NO
Indicates that a DPROC association is to be removed from an existing definition,
as in the following:
/JCL,INDEX=index,OPT=UPD,DPROC=NO
*NONE*
Indicates that CA-Driver is not to be invoked for JCL using this INDEX.
LTERM
Specifies the logical terminal to which prompt messages should be routed for jobs
using JCL from this library. The default is MASTER. See the discussion of the
LTERM keyword or the JCL initialization file statement in the CA-7 Systems Pro-
grammer Guide for further information.
2.13 /LOG
Use the /LOG command to add free-form text to the CA-7 log data set. Use these entries
to document situations occurring during production, such as why a job is late or canceled.
You can review this text later through batch report CA7xx032.
2.13.1 Syntax
/LOG
──/LOG──,─┬─D────┬─=data────────────────────────────────────────
└─DATA─┘
Where:
DATA
Identifies data to be logged to the log data set. DATA and D may be used inter-
changeably, but one or the other is required. If commas are included as part of the
data, enclose the entire data text in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
See report request ID CA7xx032 in the CA-7 Reports Guide for a report which reflects
/LOG information.
2.13.3 Examples
/LOG,DATA=CA37JOB1 CANCELED
Note: Current date and time are added to the text when the log record is written.
2.14 /LOGOFF
Use the /LOGOFF command to inform the CA-7 system that a terminal is going inactive.
Whenever a terminal is to be inactive for some time, it is best to issue a /LOGOFF. This
does not return to VTAM (see /CLOSE). It causes CA-7 to return the terminal to the
Logon screen.
/LOGOFF with no terminal specification causes the issuing terminal to be logged off
from CA-7.
2.14.1 Syntax
/LOGOFF
──/LOGOFF──┬──────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─T────┬─=term─┘
└─TERM─┘
Where:
TERM
Indicates the terminal to be logged off. Value must be a terminal name, up to 7
characters. The T option could be used from the master terminal to log off a ter-
minal to allow completion of the shutdown process. See the description of /SHUT-
DOWN on 2.31, “/SHUTDOWN” on page 2-64.
2.15 /LOGON
Use the /LOGON command to initiate a CA-7 terminal session. Information supplied on
the /LOGON command is used to validate user access to CA-7.
2.15.1 Syntax
/LOGON
──/LOGON──userid──┬───────────┬──┬───────────────┬───────────────
└─,password─┘ └─,NPW=password─┘
──┬───────────────┬──┬────────────────┬──────────────────────────
└─,UID=resource─┘ └─,PRM=parameter─┘
Where:
userid
Specifies the userid. The parameters described above are valid for batch users of
CA-7 (for example, console users, batch terminal users, and so on). For online users,
these parameters are not considered valid unless RESLOGON=NO is specified on the
SECURITY statement in the CA-7 initialization file. If RESLOGON=NO is not
specified, the /LOGON command causes the LOGON screen to be displayed with an
error message.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
password
Specifies the password. This parameter may be entered as PSW=password.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
NPW
Specifies the new password. This parameter may be used to change the user's
current password if using external security.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No, unless required by external security
UID
Specifes the UID resource name. The data entered is not displayed. See the CA-7
Security Guide for more information on UID resources.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
PRM
Specifies free-form text to be passed to the SASSXXLX user exit.
Size/Type: 1 to 40 alphanumeric characters
Required: No, unless required by user exit
2.15.3 Example
/LOGON Command
< =
PLEASE ENTER LOGON DATA OR PRESS PF3 TO DISCONNECT
2.16 /MSG
Use the /MSG command to send a free-form message to another logical terminal.
2.16.1 Syntax
/MSG
──/MSG──┬──────────────────────┬──┬────────────┬─────────────────
└─,─┬─LT────┬─=station─┘ └─,ID=userid─┘
└─LTERM─┘
──,─┬─M───┬─=text────────────────────────────────────────────────
└─MSG─┘
Where:
LTERM
Identifies the logical terminal (station) to which the message is to be sent. LTERM
and LT may be used interchangeably, but cannot be used with ID. Value must be a
single, logical station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
ID
Identifies the user ID to which the message is to be sent. The message is queued to
the logical terminal associated with the user ID. If the user ID is logged on multiple
times, only the first logical terminal receives the message. ID cannot be used with LT
or LTERM.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
MSG
Identifies the message text to be sent. MSG and M may be used interchangeably, but
one or the other is required. If commas are included as part of the text, enclose the
entire message text in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
If the receiving terminal logs off before displaying the message, the message remains
queued to that logical terminal.
CA-7 displays the sending logical terminal name with the message text.
2.16.3 Examples
/MSG,LTERM=MASTER,M=EXPEDITE JOB 7
/MSG,LT=MASTER,M=(THIS NEEDS,PARENTHESES)
2.17 /MVS
2.17.1 Syntax
/MVS
──/MVS──,─┬─M───┬─=(operator command)───────────────────────────
└─MSG─┘
Where:
MSG
Identifies the MVS system console operator command to be issued. If commas are
included as part of the MVS command text, enclose the entire command text in
parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.17.2 Example
/MVS,M=(D A,L)
There is no output specific to the command provided on the MSG keyword. CA-7 does
not report the status of the command in MVS. In most cases, command output only
appears on the MVS console.
For information on security considerations with the /MVS command, refer to the CA-7
Security Guide.
2.18 /NXTMSG
Use the /NXTMSG command to display messages which were queued for a terminal.
Messages may originate manually from a user at a terminal or automatically from CA-7.
Users are alerted to the presence of messages at /LOGON time and by the MSGS indi-
cator at the bottom of preformatted screens or below the page number on general inquiry
command displays.
Each command displays the next message in the sequence received; that is, the message
that has been queued the longest amount of time.
2.18.1 Syntax
/NXTMSG
──/NXTMSG───────────────────────────────────────────────────────
There are no keywords associated with this command. The next queued message for this
terminal is displayed. If there are no more messages, a message is produced that indi-
cates there are no queued messages.
2.19 /OPEN
Use the /OPEN command to restore access to terminals or line groups by the CA-7
system, after a /CLOSE command.
Use this command to start manually the CA-7 CCI Terminal interface. You may need to
start this interface manually if CCI is not active when CA-7 initializes or if CCI termi-
nates after the interface has been initialized.
To initialize the CA-7 CCI Terminal Interface without recycling CA-7, use the /OPEN
command specifying a GROUP that is defined as DEVICE=CCI.
There is no need to issue the /OPEN for each group defined with DEVICE=CCI, the first
/OPEN issued for such a group will suffice.
This command should NOT be used after a /CLOSE has been issued for a GROUP
defined as DEVICE=CCI.
2.19.1 Syntax
/OPEN
──/OPEN──,─┬─GROUP=group─────┬──────────────────────────────────
└──┬─T────┬─=term─┘
└─TERM─┘
Where:
GROUP
Indicates a line group to be opened and identifies which group. Value must be the
group name. When GROUP specifies a VTAM group, logons are accepted.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes (unless TERM is used)
TERM
Specifies the name of a VTAM terminal which is to have its logon simulated
(SIMLOGON). This establishes a connect to the terminal from CA-7 to VTAM.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes (unless GROUP is used)
2.19.2 Examples
/OPEN,GROUP=VGROUP
/OPEN,T=VPRNTR
/OPEN,GROUP=CCI31
2.20 /OPERID
Use the OPERID command to obtain the current internal security definitions for the
issuing user.
2.20.1 Syntax
/OPERID
──/OPERID───────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.20.2 Example
/OPERID Command
< /OPERID
=
MMM OPERATOR DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
OPERATOR-ID TERMINAL USERID ----------------APPL,PRTY-------------
2.21 /OPERIDS
Use the /OPERIDS command to display current internal security definitions for an oper-
ator ID other than your own or for all operator IDs. You may also use the /OPERIDS
command to display all active users logged on to CA-7.
2.21.1 Syntax
/OPERIDS
──/OPERIDS──,ID=─┬─userid─┬─────────────────────────────────────
├─ALL────┤
└─MACTM──┘
Where:
ID
The operator ID for which the internal security definitions are to be displayed. You
may enter one of the following:
userid
Display the definitions for a single operator ID.
ALL
Display the definitions for all currently defined operator IDs.
*ACT*
Displays all active terminal users logged on to CA-7. Once the trailer terminal
has been used after CA-7 startup, it always shows active.
2.21.2 Examples
/OPERIDS Command
< /OPERIDS,ID=MASTER
=
MMM OPERATOR DISPLAY MMM PAGE 3331
OPERATOR-ID TERMINAL USERID ----------------APPL,PRTY-------------
K L
OPERATOR-ID
The CA-7 operator ID as defined in the CA-7 internal security matrix.
TERMINAL
The CA-7 terminal name as defined in the CA-7 initialization file.
USERID The internal security UID level associated with the operator ID listed.
APPL,PRTY
The CA-7 application IDs and the associated security level for this user for
each application. (Example: SDM0,15 where SDM0 is the database mainte-
nance application, and the user has a security level of 15 for this application.)
/OPERIDS Command
< /OPERIDS,ID=MACTM =
MMM DISPLAY ACTIVE USERS MMM
PAGE 3331
TERMINAL LUNAME USERID UID
K L
TERMINAL
The CA-7 terminal name as defined in the CA-7 initialization file.
LUNAME The VTAM logical unit name associated with this terminal.
USERID The user ID associated with the terminal. If CA-7 internal security is being
used, this is the CA-7 operator ID. For external security, this is the ID of the
user that was used during logon to CA-7.
UID The internal security UID level associated with the user.
2.22 /PAGE
Use the /PAGE command for the selective review of an output message or command
response. Previous pages (screens) and succeeding pages of a current display may also
be reviewed.
2.22.1 Syntax
/PAGE
──/PAGE──┬─=nnn─┬───────────────────────────────────────────────
├─+nnn─┤
└─-nnn─┘
Where:
=nnn
Identifies the exact page number to be displayed.
+nnn
Identifies a relative number of pages to skip forward within the message.
-nnn
Identifies a relative number of pages to skip backward within the message.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters
Required: Yes
The last page in a message can be displayed by requesting a specific page (/PAGE=nnn)
and giving a high value for nnn (for example, 255).
PF7 and PF8 are temporarily overridden by online menus and their related formatted and
display screens to /PAGE-1 and /PAGE+1 respectively. For other displays, PA1 and
PA2 default to these same values if they have not been set to some other value during
initialization or by a /PA command.
2.22.3 Examples
/PAGE=4
Go to page four.
/PAGE+2
/PAGE-3
2.23 /PAnn
Use the /PAnn command to reassign PA keys. This can serve as a shortcut for doing
repetitive commands at the terminal (3270-type). Each terminal may have unique infor-
mation associated with a program access (PA) key, or certain basic commands may be
assigned to PA keys during initialization of CA-7. An individual at a terminal may reas-
sign PA keys set during initialization.
2.23.1 Syntax
/PAnn
──/PAnn──┬─────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─M───┬─=text─┘
└─MSG─┘
Where:
nn
Specifies the PA key to be assigned.
Size/Type: 2 numeric characters from 01 to 03
Leading zero is required
Required: Yes
MSG
Specifies the character string assigned to the key. MSG and M may be used inter-
changeably. If commas are included as part of the text, enclose the entire message
text in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
All /PA command assignments are carried across /LOGOFF and /LOGON command
sequences, but not across initializations of CA-7. Default values for PA keys, if not
overridden during initialization or by a /PA command, are:
2.23.3 Examples
/PA33,M=(/COPY,LT=TERMABC)
/PA31,M=LQUE
2.24 /PFnn
Use the /PFnn command to provide a shortcut method for doing repetitive commands at a
3270-type terminal. Each terminal may have unique information associated with a
program function (PF) key, or certain basic commands may be assigned to PF keys
during initialization of CA-7. Using the /PF command, an individual at a terminal may
reassign PF keys set during the initialization.
2.24.1 Syntax
/PFnn
──/PFnn──┬─────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─M───┬─=text─┘
└─MSG─┘
Where:
nn
Specifies the PF key to be assigned. Value is 99 to cancel all assignments made
with previous /PF and /PA commands.
Size/Type: 2 numeric characters from 01 to 24
Leading zero is required
Required: Yes
MSG
Specifies the character string assigned to the key. MSG and M may be used inter-
changeably. If commas are included as part of the text, enclose the entire message
text in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
/PF99 cancels all /PF and /PA command assignments on that terminal for both PA and PF
keys. (The assignments in the initialization file are not removed.) If entered with no
parameters (for example, /PF01), the character string assigned to the key by a previous
/PF command is removed. (The assignments in the initialization file are not removed.)
All /PF command assignments are carried across /LOGOFF and /LOGON command
sequences, but not across initializations of CA-7. It should be emphasized that /PF
command assignments are associated with terminals. This is an important consideration if
virtual terminals are used.
Default values for PF keys, if not overridden during initialization or by a /PF command,
are:
PF1 - /PURGPG
PF2 - /COPY
PF3 - /NXTMSG
In a VTAM environment, a PF key is normally assigned as the VTAM logoff key in the
initialization file. If this assignment is not made to one of the keys and a /PF or /PA
command has not been used to define a /CLOSE command, the /CLOSE top line
command must be used for that purpose.
2.24.3 Examples
/PF34,M=LQ
/PF39,M=(/ECHO,M=(LJOB,JOB=#))
/PF36,MSG=(/FETCH)
2.25 /PROF
Use the /PROF command to list and manage your CA-7 user profile. The user profile is
stored in the CA-7 database and contains personal PA/PF key settings and an external
UID resource name (see 2.35, “/UID” on page 2-72 and the CA-7 Security Guide). When
you log on to CA-7, the PA/PF key settings from your user profile are set up for your
terminal session automatically. Also, if you do not specify an external UID resource
name on the CA-7 Logon screen, it is taken from the user profile if it has been defined
there.
Note: User profile PA/PF key settings override terminal and default PA/PF key settings
from the CA-7 initialization file with one exception. The PA/PF key which is
defined as the VLOGOFF key is NOT overridden by the user profile settings.
If you issue the /PROF command without any operands, the current values in your user
profile are listed.
2.25.1 Syntax
/PROF
──/PROF──┬───────────────────┬──┬───────────────────────────┬────
└─,EXRSLV=─┬─NO──┬──┘ └─,─┬─K────┬─=─┬─CLEAR───┬──┘
└─YES─┘ └─KEYS─┘ ├─PROFILE─┤
└─SAVE────┘
──┬────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬───────────────────────
└─,R=uidname─┘ └─,─┬─ST─────┬─=DELETE─┘
└─STATUS─┘
Where:
EXRSLV
Indicates whether extended RESOLV messages should be produced when you issue a
RESOLV command. These messages (SRC1-137) can be produced when a
job/network is scheduled on the same day by two or more schedule IDs.
Required: No. The extended RESOLV message option can be overridden using
the DUPDATE= keyword on the RESOLV command itself.
KEYS
Indicates the action to be taken with PA/PF keys.
SAVE
Causes your current terminal PA/PF key settings to be saved in your user profile.
The current terminal key settings are defined by using the /PAnn and /PFnn
commands. To determine your current settings, issue /DISPLAY,ST=KEY. The
definitions under the heading ---- TERMINAL ---- are the settings that are saved
to your profile. Other PA/PF key settings under the headings Initialization and
Defaults are NOT saved. If you already have PA/PF key settings in your user
profile, they are NOT merged with the new settings.
PROFILE
Causes your current terminal PA/PF key settings to be replaced by the defi-
nitions in your user profile. PROF and PROFILE may be used interchangeably.
If you have made temporary changes to your current settings with the /PAnn
and/or /PFnn commands, you can return to your profile definitions by using
KEYS=PROFILE.
CLEAR
Causes the PA/PF key settings in your user profile to be cleared. Once cleared,
these settings cannot be recovered. You have to define new settings to your
current session using the /PAnn and/or /PFnn commands and then save them
using KEYS=SAVE. If you wish to clear only the settings for your current ter-
minal session, use the /PF99 command.
R
Indicates the resource name defined in the UID resource table to be used as your
default at logon time. If you explicitly specify a resource name on the CA-7 Logon
screen, it overrides the value in your user profile.
Note: The resource name specified is NOT validated against the current UID
resource table, nor is it checked against external security at the time it is
placed in the profile record. These checks are made if the resource name is
used at logon time.
STATUS=DELETE
Indicates the entire user profile record should be deleted from the database. If used,
this keyword must be the only one coded. ST and STATUS may be used inter-
changeably.
2.25.2 Examples
For example:
PF31 /ECHO,M=(/DISPLAY,ST=KEY)
PF32 /ECHO,M=(/DISPLAY,ST=ALL)
PF36 /NXTMSG
PF19 /PAGE-1
PF23 /PAGE+1
PF23 /ECHO,M=(/PURGPG)
2.26 /PROFS
Use the /PROFS command to list and manage other users' CA-7 user profiles. The user
profile is stored in the CA-7 database and contains personal PA/PF key settings and a
UID resource name (see 2.35, “/UID” on page 2-72). When you log on to CA-7, the
PA/PF key settings from your user profile are set up for your terminal session automat-
ically. Also, if you do not specify an external UID resource name on the CA-7 Logon
screen, it is taken from the user profile if it has been defined there.
Note: User profile PA/PF key settings override terminal and default PA/PF key settings
from the CA-7 initialization file with one exception. The PA/PF key which is
defined as the VLOGOFF key is NOT overridden by the user profile settings.
If you issue the /PROFS command with only the ID= operand, the current settings in that
user's profile are listed.
2.26.1 Syntax
/PROFS
──/PROFS──,ID=opid──┬───────────────────┬────────────────────────
└─,EXRSLV=─┬─NO──┬──┘
└─YES─┘
──┬───────────────────────────┬──┬────────────┬───────────────────
└─,─┬─K────┬─=─┬─CLEAR───┬──┘ └─,R=resname─┘
└─KEYS─┘ ├─PROFILE─┤
└─SAVE────┘
──┬──────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─ST─────┬─=DELETE─┘
└─STATUS─┘
Where:
ID
The operator ID (1 to 8 character userid) for the user profile you wish to display or
update.
EXRSLV
Indicates whether extended RESOLV messages should be produced when the target
user issues a RESOLV command. These messages (SRC1-137) can be produced
when a job/network is scheduled on the same day by two or more schedule IDs.
Required: No. The extended RESOLV message option can be overridden using
the DUPDATE= keyword on the RESOLV command itself.
KEYS
Indicates the action to be taken with PA/PF keys.
SAVE
Causes YOUR current terminal PA/PF key settings to be saved in the user
profile for the ID= user. The current terminal key settings are defined by using
the /PAnn and /PFnn commands. To determine your current settings, issue
/DISPLAY,ST=KEY. The definitions under the heading ---- TERMINAL ----
are the settings that are saved into the profile. Other PA/PF key settings under
the headings Initialization and Defaults are NOT saved. If there are already
PA/PF key settings in the user profile, they are NOT merged with the new set-
tings.
PROFILE
Causes YOUR current terminal PA/PF key settings to be replaced by the defi-
nitions in the ID= user's profile. PROF and PROFILE may be used interchange-
ably. You can return to your own profile settings by issuing
/PROF,KEYS=PROFILE.
CLEAR
Causes the PA/PF key settings in the ID= user's user profile to be cleared. Once
cleared, these settings cannot be recovered.
R
Indicates the resource name defined in the UID resource table to be used by the ID=
user as his/her default at logon time. If they explicitly specify a resource name on
the CA-7 Logon screen, it overrides the value in their user profile.
Note: The resource name specified is NOT validated against the current UID
resource table, nor is it checked against external security at the time it is
placed in the profile record. These checks are made if the resource name is
used at logon time.
STATUS=DELETE
Indicates the entire user profile record should be deleted from the database. ST and
STATUS may be used interchangeably. If used, this keyword must be the only one
coded.
2.26.2 Examples
For example, to set up default PA/PF keys for other users, you must first define them to
your current terminal session using the /PA and/or /PF commands. You can then save
these definitions into their profile (/PROFS,ID=userid,KEYS=SAVE).
Another way to accomplish this is to fetch the PA/PF key settings from an existing
profile into your current terminal session; then save them into another user's profile; then
return to your own profile settings. For example:
Note: The /PROF, /PROFS, /PA, and /PF commands can all be executed in batch using
the BTI facility. So you can set up a batch command deck that defines all the
PA/PF keys and SAVES them into one or more user profiles. For example:
2.27 /PURGPG
Use the /PURGPG command to delete additional pages of an output message which are
queued. All queued output for a logical terminal may also be deleted using a form of this
command.
2.27.1 Syntax
/PURGPG
──/PURGPG──┬──────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─LT────┬─=station─┘
└─LTERM─┘
Where:
LTERM
Specifies the logical terminal (station) from which queued output is to be purged.
LTERM and LT may be used interchangeably. If no logical terminal is specified
(that is, LTERM is omitted), only the pages of the currently displayed message are
purged.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.27.3 Examples
/PURGPG
/PURGPG,LTERM=INPUT
2.28 /REFRESH
Use the /REFRESH command to refresh the UID resource table that was loaded during
CA-7 initialization without cycling CA-7.
2.28.1 Syntax
/REFRESH
──/REFRESH──,MOD=membername─────────────────────────────────────
Where:
MOD=membername
Identifies a UID resource table in load module format that was built using the
CA7RTBL macro. This must be the member name of the UID resource table and it
must reside in a load library accessible to CA-7.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
Note: See CA-7 Security Guide for a discussion of the CA-7 UID resource table.
2.29 /RELINK
Use the /RELINK command to dynamically load a new copy of a CA-7 module without
having to shut CA-7 down.
2.29.1 Syntax
/RELINK
──/RELINK──,─┬─A────┬─=SASSxxxx──┬──────────────────┬───────────
└─APPL─┘ └─,─┬─U──────┬─=xx─┘
└─USERID─┘
OR
/RELINK
──/RELINK──,─┬─FM─────┬─=─┬─SFMxyyyy─┬───┬──────────────────┬───
└─FMTBLK─┘ └─SCALyyyy─┘ └─,─┬─U──────┬─=xx─┘
└─USERID─┘
Where:
APPL
Identifies the CA-7 program module to be relinked. A and APPL may be used inter-
changeably, but one or the other must be specified to relink a program module. Both
must be omitted if FM or FMTBLK is to be used. Value must be the module name
in the format SASSxxxx where xxxx is the last 4 characters of a module name.
Size/Type: 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
FMTBLK
Identifies the CA-7 format block/calendar block to be relinked. FM and FMTBLK
may be used interchangeably, but one or the other must be specified to relink a
format block of a calendar module. Both must be omitted if A or APPL is to be
used.
Size/Type: 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
SFMxyyyy
Specifies format block name where x is A for batch, H for online, and yyyy is
the last 4 characters of a module name.
SCALyyyy
Specifies calendar block name where yyyy is the last 4 characters of a module
name.
USERID
Specifies a prefix to replace the first 2 characters of the standard module name. U
and USERID may be used interchangeably. Value, if used, may be any 2 characters
with the first being alphabetic.
Size/Type: 2 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.29.3 Examples
/RELINK,APPL=SASSSCM5
/RELINK,A=SASSSP33,USERID=XX
/RELINK,FMTBLK=SFMASDM3,U=ZZ
/RELINK,FM=SFMHSCRJ
/RELINK,FM=SCAL33XX
2.30 /RESET
Use the /RESET command to reset the CA-7 assigned job numbers to begin again with
job number 1. Numbers in use at the time of the command are skipped.
2.30.1 Syntax
/RESET
──/RESET────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.31 /SHUTDOWN
Use the /SHUTDOWN command to cause a normal termination of CA-7 execution. Due
to the impact of shutting down CA-7, you should use the /SHUTDOWN command with
caution.
The /SHUTDOWN command may only be used by a terminal specified as the Master or
Alternate Master (CONS=MASTR or CONS=ALTRN on the TERM statement in the
initialization file).
You can set default /SHUTDOWN options on the OPTIONS statement in the CA-7
initialization file. These options take effect if you enter /SHUTDOWN with no parame-
ters.
2.31.1 Syntax
/SHUTDOWN
──/SHUTDOWN──,──┬──────┬────────────────────────────────────────
├─DMPQ─┤
└─Zn───┘
Where:
DMPQ
Specifies that the CA-7 queues, except the SCRQ and DQTQ are to be unloaded
during the shutdown process. These queues are unloaded to the CA-7 queue dump
file. The data in the queues is not deleted, only read. If only DMPQ is specified,
CA-7 does not terminate until all batch terminal processing is completed and all
online terminals are logged off.
Note: The VRM database component contains "active" resource records which
relate to jobs currently in the CA-7 queues. These active records are dumped
to the VRM dump queue file ddname CA7VDMP and are date/time stamped
to match the queue record(s) to ensure synchronization during MOVQ proc-
essing.
Required: No
Zn
Specifies the method of shutdown as follows:
Z1
Specifies a "fast" shutdown of CA-7. Messages are not sent to the individual
terminals and CA-7 does not wait for them to log off, but waits for batch termi-
nals to complete.
Z2
Specifies that shutdown is to occur even if batch terminals are still active but
waits for online terminals to log off.
Z3
Specifies that shutdown is to occur even if online and/or batch terminals are
active.
Z4
A combination of Z1 and DMPQ.
Z5
A combination of Z3 and DMPQ.
Note: If a form of Zn is not specified, CA-7 does not terminate until all termi-
nals have logged off. No batch terminals can be active.
For online terminals, a verification process is required before shutdown can occur. After
the /SHUTDOWN command is entered, CA-7 is put in a shutdown status. The terminal
that entered the shutdown receives a message indicating the options entered for the shut-
down. If the displayed options are correct, then shutdown occurs when Enter is pressed.
If the options are not correct, the /SHUTDOWN command can be changed and reentered.
When two /SHUTDOWN commands with the same options are entered consecutively,
CA-7 shuts down.
If you specified a default shutdown type in the CA-7 initialization file, you can enter the
/SHUTDOWN command without any parameters, and the default option is selected for
normal termination of CA-7.
If a batch terminal requested the shutdown, only one SHUTDOWN command is required
to shut down the system.
While in the shutdown mode (and until Enter is pressed or two /SHUTDOWN com-
mands with the same options are entered), other terminals entering commands receive a
CA07.010 UNIDENTIFIED COMMAND message.
The terminal that entered the /SHUTDOWN command is allowed to enter certain slash (/)
commands (/LOGOFF, /DISPLAY, and so on) between the "consecutive" /SHUTDOWN
commands. If an invalid command is entered while CA-7 is in shutdown mode, the ter-
minal receives an error message stating that the command must be /SHUTDOWN. CA-7
may be shut down without terminating ICOM if CA-7 controlled jobs are still active in
OS. However, if CA-7 is to be down for a long period of time, it is recommended that
ICOM be stopped.
2.32 /START
Use the /START command for restarting line groups and terminals following correction
of an I/O error or after the line or terminal has been stopped with a /STOP command.
2.32.1 Syntax
/START
──/START──┬──────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬─────────
└─,─┬─L────┬─=line─┘ └─,─┬─LT────┬─=station─┘
└─LINE─┘ └─LTERM─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────┬─────────
└─,─┬─M───┬─=PROMPTS─┘ └─,─┬─T────┬─=─┬─terminal─┬──┘
└─MSG─┘ └─TERM─┘ └─ALL──────┘
Where:
LINE
Indicates the line to be started. L and LINE may be used interchangeably. One or
the other is required when starting an entire line. When starting a terminal, LINE or
L may also be given to qualify the terminal name. Both must be omitted if LTERM
(or LT) is specified.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
LTERM
Indicates a logical terminal (station) for which activities involving output are to be
started. LT and LTERM may be used interchangeably. One or the other is required
when the command is to impact a logical terminal. Both must be omitted if LINE
(or L) or TERM (or T) is specified.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
MSG
Indicates prompting for a specific logical terminal is to be started. MSG is required
to invoke this function. However, it may only be used with LTERM (or LT). Value
if used must be MSG=PROMPTS.
Required: Yes - for LTERM option
TERM
Indicates a real terminal is to be started. TERM or T may be used interchangeably.
One or the other must be used to start a terminal.
terminal
Specifies the terminal name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
ALL
Specifies restart all terminals.
2.32.3 Examples
/START,T=RTERM1
/START,LTERM=KEYPUNCH
/START,L=VLINE,T=ALL
2.33 /STOP
Use the /STOP command to stop line groups and terminals started by the /START
command. You may use it to stop a terminal having I/O errors.
2.33.1 Syntax
/STOP
──/STOP──┬──────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬──────────
└─,─┬─L────┬─=line─┘ └─,─┬─LT────┬─=station─┘
└─LINE─┘ └─LTERM─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────┬─────────
└─,─┬─M───┬─=PROMPTS─┘ └─,─┬─T────┬─=─┬─terminal─┬──┘
└─MSG─┘ └─TERM─┘ └─ALL──────┘
Where:
LINE
Indicates the line to be stopped. L and LINE may be used interchangeably. One or
the other is required when stopping an entire line. When stopping a terminal, LINE
(or L) may also be given to qualify the terminal name. Both must be omitted if
LTERM (or LT) is specified. Value for either usage must be the line name, up to 7
characters.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
LTERM
Indicates a logical terminal (station) for which activities involving output are to be
stopped. LT and LTERM may be used interchangeably. One or the other is required
when the command is to impact a logical terminal. Both must be omitted if LINE
(or L) or TERM (or T) is specified.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
MSG
Indicates prompting for a specific logical terminal is to be stopped. MSG is required
to invoke this function. However, it may only be used with LTERM (or LT). Value
if used must be MSG=PROMPTS.
Required: Yes - for LTERM option
TERM
Indicates a real or batch terminal is to be stopped. TERM (or T) may be used inter-
changeably. One or the other must be used to stop a terminal.
terminal
Specifies the real or batch terminal name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
ALL
Specifies to stop all terminals started by the /START command.
2.33.3 Examples
/STOP,L=VLINE
/STOP,LINE=RLINE1,TERM=ALL
/STOP,LTERM=DATACNTL,MSG=PROMPTS
2.34 /SWAP
Use the /SWAP command to cause CA-7 to switch log record recording to an alternate
log file. This in turn causes the current log file to be closed and the log dump job to be
automatically submitted.
Alternating DASD log files must have been defined with ALOG1 and ALOG2 statements
in the initialization file for this command to be useful.
2.34.1 Syntax
/SWAP
──/SWAP─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.35 /UID
Use the /UID command to alter the current user's UID security level. The /UID
command is valid only in environments where external security controls CA-7 logons.
2.35.1 Syntax
/UID
──/UID──,R=resname──────────────────────────────────────────────
or
/UID
──/UID──,LIST───────────────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
R
Indicates the resource name defined in the UID resource table.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
LIST
Displays the UID resource table loaded during CA-7 initialization.
2.35.2 Examples
Example 1:
/UID,R=CA73255
Example 2:
/UID,R=R993BAD
2.36 /WLB
Use the /WLB command to change the workload balancing function of the CA-7 system.
For additional information see the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide.
2.36.1 Syntax
/WLB
──/WLB──,SET=─┬─ON──┬───────────────────────────────────────────
└─OFF─┘
or
/WLB
──/WLB──,SET=─┬─CLASSx─┬───,BARR=count/+count/-count────────────
├─INITS──┤
├─MINJOB─┤
├─T1TAV──┤
├─T1MAX──┤
├─T2TAV──┤
└─T2MAX──┘
Where:
SET
Indicates whether to activate or deactivate the workload balancing function.
ON
Specifies to activate the workload balancing function.
OFF
Specifies to deactivate the workload balancing function. Workload balancing
remains off until the system is brought down or until it is reactivated manually
with SET=ON.
SET
Indicates the selection parameter to be adjusted. Specify one of the following values:
CLASSx
Specifies class barrier x, where x is A-Z or 0-9
INITS
Specifies total initiators
MINJOB
Specifies minimum jobs to schedule
T1TAV
Specifies available type 1 tapes
T1MAX
Specifies maximum allowable type 1 tapes
T2TAV
Specifies total available type 2 tapes
T2MAX
Specifies maximum allowable type 2 tapes
BARR
Denotes the number to replace or adjust the current value. An unsigned value
replaces the current value. Signed values indicate an amount by which the current
value is to be adjusted. Any value that causes a barrier to exceed its maximum (255)
causes the barrier to be set to its maximum.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 255
Required: Yes, unless SET=ON or OFF
2.37 /WTO
Use the /WTO command to send a free-form message to the OS master console. This
command is allowed from a CA-7 trailer step.
2.37.1 Syntax
/WTO
──/WTO──,─┬─M───┬─=text─────────────────────────────────────────
└─MSG─┘
Where:
MSG
Specifies the message that is sent to the OS master console. MSG and M may be
used interchangeably, but one or the other is required. If commas are included as
part of the text, enclose the entire message text in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 60 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.37.2 Examples
The first example would appear on the CA-7 job or JES log listing as:
Where:
ttttttt Is the terminal from which the message originated.
2.38 ADDRQ
Use the ADDRQ command to manually add temporary, onetime, preexecution user or
predecessor job requirements. These requirements must be added to the job while it is in
the CA-7 request queue. These added requirements apply only to the current run of the
job. User requirements must be manually satisfied with the QM.2 screen (POST) or
XRQ command before the job executes. Predecessor job requirements are satisfied auto-
matically when the predecessor job completes successfully.
2.38.1 Syntax
ADDRQ
──ADDRQ──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬───,─┬─DEPJOB=depjob─┬──────────────
└─jobnumber─┘ └─USR=text──────┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job to which the job requirement is to be added. The job must be in
the request queue.
Required: Yes
jobname
Specifies the job name to which the requirement is to be added for this run of
the job.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Specifies the CA-7 job number to which the requirement is to be added for this
run of the job.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
DEPJOB
Defines a temporary onetime job dependency requirement. The DEPJOB value spec-
ifies the job name which must complete execution or be manually posted complete
before the job identified by JOB is eligible for submission. DEPJOB is required
unless USR is used, in which case DEPJOB must be omitted. This requirement is
satisfied automatically when the predecessor job completes. Only in unusual situ-
ations would this requirement need to be satisfied manually. That is, any time that a
normal completion did not occur.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, unless USR is used
USR
Defines the description of a temporary, onetime user requirement. This requirement
must be manually satisfied before the job identified by JOB is eligible for sub-
mission. If commas are included as part of the text, enclose the entire requirements
text in parentheses. USR is required unless DEPJOB is used, in which case USR
must be omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 36 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, unless DEPJOB is used
The ADDRQ command only updates the record of the job in the request queue, not the
database. These requirements are flagged on QM.2 displays with an A in the E column.
2.38.3 Examples
ADDRQ,JOB=17,DEPJOB=PAYJOB1
ADDRQ,JOB=XYZ,DEPJOB=ABC
2.39 ADDSCH
Use the ADDSCH command to delay scheduled start and due-out times for up to 24
hours.
After a job has entered a queue, it is sometimes necessary to delay the scheduled start
time or due-out time. It may even be necessary to delay the entire workload already in a
queue to react to a major unexpected and unscheduled change in the environment.
2.39.1 Syntax
ADDSCH
──ADDSCH──,──┬─JOB=─┬─nnnn─┬──┬──,TIME=mmmm─────────────────────
│ ├─ALL──┤ │
│ └─ALLP─┘ │
└─REF=nnnnrrss───┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose schedule times should be delayed. JOB is required unless
REF is used, in which case JOB must be omitted.
Required: Yes
nnnn
Specifies the job number of a single job assigned by CA-7.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
ALL
Specifies all jobs and workstation entries in the request, ready, active, and
postprocess queues.
ALLP
Specifies all jobs and workstation entries including those in the preprocess
queue.
REF
Specifies a particular workstation task within a network (and all subsequent stations)
whose schedule(s) should be delayed. REF is required if JOB is not used.
nnnnrrs
Specifies a workstation task reference number assigned by CA-7.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
nnnn
Is the CA-7 job number.
rr
Is the relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associ-
ated with the job. For input networks, the value is 00.
s
Identifies the position of the station within the network. The first station
would be position 1.
TIME
Specifies the amount of time to be added to the start time and due-out time of the
job(s) or workstation(s) indicated. Value must be in minutes.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters from 1 to 1440
Required: Yes
When schedules are delayed using the ADDSCH command, prompting is based on the
adjusted start time and due-out time.
The use of this command only affects the due-out-time and deadline start-time of a job,
which in turn affects when the job or task is late. If job submission is not to occur, a
requirement needs to be added to a job.
2.39.3 Examples
ADDSCH,JOB=143,TIME=123
ADDSCH,JOB=ALLP,TIME=1443
ADDSCH,REF=12331,TIME=633
2.40 AL/ALC
Use the AL command to allocate a DASD data set. The ALC command allocates and
catalogs a DASD data set. This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNC-
TION value 1 or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.1.
2.40.1 Syntax
AL ALC
──┬─AL──┬──,DSN=dsname──,VOL=volume──────────────────────────────
└─ALC─┘
──,SP=(type,primary,─┬───────────┬─,─┬────────────────┬─)─────────
└─secondary─┘ └─directory-blks─┘
──,DCB=(recfm,lrecl,blksize)─────────────────────────────────────
Where:
DSN
Specifies the fully qualified name of the data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Specifies the volume serial number on which the data set is to be allocated. The
volume must have been made available to CA-7 with a U7volser type of DD state-
ment as discussed in the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide, or 2.41, “ALLOC” on
page 2-82.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
SP
Indicates space allocation. For each of the following parameters, a comma must be
coded for each parameter that is omitted or the default value is assumed. Parameters
used must be enclosed in parentheses.
type
Must be either T for tracks or C for cylinders.
Default: T
primary
Indicates primary space allocation amount.
Size/Type: 1 to 5 numeric characters
Required: Yes
secondary
Indicates an optional secondary space allocation amount.
Size/Type: 1 to 5 numeric characters
Required: No
directory-blks
Indicates the number of directory blocks to be allocated for a PDS data set. If
the number of directory blocks is zero, DSORG=PS is assumed. If nonzero,
DSORG=PO is assumed.
Size/Type: 1 to 5 numeric characters
Default: 0
DCB
Specifies the data control block (DCB) attributes. Parameters must be in parentheses.
recfm
Indicates the record format. Value must be F, FB, V, VB, VBS, VS, U, FA,
FBA, FM, FBM, VA, VBA, VM, or VBM.
Required: Yes
lrecl
Indicates the logical record length.
Size/Type: 1 to 5 numeric characters
Default: 0
blksize
Indicates the block size of the data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 5 numeric characters
Default: 0
2.40.2 Examples
AL,DSN=USER.FILE1,VOL=VOLMO1,SP=(T,2),DCB=(F,83,83)
ALC,DSN=USER.TEMP,VOL=VOLMO1,SP=(T,5),DCB=(FB,64,643)
2.41 ALLOC
Use the ALLOC command to dynamically allocate a volume not defined by a DD card in
the execution JCL for CA-7. The dynamically allocated ddname is U7 followed by the
volume serial number. See 2.167, “SCRATCH” on page 2-504 for an example of the
DD name format. This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION
value 11 or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.11.
2.41.1 Syntax
ALLOC
──ALLOC──,VOL=volume──,UNIT=unit────────────────────────────────
Where:
VOL
Indicates the volume for which allocation is desired.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
UNIT
Indicates the unit name for the type of DASD device desired (for example, 3380,
DISK, SYSDA).
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.41.2 Examples
ALLOC,VOL=DISK31,UNIT=3383
2.42 APA
Use this menu screen for online access to graphing facilities for each of the available
categories of graphs. It has no equivalent in batch mode.
To display, enter:
APA as a top line command.
APA as the function value on any other menu or formatted input screen.
To exit, enter:
a command on the top line.
the name of any other formatted screen as the FUNCTION.
< =
----------------- CA-7 AUTOMATED PERFORMANCE ANALYSIS MENU -----------------
FUNCTION ===>
K L
2.42.1.1 Usage Notes
Select the desired function by entering the appropriate number in the FUNCTION field
and pressing Enter. The 2.42.2, “APA Prompt Screen” on page 2-84 is returned. You
may request specific graphing options with that screen.
You can find more information on APA graphs and their descriptions in the CA-7 Reports
Guide.
To display, enter:
an option on the APA menu screen.
AP.n as a top line command where n is one of the menu options.
AP.n as a FUNCTION value on another formatted screen.
GRAPH as a top line command.
GRAPH as the function value on any other formatted screen.
one of the GRAPHc top line commands without any other keywords.
This screen also displays when an error occurs on an online top line GRAPHc command.
< =
---------------- CA-7 AUTOMATED PERFORMANCE ANALYSIS PROMPT ----------------
FUNCTION ===> xxxxxxxx CATEGORY: x (xxxxxxxx)
DESIRED GRAPHS:
ID1: nnnn ID2: nnnn ID3: nnnn ID4: nnnn ID5: nnnn
ID6: nnnn ID7: nnnn ID8: nnnn ID9: nnnn ID13: nnnn
TEMPORARY OVERRIDES:
SCALE: nnnnnnn DIV1: nnnnnn DIV2: nnnnnnn (UP TO 7 DIGITS EACH)
GLINE: x (P = PRIM, S = SCND, C = CALC)
The CATEGORY field can be changed and is blank if command GRAPH is entered.
This screen appears with CATEGORY filled in if one of the APA commands is entered
without other keywords; that is, GRAPHS would produce this screen with CATEGORY
of S.
2.42.2.2 Fields
FUNCTION
Function desired. Optional. Acceptable values are:
G Displays graphs specified by the CATEGORY and ID fields on this screen.
This is the default.
C Displays contents of current counters for every graph specified by the CATE-
GORY field. Same as LIST=ALL option on equivalent top line command.
D Displays graph format parameter definitions for every graph specified by the
CATEGORY field. Same as LIST=DETL option on equivalent top line
command.
H Displays directory list of every ID and title specified by the CATEGORY
field. Same as LIST=HELP option on equivalent top line command.
The name of any other formatted screen may be entered.
CATEGORY
Graph category. Required field. If accessed from the APA Menu screen, with a
DB.n command or FUNCTION, or with a top line GRAPHc command without any
other keywords, this is completed for you. May be changed if desired. If accessed
through the GRAPH command (or function), this must be entered. Descriptive
name of the category is enclosed in parentheses following the value. Categories
and their descriptive names are as follows:
D DATABASE
J JOBS
N NETWORKS
R REPORTS
S SYSTEM
??????? indicates a category value is needed.
DIV2
Temporary override to division factor for the secondary counter for each graph
requested. Up to 7 digits. Optional field. Same as keyword DIV2 on equivalent
top line command. Function D or top line command with LIST=DETL lists the
predefined value under the heading DIV2 if one exists. Only valid if a value is
shown there. When used, each graph defined in the ID fields must be the type
which has a predefined DIV2 value.
GLINE
Temporary override to which value is used on the graph line. Optional field.
Similar to keyword GLINE on equivalent top line command. Function D or top
line command with LIST=DETL lists the predefined values. If that list indicates
PRIM under the GRAPH heading for a graph, PRIM is the only valid option for
that graph. When used, each graph defined in the ID fields must be compatible
with the value entered here.
Enter the desired values and press Enter. The entered values are converted into the
equivalent top line command and processed accordingly. That top line command is
echoed at the top of the resulting displays. It may be modified to perform another
display or any other top line command may be entered in its place. See the discussion of
2.83, “GRAPHc” on page 2-195 for further information on the keywords used with that
top line command technique.
This screen allows data to be entered that could require more than the maximum of 80
characters to be echoed on the top line of the resulting display screens. Functions H, D,
and C require less than 80. Fields which cannot entirely fit into the available space for
the command echo are dropped completely from the echo even though they are being
processed. Fields are placed in the echo area in the sequence in which they appear on the
screen. If no value was entered, nothing is echoed.
The display may require multiple screens to complete. The last screen has a message at
the bottom indicating "request completed."
PF7 and PF8 are temporarily overridden to page backward/forward for ease in browsing
any multipage display that may occur. If PF7 or PF8 were set to some other values by
the user, those values are temporarily ignored. They revert back to the values defined by
the user whenever PF3 or a top line command is entered.
2.43 ARFP
Use the ARFP command to purge the ARF requirement for a job in the request, ready, or
active queue.
2.43.1 Syntax
ARFP
──ARFP──,JOB=jobnumber──┬────────────┬──────────────────────────
└─,FORCE=YES─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the unique CA-7 job number (leading zeros not required) for the job whose
ARF requirements are to be purged.
FORCE
Forces the purging of the ARF requirement for a job even if it does not exist in the
request, ready, or active queue.
2.43.2 Example
ARFP,JOB=23
2.44 ARTS
If you have installed the CA-7 CA-11 interface, you can use the ARTS command to
interface directly with CA-11. See the CA-7 Interfaces Guide for more information on
the CA-7 CA-11 interface and the ARTS command.
2.45 AR.3
You can find more information on defining ARF conditions using the AR.3 command in
the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide.
2.46 BLDG
Use the BLDG command to build a generation data group (GDG) index. This command
is valid only for CVOL catalogs.
Note: It is not valid for VSAM or ICF catalogs.
This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 6 or on any other
menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.6.
2.46.1 Syntax
BLDG
──BLDG──,INDX=index──,ENTRIES=nnn──┬────────────────────┬───────
│ ┌─DELETE─┐ │
└─,FULL=─┴─EMPTY──┴──┘
Where:
INDX
Indicates the name of the GDG index.
Size/Type: 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
ENTRIES
Indicates the number of entries to be contained in the GDG index.
Size/Type: 1 to 255 numeric characters
Required: Yes
FULL
Indicates action to be taken once the ENTRIES value is exceeded.
Default: DELETE
Required: No
DELETE
Indicates the oldest entry is to be removed.
EMPTY
Indicates all entries are to be removed.
2.46.2 Examples
BLDG,INDX=USER.FILE.MONTHLY,ENTRIES=2
BLDG,INDX=USER.FILE.DAILY,ENTRIES=7,FULL=EMPTY
BLDG,INDX=USER.DAILY.FILE1,ENTRIES=33,FULL=DELETE
See the CA-7 Message Guide, message UTL5-14, for further discussion of restrictions and
guidelines on the use of BLDG.
2.47 CALMOD
Use the CALMOD command to display the DB.2.8 Base Calendar Maintenance screen.
You can find more information on this screen in the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide.
2.47.1 Syntax
CALMOD
──CALMOD────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.48 CANCEL
Use the CANCEL command to delete jobs from the CA-7 queues. This command only
removes the job from the CA-7 queues. Cancelation of a job in the CA-7 active queue or
ready queue (if it has been submitted) does not cause termination of the job's execution.
CPU jobs which may be executing have to be canceled from the operating system sepa-
rately. Execution must be terminated from an OS system console. This function is avail-
able on the QM.1, QM.6, and QM.7 screens as option C. There are three formats of the
CANCEL command, depending on the queues in which the task resides.
2.48.1.1 Syntax
CANCEL
──CANCEL──,JOB=jobnumber────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
JOB
Specifies the unique CA-7 job number (leading zeros not required) for the work-
station network to be canceled.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes
2.48.2.1 Syntax
CANCEL
──CANCEL──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬───┬────────────┬───────────────────
└─jobnumber─┘ └─,FORCE=YES─┘
──┬──────────────┬───────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,REASON=text─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job to be canceled.
Required: Yes
jobnumber
Specifies the unique CA-7 job number (leading zeros not required) for the job to
be canceled.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
jobname
Allows canceling a job by job name if only one job with that name is present in
the request queue.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
FORCE
Forces the cancellation of the job. If the job to dump the log data set is to be can-
celed, FORCE=YES must be specified to prevent the job from being resubmitted.
FORCE=YES must be used when a job to be canceled shows a status of SKELETON
or RETRY. FORCE=YES must be used to cancel a job with connected resources.
Caution
Use of this option can potentially cause CA-7 to abend; therefore, it should only
be used as a last resort.
Required: No
REASON
Specifies the reason for the job cancellation. Depending on the initialization file
CANCEL statement value, this may be required or optional. If it is required but not
given, a message prompts the user to provide it. The text is entered into the run log
entry for this occurrence of this job and is displayed on any subsequent LRLOG
inquiries.
Size/Type: 1 to 40 alphanumeric characters
Required: No (depending on initialization options)
2.48.3.1 Syntax
CANCEL
──CANCEL──,JOB=jobnumber──┬───────────────────┬──────────────────
└─,NW=─┬─network─┬──┘
└─ALL─────┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
└─,SUBID=─┬─subid─┬──┘
└─ALL───┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the unique CA-7 job number (leading zeros not required) of the job whose
postprocess work is to be canceled.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes
NW
Specifies the network(s) to be canceled.
Required: No
network
Specifies the network name as previously defined in the database.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
ALL
Indicates all networks are to be canceled for the associated job.
SUBID
Specifies a further qualification of the network to be acted upon. SUBID is optional
unless it was specified when the network was demanded or is part of the database
definition of a regularly scheduled network. Since a single output workstation
network can be associated with a job multiple times and assigned unique SUBIDs for
differentiation, it is important to specify correct SUBIDs when canceling work.
Required: No
subid
Specifies the sub-ID value.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
ALL
Cancels network entries for the NW value specified no matter what sub-ID value
was used.
The record for the specified job is deleted from the appropriate queue, and if CA-11 is
used, an attempt is made to clear the CMT. See the CA-7 Interfaces Guide for further
discussion related to CA-11.
Obviously, canceling a job stops all triggering by the canceled job and does not satisfy
requirements for other jobs which may be dependent on the canceled job.
The job does not go through normal job completion; therefore, job triggering and require-
ment posting are not performed.
All output workstation networks for the canceled job are notified and their records are
deleted from the postprocess queue.
2.48.3.3 Examples
CANCEL,JOB=17
CANCEL,JOB=163,FORCE=YES
CANCEL,JOB=163
CANCEL,JOB=163,NW=ALL,SUBID=ALL
CANCEL,JOB=163,NW=REPTS
CANCEL,JOB=163,NW=REPTS,SUBID=ALL
CANCEL,JOB=163,NW=REPTS,SUBID=CA7HIST3
2.49 CAT
Use the CAT command to catalog a data set. This function is available on the UT Menu
screen as FUNCTION value 2 or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION
value UT.2.
2.49.1 Syntax
CAT
──CAT──,DSN=dsname──,VOL=─┬─volume─────────┬─────────────────────
│ ┌─,──────┐ │
!─volume─┴─)─┘
└─(──
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬────────┬──┬───────────────┬─────────
└─,─┬─DVC=xxxxxxxx─┬──┘ └─,SEQ=n─┘ └─,CVOL=cvolume─┘
└─UNIT=unit────┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set to be cataloged.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates from one to five volumes on which the data set resides.
Required: Yes
volume
Indicates the volume on which the data set resides.
(volume,...,volume)
Specifies from one to five volumes as a list. If more than one volume is speci-
fied, they must be enclosed in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
DVC
Indicates a hexadecimal device code. This field must be omitted if UNIT is speci-
fied.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
UNIT
Indicates the unit name of the type of device desired (generic equivalent of a device
code found in SASSUTBL (for example, 3350, DISK)). This field must be omitted
if DVC is specified.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
SEQ
Indicates the label sequence number.
Size/Type: 1 numeric character
Default: 0 for disk data sets, or
1 for tape data sets
Required: No
CVOL
Indicates the volume containing the catalog. This option is only valid for CVOL
catalog structures. If the catalog structure is ICF, it defaults to the IPL catalog.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: SYSRES (for CVOL catalog structures)
Required: No
You should update the module SASSUTBL to contain all user-defined generic names.
You may use a +1 generation number to catalog a new version of a generation data set.
2.49.3 Examples
CAT,DSN=USER.FILE1,VOL=DA3333
CAT,DSN=USER.FILE2,VOL=DA3333,DVC=33532339
CAT,DSN=USER.FILE3,VOL=DA3333,UNIT=3333
CAT,DSN=USER.TAPE,VOL=T13331,SEQ=3,DVC=34338333
CAT,DSN=USER.TAPE1,VOL=(T13332,T13333),UNIT=3433-3
CAT,DSN=USER.FILEX,VOL=DA3331,CVOL=ALTRES
2.50 CONN
Use the CONN command to connect high-level indexes from the SYSRES catalog to
another catalog.
Note: It is not valid for VSAM or ICF catalogs.
This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 8 or on any other
menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.8.
2.50.1 Syntax
CONN
──CONN──,INDX=index──┬─────────────┬────────────────────────────
└─,VOL=volume─┘
Where:
INDX
Indicates the name to be entered as a high-level index in the SYSRES catalog.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates the volume serial number of the connected volume. You may omit this
field to display the connected volume for the specified index. The connected volume
must be available to CA-7.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Default: SYSRES (for CVOL catalog structures)
Required: No
2.50.2 Examples
CONN,INDX=USER,VOL=ALTCAT
CONN,INDX=USER
2.51 CTLG
Use the CTLG command to maintain and modify the CA-7 index data set entries. The
primary use of data set entries in the index data set is to determine the availability of
input requirements for job scheduling. The three most current creations of each data set
(by CA-7 submitted jobs) are recorded in the index data set, regardless of whether the
data set is a GDG or not. The volume serial data in the index data set is informational
only, since the system catalog remains the source for locating data sets during job proc-
essing.
2.51.1 Syntax
CTLG
──CTLG──,DSN=dataset──,TYPE=─┬─ADD──┬───,VOL=volser──────────────
├─CON──┤
├─COPY─┤
├─DEL──┤
└─REPL─┘
──┬───────────────┬──┬──────────┬──┬──────────┬──────────────────
└─,DVC=nnnnnnnn─┘ └─,ENTRY=n─┘ └─,SEQ=nnn─┘
Where:
DSN
Specifies the data set name to be modified.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
TYPE
Specifies the CTLG function to be performed. Function must be one of the
following:
Required: Yes
ADD
For adding new entries for a data set already defined in the CA-7 database.
CON
For consolidating system and index data set entries.
COPY
For copying system catalog entries.
DEL
For deleting existing entries.
REPL
For replacing existing entries.
Processing for these CTLG functions is described on the following pages.
VOL
Specifies up to ten volume serial numbers on which the data set resides. (See 2.51.6,
“Processing for TYPE=REPL” on page 2-104 for replacing entries with more than
ten volumes.) When more than one volume serial number is coded, it must be
enclosed in parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
DVC
Specifies the device type code for the data set.
Size/Type: 8 digits - hexadecimal
Default: Device code of current entry
Required: No
ENTRY
Specifies which entry is to be deleted or replaced. ENTRY is required when
TYPE=DEL or TYPE=REPL. ENTRY=1 is the most recent.
Size/Type: 1 numeric character from 1 to 3
Required: No
SEQ
Specifies a label sequence.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters
Default: Label sequence of current entry
Required: No
2.51.3 Examples
2.51.3.1 Example 1
CTLG,DSN=CA7.DSN1,TYPE=ADD,VOL=DASD37
CTLG,DSN=CA7.TAPEDS,TYPE=ADD,VOL=(333331,333333)
CTLG,DSN=CA7.DSN2,TYPE=ADD,VOL=DASD-7,DVC=33532339,SEQ=1
2.51.3.2 Example 2
CTLG,DSN=CA7.DSN,TYPE=DEL,ENTRY=1
2.51.3.3 Example 3
CTLG,DSN=CA7.DSN1,TYPE=REPL,VOL=DASD38,ENTRY=1
CTLG,DSN=CA7.DSN2,TYPE=REPL,VOL=TAPE31,SEQ=3,ENTRY=2
2.51.3.4 Example 4
CTLG,DSN=CA7.DSN1,TYPE=CON
You can find hexadecimal values to be specified if DVC is used in an IBM Data Areas
Manual under UCBTYP field.
You cannot use the ADD function if a data set to be added resides on more than ten
volumes. Catalog the data set on the system catalog, and then use the COPY function of
the CTLG facility.
When adding GDGs, consider these items with respect to how the DSN is specified:
Relative generation numbers may not be used.
If an absolute generation number (for example, GnnnnVnn) is specified, that number
is used.
If no generation number is given and an entry currently exists, the current generation
number is incremented by 1 and used for the new entry.
If no generation number is given and no entry currently exists, G0001V00 is
assumed.
Adding an entry to record creation of an external data set is not required. However, if
the new version of the data set is cataloged before the using job is scheduled, the external
requirement is automatically satisfied by initial requirements scan when the job is sched-
uled. If the entry is added after scheduling of the user job, the external requirement must
be manually posted as satisfied.
You can find hexadecimal values to be specified if DVC is used in an IBM Data Areas
Manual under UCBTYP field.
You cannot use the REPL function if the data set entry to be replaced contains more than
ten volumes. Use the COPY function to obtain the replacement from the system catalog.
When replacing GDG entries, no generation number is needed. The generation of the
entry being replaced is used instead.
When copying GDGs, the most current generation in the system catalog is used.
If the entries disagree, the index data set entry is updated and the current date and time
are stored as creation date and time.
2.52 DB
The following table gives a brief description of the DB commands. For more informa-
tion, see the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide where they are fully described.
2.53 DCONN
Use the DCONN command to disconnect high-level indexes previously connected to the
SYSRES catalog with the CONN command or function 8 of UT Menu screen.
Note: This command is not valid for VSAM or ICF catalogs.
This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 9 or on any other
menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.9.
2.53.1 Syntax
DCONN
──DCONN──,INDX=index────────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
INDX
Indicates the name of the index to be deleted from the SYSRES catalog.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.53.2 Examples
DCONN,INDX=USER
DCONN,INDX=USERNODE
2.54 DEALLOC
Use the DEALLOC command to release volumes previously allocated with the ALLOC
command or function 11 of the UT Menu screen. This function is available on the UT
Menu screen as FUNCTION value 12 or on any other menu or formatted screen as
FUNCTION value UT.12.
2.54.1 Syntax
DEALLOC
──DEALLOC──,VOL=volume──────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
VOL
Identifies the volume whose allocation is to be released.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.54.2 Examples
DEALLOC,VOL=DISK31
Use the DEMAND command to force immediate scheduling of a job into the CA-7
request queue. Jobs which do not have definable processing cycles can be scheduled in
this manner. Demand scheduling may also be used to force early execution of jobs which
have defined processing cycles or to schedule jobs for the first time, before they have
been defined in the CA-7 database.
Use the DEMANDH command to indicate that the demanded job is to be placed on hold
in the request queue.
2.55.1 Syntax
DEMAND DEMANDH
──┬─DEMAND──┬──,JOB=jobname──┬──────────────────────────┬────────
└─DEMANDH─┘ └─,ARFSET=─┬─arfsetname─┬──┘
└─MMNONEMM───┘
──┬──────────┬──┬──────────┬──┬───────────────────┬───────────────
└─,CC=nnnn─┘ └─,CLASS=x─┘ └─,DATE=─┬─+nn───┬──┘
└─yyddd─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────┬───────────
(1)
└─,DEPJOB=jobname2─┘ └─,DOTM=hhmm─┘ └─,FROMNODE── ─┘
──┬──────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬────────────────
└─,─┬─JCLID=nnn─────┬──┘ │ ┌─3133─┐ │
└─JCLLIB=&x...x─┘ └─,LEADTM=─┴─hhmm─┴──┘
──┬───────────┬──┬──────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────
└─,PRTY=nnn─┘ └─,RO=─┬─EQ─┬──┘ │ ┌─1───┐ │
├─LT─┤ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
├─GT─┤
├─GE─┤
├─LE─┤
├─NE─┤
├─#S─┤
├─IG─┤
└─3──┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬───────────────────┬──┬───────────┬───────
└─,SET=─┬─NDB─┬──┘ └─,TIME=─┬─hhmm──┬──┘ └─,TYPE=RES─┘
├─NTR─┤ └─+hhmm─┘
└─SKP─┘
Note:
1 You cannot specify this keyword. See 2.55.2, “Usage Notes” on page 2-114.
Where:
JOB
Specifies the name of the job being demanded. Demanded jobs are placed in the
request queue and assigned a unique CA-7 job number.
ARFSET
Identifies the ARF set name used for this run of the job. If you specify **NONE**,
no ARF processing is performed for this run of the job.
Size/Type 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters or **NONE**
Required: No
CC
Used with RO (relational operator) to define the job-level condition codes used to
determine if a job executes successfully or not. If specified, this overrides the RO
defined for the job in the CA-7 database.
Size/Type 1 to 4 numeric characters from 0-4095
Default: DB.1 screen COND-CODE value if job defined to CA-7; otherwise 0.
Required: No
CLASS
Specifies the workload balancing class for resource checking.
Size/Type: 1 alphanumeric character
Required: No
DATE
Specifies due-out and submit dates.
Required: No, but if used, DOTM or TIME must be specified.
+nn
Specifies the number of days after the current date.
Size/Type: 1 to 2 numeric characters from 1 to 99
yyddd
Specifies the Julian date to run the job.
DEPJOB
Specifies a single predecessor job which must complete while demanded job is
waiting.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
DOTM
Specifies the due-out time-of-day for the job in hours (hh) and minutes (mm). If
omitted, the current time (when the DEMAND was processed) plus the lead time is
assumed.
If DOTM is specified on the DEMAND/DEMANDH command and the value given
is earlier than the current time, the due-out day is assumed to be the following day.
If DOTM and LEADTM are both omitted, then deadline start time is assumed to be
the current time plus the LEADTM.
Size/Type: hh= 1 to 2 numeric characters from 0 to 24
mm= 2 numeric characters from 00 to 59
Default: current time
Required: No (unless DATE is used, if so, DOTM or TIME must be specified)
JCLID
Identifies the JCL data set which contains the execution JCL to be submitted. If
used, the value must be a numeric INDEX associated with the desired JCL data set
(on the JCL statement in the initialization file). If the job is defined in the database,
the value must be the same as the value on the DB.1 screen. (See the CA-7 Systems
Programmer Guide for further information on the initialization file). This field or the
JCLLIB field is required if the job is not defined in the database. JCLID and
JCLLIB are mutually exclusive.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 254
Required: No, unless job is not defined in database
JCLLIB
Identifies the JCL data set which contains the execution JCL to submitted. If used,
the value must be a symbolic INDEX associated with the desired JCL data set (on
the JCL statement in the initialization file). If the job is defined in the database, the
value must be the same as the value on the DB.1 screen. (See the CA-7 Systems
Programmer Guide for further information on the initialization file). This field or the
JCLID field is required if the job is not defined in the database. JCLID and JCLLIB
are mutually exclusive.
Size/Type: 2 to 16 alphanumeric characters beginning with ampersand (&)
Required: No, unless job is not defined in database
Note: A dynamic allocation failure on a JCL data set specified by JCLLIB causes
the job to enter the request queue in SKELETON status.
LEADTM
Specifies the amount of elapsed time required to process the job. Indicates in hours
(hh) and minutes (mm) the elapsed time. The maximum value you can specify is
2400.
Size/Type: hh= 1 to 2 numeric characters from 0 to 24
mm= 2 numeric characters from 00 to 59
Default: 1 hour
Required: No
PRTY
Specifies the initial workload balancing priority.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 1 to 255
Required: No
RO
Indicates the relational operator of the condition code (CC) or if the step level #SCC
statements are being used in the job's JCL. If specified, this overrides the RO defined
for the job in the CA-7 database. Values are:
EQ Equal to
LT Less than
GT Greater than
GE Greater than or equal to
LE Less than or equal to
NE Not equal to
#S Step condition code tests to be made based on #SCC statement. See #SCC
statement discusssion in the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide for more infor-
mation.
IG No evaluation of the job is done. CA-7 always assumes the job completes suc-
cessfully, regardless of condition codes, abend codes, or run-time JCL errors.
0 No condition code test is to be made.
Default: DB.1 screen RO value if job defined to CA-7; otherwise 0
Required: No
SCHID
Identifies the schedule ID within the job's total schedule definition to be used for this
run. If omitted, SCHID=1 is assumed unless the job exists in the CA-7 database and
has an associated schedule. In this case, the first SCHID defined in the schedule
member is assumed.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric from 1 to 255
Default: 1
Required: No (See Note)
Note: If the SCHEDULE statement in the initialization file specifies
SCHID=YES, then this parameter is required.
SET
Specifies whether to skip the next scheduled cycle for the job (SKP), to disable trig-
gering (NTR), or to bypass database updating at job completion.
Required: No
SKP
Indicates this run of the job takes the place of the next scheduled run. This has
the same effect as entering NXTCYC,SET=SKP. It is reflected on output from
LJOB and LLOCK commands as if NXTCYC,SET=SKP was used. Invalid if
job has no schedule.
NTR
Specifies normal triggering is disabled only for this run of the job.
NDB
Allows a job to bypass all load processing at job completion, but allows other
processing to proceed normally.
Note: Data set triggering is still in effect.
TIME
Establishes a submit time-of-day requirement for the job. If the format is used with
a +, then the submit time is calculated from the current time, adding the specified
number of hours and minutes. If the + is used, then the DATE keyword must be
omitted.
Size/Type: + is optional
hh= 1 to 2 numeric characters from 0 to 23
mm= 2 numeric characters from 00 to 59
Required: No (unless DATE is used, if so, DOTM or TIME (hhmm format)
must be specified)
TYPE
Indicates the job is being scheduled in restart/rerun status. The job is put into the
request queue with a restart requirement and is not submitted until the CA-7 restart is
done. Output networks are scheduled, but input requirements checking is bypassed.
Required: No
Using SET=NDB can allow a job not defined to CA-7 to be run under the CA-7 control
and not be added to the database when it completes.
Input workstation networks must be demanded separately from jobs. If a demanded job
requires input workstation activity, the network responsible for that activity must be
requested separately using the DMDNW command.
Preprocessing work may be demanded well in advance of the job for which it is a
requirement. This may be necessary if the preprocessing activity requires several hours
or days of lead time, or if the work is available and is requested to be done early during a
slack period.
Output workstation networks associated with a job are automatically placed in the
postprocess queue when the CPU job is demanded.
Output networks may be demanded separately from their associated CPU jobs by a
DMDNW command.
Demanded work is assigned the UID of the operator issuing the DEMAND command if
the job is not defined in the database.
FROMNODE is a reserved keyword that is not considered valid input unless generated by
CA-7 internally. This keyword may not be coded on online, batch, or trailer terminal
transactions. It is reserved to indicate that the DEMAND is issued in response to a
scheduling request from an XPS client.
2.55.3 Examples
DEMANDH,JOB=CA7JOB1
DEMAND,JOB=CA7JOB1,DOTM=1633,LEADTM=3345
DEMAND,JOB=CA7JOB3,JCLID=7,SCHID=14
DEMAND,JOB=CA7JOB2,TYPE=RES
DEMAND,JOB=CA7JOB4,SET=NTR
2.56 DIRECT
Use the DIRECT command to alter any defined MAINID for a job in the request or
ready queue before the job is submitted for processing.
2.56.1 Syntax
DIRECT
──DIRECT──,JOB=jobnumber──,MAINID=─┬─ALL──┬─────────────────────
├─SYn──┤
└─/SYn─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the unique CA-7 job number of the job whose MAINID is to be changed.
The job must be in the request or ready queue and not already submitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes
MAINID
Specifies the MAINID, as defined in the initialization file CPU statement, to which
the job is to be redirected. The name must be one of the following:
Required: Yes
ALL
Indicates all CPUs are acceptable for executing the job.
SYn
n indicates the CPU to which the job is being redirected. The value of n may
range from 1 to 7.
/SYn
n indicates a CPU to which the job may not be submitted. The value of n may
range from 1 to 7.
Use of a MAINID has no effect on the routing of jobs in a shared spool environment
unless a user-supplied submit exit inserts appropriate JES control statements.
The 2.146.2, “QM.3-X CPU Job Attributes” on page 2-443 may be used as an alternative
for this purpose.
If a job has already been submitted and the DIRECT command is to be used because a
CPU is down, the job must be requeued before this command takes effect. See 2.154,
“REQUEUE” on page 2-471 and the 2.201, “XQ, XQJ, XQN, and XQM” on
page 2-574.
2.56.3 Examples
DIRECT,JOB=15,MAINID=SY3
DIRECT,JOB=73,MAINID=/SY1
2.57 DLTX
This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 7 or on any other
menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.7.
2.57.1 Syntax
DLTX
──DLTX──,INDX=index──┬──────────────┬───────────────────────────
└─,CVOL=volume─┘
Where:
INDX
Indicates the fully qualified name of the index to be removed.
Size/Type: 1 to 36 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
CVOL
Indicates the volume containing the catalog. If this field is omitted, the search begins
with the system residence volume, and a standard catalog search is employed.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.57.3 Examples
DLTX,INDX=USER.LEV1.LEV2.LEV3
DLTX,INDX=USER.LEV1.LEV2,CVOL=ALTCAT
DLTX,INDX=USER.GDG.FILE1
2.58 DMDNW
Use the DMDNW command to schedule on-request input and output networks into the
queues.
2.58.1 Syntax
DMDNW
──DMDNW──,NW=network──┬────────────┬──┬───────────┬──────────────
└─,DESC=desc─┘ └─,JOB=name─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────
│ ┌─3133─┐ │ │ ┌─1───┐ │
└─,LEADTM=─┴─hhmm─┴──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
──┬──────────────┬───────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,SUBID=subid─┘
Where:
NW
Specifies the network to be demanded. Value must be the network name used when
the network was defined in the database.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
DESC
Supplies an optional description. This value is displayed on the QM.6, QM.7, LPRE,
and LPOST screens.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
JOB
Supplies a name to assign to the network.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: DMD#nnnn, if neither SUBID nor JOB is specified. nnnn is the CA-7
number
Required: No
LEADTM
Specifies an elapsed (lead) time for calculating deadline start time-of-day of the first
station in the network.
Size/Type: hh= 1 to 2 numeric characters from 0 to 99
mm= 1 to 2 numeric characters from 0 to 59
Default: 1 hour
Required: No
SCHID
Identifies which schedule ID of the network's scheduling definition is to be used.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 1 to 255
Default: 1
Required: No
SUBID
Supplies an optional ID to be used to further identify the network when it enters the
queue.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
Even though networks can be demanded with this command, all networks must have a
schedule.
The DMDNW command must be used, instead of the CPU job DEMAND command for
input networks. It may be used to demand output networks independently of their CPU
jobs.
2.58.3 Examples
DMDNW,NW=RECPTS
DMDNW,NW=REPTS,SUBID=PAYR1234,DESC=PAYDATA
DMDNW,NW=REPTS,SCHID=27,LEADTM=3125
2.59 DMPCAT
Use the DMPCAT command to display the first block of catalog information for a speci-
fied data set. This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 18
or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.18.
2.59.1 Syntax
DMPCAT
──DMPCAT──,DSN=dsname──┬──────────────┬─────────────────────────
└─,CVOL=volume─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set whose first catalog block is to be
displayed.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
CVOL
Indicates the volume where the catalog search is to begin. If omitted, the catalog is
searched to determine the volume.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.59.2 Examples
DMPCAT,DSN=CA7.LOADLIB
DMPCAT,DSN=CA7.COMDS,CVOL=LIB133
2.60 DMPDSCB
Use the DMPDSCB command to display the format 1 data set control block (DSCB) for
a specific data set. This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION
value 13 or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.13.
2.60.1 Syntax
DMPDSCB
──DMPDSCB──,DSN=dsname──┬─────────────┬─────────────────────────
└─,VOL=volume─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set whose data set control block
(DSCB) is to be displayed.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates the volume on which the data set resides. If omitted, the catalog is
searched to determine the volume.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.60.2 Examples
DMPDSCB,DSN=CA7.LOADLIB,VOL=LIB132
DMPDSCB,DSN=CA7.COMDS
2.61 DMPDSN
Use the DMPDSN command to display physical records of a given data set or directory.
It supports DSORG of PS, DA, or PO and RECFM of F, V, or U. This function is
available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 17 or on any other menu or for-
matted screen as FUNCTION value UT.17.
2.61.1 Syntax
DMPDSN
──DMPDSN──,DSN=dsname──┬─────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬──────
└─,MEM=member─┘ │ ┌─1────┐ │
└─,REC=─┴─nnnn─┴──┘
──┬─────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,VOL=volume─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
MEM
Indicates that a PDS member is to be displayed. This should be specified for parti-
tioned data sets (PDSs) only. If omitted for a PDS, the directory is displayed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
REC
Indicates a relative physical record is to be displayed.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Default: 1 - first record in data set
Required: No
VOL
Indicates the volume on which the data set resides. If omitted, the catalog is
searched to determine the volume.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.61.2 Examples
DMPDSN,DSN=CA7.LOADLIB,MEM=SASSUTLX
DMPDSN,DSN=CA7.COMMDS,VOL=LIB132,REC=3
DMPDSN,DSN=CA7.LOADLIB,REC=5
2.62 FALL
Use the FALL command to provide forecasting for CPU jobs and network workstations.
Only the database is used for this forecast.
2.62.1 Syntax
FALL
──FALL──,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┼─#JOB─┼──┘
└─name#─┘ ├─CPU──┤
├─GRPH─┤
├─JOB──┤
└─STN──┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬─────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ └─,MAINID=SYn─┘ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────
└─,NWOPT=─┬─N─┬──┘ └─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─S─┘ └─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─JOB──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
└─system#─┘ ├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the forecast time interval. FROM is
required. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. Either TO or
SPAN is required. If TO is specified, SPAN must be omitted. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast
Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
LIST
Specifies the options for resource forecasting.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Produces all of the following:
#JOB
Graphically displays number of jobs running during each time interval specified.
CPU
Graphically displays percent of CPU usage during each time interval specified.
GRPH
Graphically displays number of jobs running, percent of CPU used, and tape
usage during each time interval specified.
JOB
Produces resource forecast report for CPU workload.
STN
Produces resource forecast report.
Note: You must omit LIST if RINT is not specified.
2.62.2 Examples
FALL,FROM=(333533,3833),TO=(3316,17),TYPE=ALL
FALL,FROM=33,TO=33,SYS=PACKBACK
FALL,FROM=(33,38),SPAN=8,SEQ=JOB
FALL,FROM=(33,38),SPAN=8,JOB=G431M,SYS=ACCTPY,NW=RPTPREP,STN=(PRNT,BURST,DISTR)
FALL,FROM=(1332),SPAN=24,RINT=3133,LIST=GRPH
NOEX in the RQMT column on the output identifies nonexecutable jobs (for example,
EXEC:N on the DB.1 screen).
JCLO in the RQMT column on the output identifies jobs requiring JCL overrides (for
example, JCL-OVRD:Y on the DB.1 screen).
< FALL,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FALL DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS AND STATIONS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
JOBS(S) : ALL
STATIONS(S) : ALL
NETWORK(S) : ALL
K L
< FALL,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FALL DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
START DTTM END DTTM JOB SYS SCHED# SID TRIGGERING JOB/DSN RQMT
33365/3759 33365/3833 DUCCXX31 TESTNTWK SJ333331 331
33365/3759 33365/3833 DUCCXX38 TESTNTWK SJ333332 331
33365/3933 33365/3933 JCO153D CO SJ333312 331 NOEX
33365/3333 33365/3333 JCO623D CO LEV331 331 JCO153D
33365/1133 33365/1133 PAT1 CHICAGO SJ333316 332 JCLO
33365/1159 33365/1233 DUCCXX31 TESTNTWK SJ333331 332
33365/1159 33365/1233 DUCCXX38 TESTNTWK SJ333332 332
33365/1233 33365/1233 JCO153D CO SJ333312 332 NOEX
33365/1233 33365/1233 PATM1 SJ333314 331
33365/1213 33365/1213 JCO531D CO LEV331 332 JCO153D
33365/1559 33365/1633 DUCCXX31 TESTNTWK SJ333331 333
33365/1559 33365/1633 DUCCXX38 TESTNTWK SJ333332 333
33365/1959 33365/2333 DUCCXX31 TESTNTWK SJ333331 334
33365/1959 33365/2333 DUCCXX38 TESTNTWK SJ333332 334
33365/2333 33365/2333 ALLNET1 DEMO SJ333335 331 JCLO
33365/2359 33365/2359 PATOM PAT SJ333315 331
K L
FALL Screen - Forecast for CA-7 Stations
< FALL,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FALL DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3333
FORECAST FOR CA-7 STATIONS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/S
33365/3933 33365/1133 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:335
33365/1233 33365/1333 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1333 33365/1533 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/1533 33365/1533 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1633 33365/1733 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/1733 33365/1933 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33365/1933 33365/1933 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SI333331 331
33365/2333 33365/2133 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SI333331 331
33365/2133 33365/2333 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SI333331 331
33365/2333 33365/2333 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SI333331 331
33366/3333 33366/3133 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SI333331 331
33366/3333 33366/3333 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SI333331 331
K L
2.63 FIND
Use the FIND command to search DASD volumes for copies of a given data set name.
Volume serial number and creation date are displayed for each DASD volume on which
the data set is found. This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION
value 10 or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.10.
2.63.1 Syntax
FIND
──FIND──,DSN=dsname──,VOL=─┬─ALL────────────┬───────────────────
├─volume─────────┤
│ ┌─,──────┐ │
!─volume─┴─)─┘
└─(──
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates the volumes to be searched.
Required: Yes
ALL
Specifies all volumes available to CA-7. SPACE,VOL=ALL may be used to
determine which volumes are available to CA-7 by way of:
//U7nnnnnn DD statements in the CA-7 JCL
Function 11 on the Utilities Menu screen
Top line ALLOC command
volume
Specifies a single volume.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
(volume,...,volume)
Specifies up to five volumes enclosed in parentheses and separated by commas.
2.63.2 Examples
FIND,DSN=SYSCTLG,VOL=ALL
FIND,DSN=USER.FILE1,VOL=(VOLM31,VOLM32,VOLM33)
FIND,DSN=USER.FILE2,VOL=VOLM32
CA-7 displays the volser and creation date for each DASD volume where the data set is
found.
2.64 FJOB
Use the FJOB command to provide forecasting for CPU jobs. It includes an option to
include output workstation networks in the forecast. Only the database is used for this
forecast.
2.64.1 Syntax
FJOB
──FJOB──,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┼─#JOB─┼──┘
└─name#─┘ ├─CPU──┤
├─GRPH─┤
├─JOB──┤
├─W────┤
├─WP───┤
├─WPS──┤
└─WS───┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬─────────────┬──┬────────────────┬─────────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ └─,MAINID=SYn─┘ └─,NWOPT=─┬─N─┬──┘
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─S─┘
──┬────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────────────
└─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─3───┐ │
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
──┬───────────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬──────────────
└─,SEG=(segment,subsegment)─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─JOB──┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
└─system#─┘ ├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the time interval to be forecast. FROM is
required. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. Either TO or
SPAN is required. If TO is specified, SPAN must be omitted. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast
Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
LIST
Specifies the options for either resource forecasting or the worksheet. When used for
resource forecasting, LIST must be omitted if RINT is not specified.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Produces all of the following:
#JOB
Graphically displays the number of jobs running during each time interval speci-
fied.
CPU
Graphically displays the percent of CPU usage during each time interval speci-
fied.
GRPH
Graphically displays the number of jobs running, percent of CPU used and tape
usage during each time interval specified.
JOB
Produces resource forecast report for CPU workload.
For worksheet requests, RINT and NWOPT must be omitted and LIST can have
one of the following values:
W
Produces a schedule worksheet, without prose from the forecast report.
WP
Produces prose information with the specified forecast worksheet.
WPS
Same as WP except skip to top of page for each job.
WS
Same as W except skip to top of page for each job.
2.64.3 Examples
FJOB,FROM=(333533,3833),TO=(3316,17)
FJOB,FROM=32,TO=33,SYS=PAYROLL,TRIG=DJ
FJOB,FROM=33,SPAN=24,SEQ=JOB,JOB=G431M
FJOB,FROM=(33,38),SPAN=8,JOB=(JOB1,JOB2,JOB3)
FJOB,FROM=3332,SPAN=24
FJOB,FROM=32,SPAN=24
FJOB,FROM=(3915,3833),SPAN=48,SYS=PAYROLL,RINT=3333,LIST=CPU
FJOB,FROM=(3314,1333),SPAN=24,LIST=WPS,TYPE=ALL
NOEX in the RQMT column on the output identifies nonexecutable jobs (for example,
EXEC:N on the DB.1 screen). These jobs have both the start and end times set to the
DOTM of the job.
JCLO in the RQMT column on the output identifies jobs which require JCL overrides
(for example, JCL-OVRD:Y on the DB.1 screen).
The asterisk preceding the job name indicates the time had to be adjusted.
< FJOB,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FJOB DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
JOB(S) : ALL
< FJOB,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FJOB DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
START DTTM END DTTM JOB SYS SCHED# SID TRIGGERING JOB/DSN RQMT
33365/3759 33365/3833 DUCCXX31 TESTNTWK SJ333331 331
33365/1159 33365/1233 DUCCXX31 TESTNTWK SJ333331 332
33365/1633 33365/1633 DUCCXX32 TESTNTWK SJ333332 331 NOEX
33365/1959 33365/2333 DUCCXX33 TESTNTWK SJ333333 331 JCLO
K L
FJOB Screen - Forecast for CA-7 Jobs and Stations (Summary)
< FJOB,FROM=333633,TO=333633,NWOPT=S
=
FJOB DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS AND STATIONS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
JOB(S) : ALL
STATION(S) : ALL
NETWORK(S) : ALL
K L
FJOB Screen - Forecast for CA-7 Stations
< FJOB,FROM=333633,TO=333633,NWOPT=S
=
FJOB DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
FORECAST FOR CA-7 STATIONS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33365/3933 33365/1533 1 PRINT TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1333 33365/1933 2 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/1733 33365/2333 3 DELIVER TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33365/2133 33366/3333 4 MAIL TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:334
K L
< FJOB,FROM=333633,TO=333633,LIST=WP
=
DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
< FJOB,FROM=333333,TO=333333,TRIG=J,JOB=WHIDO95M,TYPE=ALL =
FJOB DATE 12-13-33 PAGE 3331
FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-33-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-33-33 AT 2359 HRS
START DTTM END DTTM JOB SYS SCHED# SID TRIGGERING JOB/DSN RQMT
2.65 FLOWD
Use the FLOWD command to manually delete active Critical Path Management (CPM)
flow elements.
2.65.1 Syntax
FLOWD
──FLOWD──,FLOW=flowname──┬─────────────┬──┬────────────┬────────
└─,DATE=yyddd─┘ └─,TIME=hhmm─┘
Where:
FLOW
Indicates the fully qualified name of the CPM flow to be deleted. To delete all
active flows, specify *ALL*. If there are multiple occurrences of the flow active, all
of them will be deleted unless the DATE and TIME keywords are used to qualify the
selection.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
DATE
If there are multiple occurrences of the same flow, you can use the DATE (and
optionally TIME) keywords to select which flow(s) to delete. The value is matched
against the flow start date (see 2.66, “FLOWL” on page 2-138).
Size/Type: 5 numeric digits (yyddd)
Required: No
TIME
If there are multiple occurrences of the same flow, you can use the DATE (and
optionally TIME) keywords to select which flow(s) to delete. The value is matched
against the flow start time (see 2.66, “FLOWL” on page 2-138).
Size/Type: 4 numeric digits (hhmm)
Required: No. The TIME keyword is ignored if the DATE keyword is not also
specified
2.66 FLOWL
Use the FLOWL command to display information on active Critical Path Management
(CPM) flows. See the CA-7 Interfaces Guide for information about the CPM facility.
2.66.1 Syntax
FLOWL
──FLOWL──┬─────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬──────────────
└─,FLOW=flowname#─┘ └─,LIST=─┬─FLOW─┬──┘
└─JOBS─┘
Where:
FLOW
Specifies the fully or partially qualified flow name for which information is to be
displayed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
Default: * (all flows)
LIST
Specifies the amount of flow information to be displayed.
Required: No
Default: FLOW
FLOW
Displays a single line of information for each active flow selected.
JOBS
Displays a line of information for each active flow selected and also lists the
CA-7 job numbers of the jobs which are currently connected to each flow.
2.66.2 Examples
< FLOWL,LIST=JOBS
=
PAGE 3331
A B C D E F
FLOWNAME START-DATE/TIME START-JOB/SID/NUM END-JOB/SID SLA-TARGET JOBCNT
2.67 FPOST
Use the FPOST command to provide forecasting for output network workstations. Only
the database is used for this forecast.
2.67.1 Syntax
FPOST
──FPOST──,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬─────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ └─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘ └─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─network#─┘ └─STN──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the forecast time interval. FROM is
required. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. Either TO or
SPAN is required. If TO is specified, SPAN must be omitted. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast
Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.67.2 Examples
FPOST,FROM=(333533,3833),TO=(3316,17)
FPOST,FROM=33,TO=33,STN=KEYPUNCH
FPOST,FROM=(33,17),SPAN=8,NW=RPT,STN=(BURST,DISTR)
FPOST,FROM=32,SPAN=24,RINT=3345
< FPOST,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FPOST DATE 33-36-33 PAGE 3331
FORECAST FOR CA-7 STATIONS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
STATIONS(S) : ALL
NETWORK(S) : ALL
K L
FPOST Screen - Forecast for CA-7 Stations (Output Networks)
< FPOST,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FPOST DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33365/3933 33365/1133 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1233 33365/1333 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1333 33365/1533 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/1533 33365/1533 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1633 33365/1733 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/1733 33365/1933 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33365/1933 33365/1933 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/2333 33365/2133 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33365/2133 33365/2333 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:334
33365/2333 33365/2333 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33366/3333 33366/3133 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:334
33366/3333 33366/3333 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:334
2.68 FPRE
Use the FPRE command to provide forecasting for input network workstations. Only the
database is used for this forecast.
2.68.1 Syntax
FPRE
──FPRE──,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ └─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘ └─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─network#─┘ └─STN──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the forecast time interval. FROM is
required. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. Either TO or
SPAN is required. If TO is specified, SPAN must be omitted. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast
Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.68.2 Examples
FPRE,FROM=(333533,3833),TO=(3316,17)
FPRE,FROM=33,TO=33,STN=KEYPUNCH
FPRE,FROM=(33,17),SPAN=24,NW=DATAPREP,SEQ=STN
FPRE,FROM=(33,3833),SPAN=8,STN=(KEYPUNCH,VERIFY)
FPRE,FROM=(3915,3833),SPAN=8,RINT=3233,
< FPRE,FROM=333633,TO=333633,SPAN=12
=
FPRE DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
STATION(S) : ALL
NETWORK(S) : ALL
K L
Note: This is not the summary for the next screen.
< FPRE,FROM=333633,TO=333633,SPAN=12
=
FPRE DATE 33-31-33 PAGE 3332
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33365/3633 33365/3633 1 INPUTLOG TIMECARD PAY331-D SI333332 331
33365/3633 33365/3645 2 KEYENTRY TIMECARD PAY331-D SI333332 331
33365/3645 33365/3733 1 INPUTLOG SHIPPING WHS323-D SI333336 333
33365/3733 33365/3715 1 INPUTLOG APPROVAL ACP331-W SI333328 331
33365/3715 33365/3733 2 KEYENTRY SHIPPING WHS313-D SI333336 333
33365/3715 33365/3733 3 VERIFY TIMECARD PAY331-D SI333332 331
33365/3733 33365/3745 3 VERIFY SHIPPING WHS323-D SI333336 333
33365/3745 33365/3833 2 KEYENTRY APPROVAL ACP331-W SI333328 331
33365/3833 33365/3815 4 LOGOUT TIMECARD PAY331-D SI333332 331
33365/3815 33365/3833 3 VERIFY APPROVAL ACP331-W SI333328 331
33365/3815 33365/3833 4 LOGOUT SHIPPING WHS323-D SI333336 333
33365/3833 33365/3845 4 LOGOUT APPROVAL ACP331-W SI333328 331
33365/3845 33365/3933 5 TRANSMIT TIMECARD PAY331-D SI333332 331
33365/3933 33365/3915 5 TRANSMIT SHIPPING WHS313-D SI333336 333
K L
2.69 FQALL
Use the FQALL command to provide forecasting for both CPU jobs and workstation net-
works. It includes work in the request, ready, active, preprocess, and postprocess queues.
2.69.1 Syntax
FQALL
──FQALL──┬─────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──┘
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┼─#JOB─┼──┘
└─name#─┘ ├─CPU──┤
├─GRPH─┤
├─JOB──┤
└─STN──┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬─────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ └─,MAINID=SYn─┘ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─JOB──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
└─system#─┘ ├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. If TO is
specified, SPAN must be omitted. If neither is specified, only work in the queues is
considered. See 1.8.3.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-34 for more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
current date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
LIST
Specifies the options for resource forecasting.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Produces all of the following:
#JOB
Graphically displays number of jobs running during each time interval specified.
CPU
Graphically displays percent of CPU usage during each time interval specified.
GRPH
Graphically displays number of jobs running, percent of CPU used and tape
usage during each time interval specified.
JOB
Produces resource forecast report for CPU workload.
STN
Produces resource forecast report. List must be omitted if RINT is not specified.
2.69.2 Examples
FQALL
FQALL,SPAN=8
FQALL,TO=1321
FQALL,JOB=G431M,SYS=ACCM,NW=RPTM,STN=(PRNT,BURST,DISTR)
FQALL,RINT=3133,LIST=STN,SPAN=4
NOEX in the RQMT column on the output identifies nonexecutable jobs (for example,
EXEC:N on the DB.1 screen).
JCLO in the RQMT column on the output identifies jobs which require JCL overrides
(for example, JCL-OVRD:Y on the DB.1 screen).
< FQALL,SPAN=24
=
FQALL DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3332
START DTTM END DTTM JOB SYS SCHED# SID TRIGGERING JOB/DSN RQMT
33128/1613 33128/1613 DUSARS32 PAYABLES RDY-Q 331
33128/1613 33128/1613 DUSARS33 PAYABLES RDY-Q 331
33128/1613 33128/1613 DUSAXX31 AUDITORS REQ-Q 331
33128/1613 33128/1613 DUSAXX33 BILLING REQ-Q 331
33128/1611 33128/1611 DUSAZZ31 SHIPPING REQ-Q 331 NOEX
33128/1621 33128/1721 DUSAZZ12 SHIPPING LEV331 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1621 33129/3314 DUSAZZ11 SHIPPING LEV331 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1713 33128/1711 DUSAXX35 BILLING LEV331 331 DUSAXX33
33128/1711 33128/1331 DUSAZZ13 SHIPPING LEV331 331 DUSAZZ31 JCLO
33128/1821 33129/1721 DUSAZZ22 SHIPPING LEV332 331 DUSAZZ12
33128/2311 33128/2131 DUSAZZ23 SHIPPING LEV332 331 DUSAZZ13 JCLO
33129/3414 33129/1414 DUSAZZ21 SHIPPING LEV332 331 DUSAZZ11
K L
FQALL Screen - Stations
< FQALL
=
FQALL DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 332
FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS AND STATIONS (INCLUDING THOSE IN CURRENT QUEUES)
PERIOD : 35-37-33 AT 1519 HRS TO 35-39-33 AT 1519 HRS
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33127/1519 33127/1521 1 TRIGST31 TRIGINNW HEMANT PRE-Q 331
33127/1519 33127/1531 1 KEYPUNCH LAMBINWK TEST PRE-Q 331
33127/1711 33128/3611 1 HTERM2 TESTNET1 TESTSID3 POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/3833 33128/3933 1 HTERM1 TEST3TNW RPT1235 POST-Q 331 DUSAXX31
33128/3833 33128/3933 2 LHTERM1 TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/3933 33128/1333 3 DATACNTL TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1333 33128/1133 4 HTERM1 TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1133 33128/1233 5 HTERM2 TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1233 33128/1333 6 LHTERM2 TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1333 33128/1433 7 DATACNTL TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1433 33128/1533 8 LHTERM2 TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1533 33128/1633 9 LHTERM1 TESTNET1 TESTSIDO POST-Q 331 DUSAZZ31
33128/1711 33128/1721 2 TRIGSTO2 TRIGINNW HEMANT PRE-Q 331
33129/3633 33129/3733 2 HTERM2 TESTOTNW RPT1235 POST-Q 331 DUSAXX31
33129/1233 33129/1333 3 HTERM1 TESTOTNW RPT1235 POST-Q 331 DUSAXX31
2.70 FQJOB
Use the FQJOB command to provide forecasting by job name including those CPU jobs
in the request, ready, and active queues.
2.70.1 Syntax
FQJOB
──FQJOB──┬─────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──┘
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┼─#JOB─┼──┘
└─name#─┘ ├─CPU──┤
├─GRPH─┤
├─JOB──┤
├─W────┤
├─WP───┤
├─WPS──┤
└─WS───┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬─────────────┬──┬────────────────┬─────────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ └─,MAINID=SYn─┘ └─,NWOPT=─┬─N─┬──┘
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─S─┘
──┬────────────┬──┬───────────────────────────┬───────────────────
└─,RINT=hhmm─┘ └─,SEG=(segment,subsegment)─┘
──┬─────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────
│ ┌─DLDT─┐ │ │ ┌─M───────┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘ └─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘
└─JOB──┘ └─system#─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─J──────┐ │ │ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘ └─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. If TO is
specified, SPAN must be omitted. If neither is specified, selection is based on only
those jobs in the queues. See 1.8.3.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-34 for more
information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
current date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
LIST
Specifies the options for resource forecasting. LIST must be omitted if RINT is not
specified.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Produces all of the following:
#JOB
Graphically displays number of jobs running during each time interval specified.
CPU
Graphically displays percent of CPU usage during each time interval specified.
GRPH
Graphically displays number of jobs running, percent of CPU used and tape
usage during each time interval specified.
JOB
Produces resource forecast report for CPU workload.
For worksheet requests, RINT must be omitted and LIST can have one of the
following values:
W
Produces a schedule worksheet, without prose from the forecast report.
WP
Produces prose information with the specified forecast worksheet.
WPS
The same as WP except skip to top page for each job.
WS
The same as W except skip to top of page for each job.
2.70.2 Examples
FQJOB,TO=(363333)
FQJOB,SPAN=8
FQJOB,SPAN=24,SYS=INVENTRY
FQJOB,RINT=3313
FQJOB,TO=(363333,1633),RINT=3133,LIST=GRPH
NOEX in the RQMT column on the output identifies nonexecutable jobs (for example,
EXEC:N on the DB.1 screen).
JCLO in the RQMT column on the output identifies jobs which require JCL overrides
(for example, JCL-OVRD:Y on the DB.1 screen).
< FQJOB,SPAN=24
=
FQJOB DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3332
START DTTM END DTTM JOB SYS SCHED# SID TRIGGERING JOB/DSN RQMT
33127/1613 33127/1613 ACRAA31W RECEVABL RDY-Q 331
33127/1613 33127/1613 ACRAA32W RECEVABL RDY-Q 331
33127/1613 33127/1613 ACPED31W PAYABLES REQ-Q 331
33127/1613 33127/1613 CNPAC31M PAYROLL REQ-Q 331 NOEX
33127/1611 33127/1611 WHSAB31D SHIPPING REQ-Q 331 JCLO
33127/1621 33127/1721 WHSAC31D SHIPPING LEV331 331 WHSAB31D
33127/1621 33128/3314 WHSAD31D SHIPPING LEV331 331 WHSAB31D
33127/1713 33127/1711 CNPAD31M PAYROLL LEV331 331 CNPAC31M
33127/1711 33127/1331 WHSAE31D SHIPPING LEV332 331 WHSAD31D JCLO
33127/1821 33127/1721 WHSAF31D SHIPPING LEV333 331 WHSAE31D
33127/2311 33127/2131 WHSAG31D SHIPPING LEV334 331 WHSAF31D JCLO
33128/3414 33128/1414 WHSAH31D SHIPPING LEV335 331 WHSAG31D
K L
2.71 FQPOST
Use the FQPOST command to provide forecasting for output network workstation activity
including the postprocess queue.
2.71.1 Syntax
FQPOST
──FQPOST──┬─────────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬────
└─,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──┘ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘ └─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─STN──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. If TO is
specified, SPAN must be omitted. See 1.8.3.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-34 for
more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
current date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.71.2 Examples
FQPOST,TO=(363333)
FQPOST,SPAN=8
FQPOST,TO=(112133,1733)
FQPOST,SPAN=8,NW=RPT
< FQPOST,SPAN=13
=
FQPOST DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3331
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33128/3833 33128/3933 1 PRINTERS BILLING MONTHLY POST-Q 331 CHGBL31M
33128/3833 33128/3933 2 QUALITY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/3933 33128/1333 3 DECOLLAT BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1333 33128/1133 4 BURSTING BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1133 33128/1233 5 MICRFILM BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1233 33128/1333 6 QUALITY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1333 33128/1433 7 COPIES BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1433 33128/1533 8 QUALITY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1533 33128/1633 9 DELIVERY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33129/3633 33129/3733 2 DECOLLAT BILLING MONTHLY POST-Q 331 CHGBL31M
33129/1233 33129/1333 3 DELIVERY BILLING MONTHLY POST-Q 331 CHGBL31M
K L
2.72 FQPRE
Use the FQPRE command to provide forecasting for input network workstations including
the preprocess queue.
2.72.1 Syntax
FQPRE
──FQPRE──┬─────────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────
└─,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──┘ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘ └─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─STN──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. If TO is
specified, SPAN must be omitted. See 1.8.3.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-34 for
more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
current date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.72.2 Examples
FQPRE,TO=(321333,3833)
FQPRE,SPAN=8
FQPRE,TO=(3617,1733),STN=KEYPUNCH
< FQPRE,SPAN=24
=
FQPRE DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3332
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33128/1511 33128/1521 1 CONSOLE SYSTSAVE KEYSTATS PRE-Q 331
33128/1521 33128/1531 1 CONSOLE ENGINEER WEEKLY PRE-Q 331
33128/1711 33128/1721 2 PRINTER SYSTSAVE KEYSTATS PRE-Q 331
K L
2.73 FQRES
Use the FQRES command to provide forecasting, including the queues, for the following
resources:
CPU workload
– Individual job resources
– Number of jobs running within a time interval
– Percent of CPU usage within a time interval
– Number of tapes required within a time interval
– Amount of memory required within a time interval
Number of workstations involved
2.73.1 Syntax
FQRES
──FQRES──,INT=hhmm──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬───────────────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┼─#JOB─┼──┘
└─name#─┘ ├─CPU──┤
├─GRPH─┤
├─JOB──┤
├─W────┤
├─WP───┤
├─WPS──┤
└─WS───┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
└─system#─┘ ├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. If TO is
specified, SPAN must be omitted. Both are optional. If neither is specified, the
selection is based on the queues only, and current date and time are assumed.
mmddyy
Specifies the date. Optional.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). If TO is specified, mm is required. Leading
zero is required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted and TO is specified, last
day of month is assumed.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If TO is specified and yy is omitted, the current year
is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If TO is specified and hhmm omitted, 2359 is
assumed.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh with the minimum value
is 1 hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
LIST
Specifies the options for resource forecasting.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Produces all of the following:
#JOB
Graphically displays number of jobs running during each time interval specified.
CPU
Graphically displays percent of CPU usage during each time interval specified.
GRPH
Graphically displays number of jobs running, percent of CPU used and tape
usage during each time interval specified.
JOB
Produces resource forecast report for CPU workload.
STN
Produces resource forecast report.
TAPE
Graphically displays total number of tapes during each time interval specified.
2.73.2 Examples
FQRES,INT=3313,TO=36
FQRES,SPAN=8,INT=3315,LIST=JOB
FQRES,SPAN=723,INT=2433,LIST=CPU
FQRES,INT=3313,JOB=PAYRM,TO=36
The screens produced by the FQRES command are identical to those produced by the
FRES command. See FRES screen on page 2-166 through FRES screen on page 2-168
for examples of the screens.
2.74 FQSTN
Use the FQSTN command to provide forecasting for input and output network work-
stations including the preprocess and postprocess queues.
2.74.1 Syntax
FQSTN
──FQSTN──┬─────────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────
└─,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──┘ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘ └─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
└─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─STN──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. If TO is
specified, SPAN must be omitted. If neither is specified, selection is based on only
those workstations in the preprocess or postprocess queues. See 1.8.3.2, “Forecast
Interval” on page 1-34 for more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
current date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.74.2 Examples
FQSTN
FQSTN,SPAN=8
FQSTN,STN=KEYPUNCH
FQSTN,TO=(363333,1733),RINT=3233
FQSTN,NW=RPT,STN=(BURST,DISTR)
< FQSTN
=
FQSTN DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3332
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33127/1519 33127/1521 1 CONSOLE SYSTSAVE KEYSTATS PRE-Q 331 DMD#3336
33127/1519 33127/1531 1 CONSOLE ENGINEER WEEKLY PRE-Q 331 DND#3337
33127/1711 33128/3611 1 PRINTERS BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/3833 33128/3933 1 PRINTERS BILLING MONTHLY POST-Q 331 CHGBL31M
33128/3833 33128/3933 2 QUALITY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/3933 33128/1333 3 DECOLLAT BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1333 33128/1133 4 BURSTING BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1133 33128/1233 5 MICRFILM BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1233 33128/1333 6 QUALITY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1333 33128/1433 7 COPIES BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1433 33128/1533 8 QUALITY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1533 33128/1633 9 DELIVERY BENEFITS PER334-A POST-Q 331 PERAC31A
33128/1711 33128/1721 2 PRINTER SYSTSAVE KEYSTATS PRE-Q 331 DMD#3336
33129/3633 33129/3733 2 DECOLLAT BILLING MONTHLY POST-Q 331 CHGBL31M
33129/1233 33129/1333 3 DELIVERY BILLING MONTHLY POST-Q 331 CHGBL31M
K L
2.75 FQTAPE
Use the FQTAPE command to provide a tape pull list for CPU jobs including those in
the CA-7 queues.
2.75.1 Syntax
FQTAPE
──FQTAPE──┬─────────────────────────┬────────────────────────────
└─,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──┘
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─M───────┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘
└─name#─┘ └─system#─┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. If TO is
specified, SPAN must be omitted. If neither is specified, selection is from the
queues only and current date and time are assumed.
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Required. Leading zero is required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted, current day is assumed.
Leading zero is required.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If omitted, the current year is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If omitted, current time is assumed.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh with the minimum value
is 1 hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.75.2 Examples
FQTAPE
FQTAPE,SPAN=24
FQTAPE,SPAN=8,JOB=GLM,TRIG=JD
< FQTAPE
=
FQTAPE DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3332
TAPE PULL LIST FOR CA-7 JOBS (INCLUDING THOSE IN CURRENT QUEUES)
PERIOD : 35-37-33 AT 1528 HRS TO 35-37-33 AT 1528 HRS
2.76 FRES
Use the FRES command to provide forecasting, from the database only, for the following
resources:
CPU workload
– Individual job resources
– Number of jobs running within a time interval
– Percent of CPU usage within a time interval
– Number of tapes required within a time interval
– Amount of memory required within a time interval
Number of workstations involved
2.76.1 Syntax
FRES
──FRES──,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,INT=hhmm───────────────────────────
──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──────────────────────────────────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬────────────────┬─────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ └─,LIST=list─┘ │ ┌─133─┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
└─name#─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ │ ┌─3───┐ │
└─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
└─system#─┘ ├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the time interval to be forecast. FROM is
required.
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Required. Leading zero is required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted, 01 is assumed. Leading
zero is required.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If omitted, current year is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If omitted, 0000 is assumed.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. TO is
optional. If TO is specified, SPAN must be omitted. Either TO or SPAN must be
specified.
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Required. Leading zero is required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted, last day of month is
assumed. Leading zero is required.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If omitted, the current year is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If omitted, 2359 is assumed.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
LIST
Specifies the options for resource forecasting.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Produces all of the following:
#JOB
Graphically displays number of jobs running during each time interval specified.
CPU
Graphically displays percent of CPU usage during each time interval specified.
GRPH
Graphically displays number of jobs running, percent of CPU used and tape
usage during each time interval specified.
JOB
Produces resource forecast report for CPU workload.
STN
Graphically displays number of stations in use (jobs are not included).
TAPE
Graphically displays total number of tapes during each time interval specified.
2.76.2 Examples
FRES,FROM=(333533,3833),TO=(3316,17),INT=3333
FRES,FROM=33,SPAN=24,SYS=GLACTG,INT=3133
FRES,FROM=11,TO=21,INT=2433,LIST=CPU
< FRES,FROM=(3336,3733),SPAN=4,JOB=DUSAZZ31,INT=3133
=
FRES DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
RESOURCE FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3733 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 1133 HRS
< FRES,INT=3133,FROM=(353833,1633),TO=(353933,3533)
=
FRES DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3332
RESOURCE FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 35-38-33 AT 1633 HRS TO 35-39-33 AT 3533 HRS
FRES Screen - Resource Forecast for CA-7 Jobs - Percent of CPU Utilization
< FRES,INT=3133,FROM=(353833,1633),TO=(353933,3533)
=
FRES DATE 35-37-33 PAGE 3337
RESOURCE FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 35-38-33 AT 1633 HRS TO 35-39-33 AT 3533 HRS
< FRES,FROM=333633,TO=333633,INT=3133
=
FRES DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
RESOURCE FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
< FRES,FROM=333633,TO=333633,INT=3133
=
FRES DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
RESOURCE FORECAST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
< FRES,FROM=333633,TO=333633,INT=3133
=
FRES DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
RESOURCE FORECAST FOR CA-7 STATIONS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 2359 HRS
2.77 FRJOB
Use the FRJOB command to answer the question, "How does this job get into the
system?" It presents a reverse jobflow (reverse trigger flow) based upon information in
the database. The purpose is to identify how the target job can be brought into the active
scheduling system. It tracks backward through triggers from the target job to one or
more header jobs. A header job is one which has one or more defined date/time sched-
ules, or, that has no job/data set/network triggers defined. That is, a job, network, or data
set which starts the trigger flow which eventually results in the target job being brought
into the active scheduling system. FRJOB uses only information in the CA-7 database.
2.77.1 Syntax
FRJOB
──FRJOB──,JOB=─┬─jobname─────────────────┬───────────────────────
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┼─HDRS─┼──┘
└─name#─┘ └─LAST─┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ │ ┌─3───┐ │
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
└─system#─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
JOB
Specifies the specific job(s) from which the reverse flow(s) are started. The value
can be one specific job name or a substring of 1 to 10 specific job names.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID of the starting job(s) (JOB=) used to start the reverse flow.
It can be a value from 0 to 255. The default is 0, which means the next level con-
tains elements that can cause ANY schedule ID of the starting job to be
triggered/scheduled.
LIST
Specifies the option of listing the entire structure or just the first and last jobs.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Indicates the entire structure is to be listed.
HDRS
Indicates that only those elements identified as 'headers' and the starting job
should be listed.
LAST
Indicates only the first and last elements are to be listed.
2.77.2 Examples
FRJOB,JOB=PAY3393,SCHID=1
FRJOB,JOB=AR#3333,SCHID=3,LIST=LAST
FRJOB,JOB=ORD3388,LVL=13
For example, your operations staff informs you that a second copy of job PAY0090 is
being brought into the system whenever the PAYROLL application is run, even though it
had already run earlier in the cycle. You can use FRJOB to determine not only the
possible triggers for PAY0090, but also the path of control that leads up to each of those
triggers. With this information you can more easily diagnose the problem, and also check
the results after you have made changes to the structure.
The FRJOB display does not include any dates or times for elements in the structure.
This is because the flow is being generated backwards through logical control paths.
Also, the display may include jobs with a schedule ID of zero (000) which indicates it
represents any occurrence of the job rather than a specific occurrence of the job. Once
you have determined the origin point(s) for the target job you can use one of the other
forecasting commands to retrace a particular control path from the origin point to the
target job with dates and times provided.
< FRJOB,JOB=BBD37
=
FRJOB DATE 34-31-yy PAGE 3331
REVERSE STRUCTURE FOR CA-7 JOBS
JOB(S) : BBD37
A B
HEADER JOB/NETWORK NAME : BBD36I AND OTHERS
K L
The forecasting summary page for FRJOB follows the general format of all forecasting
commands with the following exceptions:
Item Description
A This field shows the name of the first (or only) origination point (header) for the
control flow which eventually results in the target job.
B If there are multiple possible origin points in the reverse jobflow, this area contains
the text AND OTHERS. If there is only one origination point (header) for the
flow, this area is blank.
< FRJOB,JOB=BBD37
=
FRJOB DATE 34-31-yy PAGE 3331
REVERSE STRUCTURE FOR CA-7 JOBS
HDR LEV# JOB NAME SYSTEM SID TYPE TRIGGERS /DSNBR /SCHEDULED
--- BBD37 ............ 333
MMMM -331 BBD36I .......... 331 INWK BBD37 :MMSCHDMM
-331 BBD36 .......... 336 JOB BBD37
-332 BBD35 ........ 335 JOB BBD36
MMMM -333 BBD34B ...... 335 DSET BBD35 :DS333358
-333 BBD34 ...... 334 JOB BBD35
-334 BBD33 .... 333 JOB BBD34
-335 BBD32 .. 332 JOB BBD33
MMMM -336 BBD31 BBDSYS 331 JOB BBD32 :MMSCHDMM
INWK This indicates the element in the Job Name field is an input network which
triggers the job in the Triggers field through a network trigger.
TRIGGERS
This field contains the name of the job on the next higher level which this element
triggers. For example, the last line of the preceding example means that job
BBD01 (level -006) triggers job BBD02 on the next higher level (level -005).
DSNBR
Data Set Number. This field contains the CA-7 data set number of the data set
created or updated by the job shown in the Job Name which causes a data set
trigger to bring in the job shown in Triggers. The DSNBR is only displayed if a
data set trigger is involved, otherwise it is blank.
SCHEDULED
Schedule Indicator. This field contains the literal **SCHD** if the element on this
line has one or more date/time schedules defined to CA-7. Otherwise it is blank.
2.78 FRQJOB
The FRQJOB command is useful to answer the question, "How does this job get into the
system today?" It presents a reverse jobflow (reverse trigger flow) based on information
in the database. It also checks the status queues (request, ready, and active) for the pres-
ence of each job in the structure as it is being built.
The purpose is to identify how the target job is brought into the active scheduling system
taking into account jobs that are already in the queues. It tracks backward through trig-
gers from the target job to one or more header jobs. A header job is one which is already
in the request, ready, or active queue or one which has one or more defined date/time
schedules, or one which has no job/data set/network triggers defined.
The difference between the FRQJOB command and FRJOB is that a check is made in the
status queues for each job present in the structure. If it is found in one of the queues,
that job is considered a header job even though it may have been triggered by something
else. This identifies the shortest possible control path that results in execution of the
target job.
2.78.1 Syntax
FRQJOB
──FRQJOB──,JOB=─┬─jobname─────────────────┬──────────────────────
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┼─HDRS─┼──┘
└─name#─┘ └─LAST─┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ │ ┌─3───┐ │
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
└─system#─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
JOB
Specifies the specific job(s) from which the reverse flow(s) is started. The value can
be one specific job name, or a substring of 1 to 10 specific job names.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID of the starting job(s) (JOB=) used to start the reverse flow.
It can be a value from 0 to 255. The default is 0, which means the next level con-
tains elements that can cause ANY schedule ID of the starting job to be
triggered/scheduled.
LIST
Specifies the option of listing the entire structure or just the first and last jobs.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Indicates the entire structure is to be listed.
HDRS
Indicates that only those elements identified as 'headers' and the starting job
should be listed.
LAST
Indicates only the first and last elements are to be listed.
2.78.2 Examples
FRQJOB,JOB=PAY3393,SCHID=1
FRQJOB,JOB=AR#3333,SCHID=3,LIST=LAST
FRQJOB,JOB=ORD3388,LVL=13
For example, a vice president of your company calls and asks if job XYZ is going to run
before the end of the day. You issue an FRQJOB command for XYZ and learn that job
X is currently in the request queue, and it triggers job Y which in turn triggers job XYZ.
You can then issue an FQJOB command for job X which gives you an estimate of the
time that job XYZ executes. Without the FRQJOB command, you would have had to
manually analyze the situation with a series of LJOB,LIST=TRIG and LQ commands.
The FRQJOB display does not include any dates or times for elements in the structure.
This is because the flow is being generated backwards through logical control paths.
Also, the display may include jobs with a schedule ID of zero (000) which indicates it
represents any occurrence of the job rather than a specific occurrence of the job. Once
you have determined the origin point(s) for the target job, you can use one of the other
forecasting commands to retrace a particular control path from the origin point to the
target job with dates and times provided.
< FRQJOB,JOB=FLOW4H
=
FRQJOB DATE 33-23-yy PAGE 3331
REVERSE STRUCTURE FOR CA-7 JOBS (INCLUDING QUEUES)
JOB(S) : FLOW4H
A B
HEADER JOB/NETWORK NAME : FLOW1A (3842)
K L
The forecasting summary page for FRQJOB follows the general format of all forecasting
commands with the following exceptions:
Item Description
A This field shows the name of the first (or only) origination point (header) for the
control flow which eventually results in the target job. If the job is currently in one
of the status queues the CA-7 job number is displayed also (0842).
B If there are multiple possible origin points in the reverse jobflow, this area contains
the text AND OTHERS. If there is only one origination point (header) for the
flow, this area is blank.
< FRQJOB,JOB=FLOW4H
=
FRQJOB DATE 33-23-yy PAGE 3331
REVERSE STRUCTURE FOR CA-7 JOBS (INCLUDING QUEUES)
HDR LEV# JOB NAME SYSTEM SID TYPE TRIGGERS /DSNBR /SCHEDULED
--- FLOW4H ............ FLOWSYS 333
-331 FLOW3D .......... FLOWSYS 331 JOB FLOW4H
-332 FLOW2C ........ FLOWSYS 333 DSET FLOW3D :DS333343
3842 -333 FLOW1A ...... FLOWSYS 331 JOB FLOW2C
TYPE
Type of element. This field contains a literal which describes the type of element
and trigger the line represents.
Possible values are:
JOB This indicates the element in the Job Name field is a job which triggers the
job in the Triggers field through a job trigger.
DSET This indicates the element in the Job Name field is a job which updates or
creates a data set (DSNBR field) which triggers the job in the Triggers
field through a data set trigger.
INWK This indicates the element in the Job Name field is an input network which
triggers the job in the Triggers field through a network trigger.
TRIGGERS
This field contains the name of the job on the next higher level which this element
triggers. For example, the last line of the preceding example means that job
FLOW1A (level -003) triggers job FLOW2C on the next higher level (level -002).
DSNBR
Data Set Number. This field contains the CA-7 data set number of the data set
created or updated by the job shown in the Job Name which causes a data set
trigger to bring in the job shown in Triggers. The DSNBR is only displayed if a
data set trigger is involved; otherwise, it is blank.
SCHEDULED
Schedule Indicator. This field contains the literal **SCHD** if the element on this
line has one or more date/time schedules defined to CA-7. Otherwise it is blank.
2.79 FSTN
Use the FSTN command to provide forecasting of output and input network workstations.
Only the database is used for this forecast.
2.79.1 Syntax
FSTN
──FSTN──,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬──────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ └─,RINT=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─DLDT─┐ │
└─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘ └─,SEQ=─┼─DODT─┼──┘
└─network#─┘ └─STN──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,STN=─┼─station─────────────────┼──┘
├─station#────────────────┤
└─(station1,...station1%)─┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the forecast time interval. FROM is
required. See 1.8.2.2, “Forecast Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. Either TO or
SPAN must be specified. If TO is used, SPAN must be omitted. See 1.8.2.2, “Fore-
cast Interval” on page 1-31 for more information.
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh, the minimum value is 1
hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.79.2 Examples
FSTN,FROM=(333533,3833),TO=(3316,17)
FSTN,FROM=33,TO=33,STN=KEYPUNCH
FSTN,FROM=(33,17),SPAN=8,NW=RPT,STN=(BURST,DISTR)
FSTN,FROM=32,SPAN=24,RINT=3345
< FSTN,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FSTN DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3331
STATIONS(S) : ALL
NETWORK(S) : ALL
< FSTN,FROM=333633,TO=333633
=
FSTN DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
START DTTM END DTTM STN #/NAME NETWORK SUBID SCHED# SID CONNJOB/SID
33365/3933 33365/1133 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1233 33365/1333 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1333 33365/1533 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/1533 33365/1533 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:331
33365/1633 33365/1733 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/1733 33365/1933 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33365/1933 33365/1933 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:332
33365/2333 33365/2133 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33365/2133 33365/2333 1 BURST TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:334
33365/2333 33365/2333 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:333
33366/3333 33366/3133 2 TRIM TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:334
33366/3333 33366/3333 3 BINS TESTONWK RPT1235 SO333331 331 DUCCXX31:334
2.80 FSTRUC
Use this command to produce a report displaying an entire CPU job flow structure with
the starting and ending times. The principal emphasis is on the job flow structure and the
elapsed time of each job. The start time of the first job can be any arbitrary time. Only
the database is used for this forecast.
2.80.1 Syntax
FSTRUC
──FSTRUC──┬─────────────────────┬────────────────────────────────
└─,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,LIST=─┴─LAST─┴──┘
└─name#─┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────────
│ ┌─133─┐ │ │ ┌─1───┐ │
└─,LVL=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
└─system#─┘ ├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the time interval to be forecast.
Default: Current date and time
Required: No
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Leading zeros are required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). A leading zero is required if less than 10.
yy
Is the year.
hhmm
Specifies the time.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
LIST
Specifies the option of listing the entire structure of the job(s) or just the first and
last jobs.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Indicates the whole structure of the job is to be listed.
LAST
Indicates only the first and last jobs are to be listed.
2.80.2 Examples
FSTRUC,FROM=31,SYS=PAYROLL,LIST=LAST
FSTRUC,FROM=33,JOB=G431M,SCHID=2
Note: When using a generic job name, only those jobs meeting the criteria entered and
also having a schedule (or not triggered) are included.
FSTRUC Screen
< FSTRUC,FROM=351833
=
FSTRUC DATE 35-15-33 PAGE 3332
LEV# JOB NAME SYS START DTTM END DTTM TRIGGERING JOB/DSN/SID
--- T2LIB111............ SYSTBKUP 33263/1528 33263/1548 :331
331 T2TSOPAK.......... SYSTBKUP 33261/3343 33261/3433 T2LIB111 :331
332 T2SYSTEM........ SYSTBKUP 33261/3343 33261/3433 T2TSOPAK :331
333 T2LIB114...... SYSTBKUP 33261/3343 33261/3433 T2SYSTEM :331
334 T2CATLG2.... SYSTBKUP 33261/3334 33261/3433 T2LIB114 :331
335 T2LIB115.. SYSTBKUP 33261/3343 33261/3433 T2CATLG2 :331
336 T2LIB119 SYSTBKUP 33261/3342 33261/3433 T2LIB115 :331
--- T2LIB112............ SYSTBKUP 33261/1528 33261/1549 :331
331 T2LIB118.......... SYSTBKUP 33262/3343 33262/3433 T2LIB112 :331
332 T2LIB113........ SYSTBKUP 33262/3345 33262/3433 T2LIB118 :331
333 T2TMSBK1...... SYSTBKUP 33262/3353 33262/3433 T2LIB113 :331
334 ROBDAILY.... SYSTBKUP 33262/3233 33262/3433 T2TMSBK1 :331
--- T2LIB117............ SYSTBKUP 33262/1528 33262/1549 :331
331 T2LIB116.......... SYSTBKUP 33262/3341 33262/3433 T2LIB117 :331
--- T2MVSPG2............ SYSTBKUP 33262/1528 33262/1552 :331
K L
2.81 FTAPE
Use the FTAPE command to provide a tape pull list for CPU jobs. Only the database is
used for this forecast.
2.81.1 Syntax
FTAPE
──FTAPE──,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)──,─┬─TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┬─────────────
└─SPAN=hhhh────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─3───┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
└─name#─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ │ ┌─J──────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘ └─,TRIG=─┼─D──────┼──┘
└─system#─┘ ├─┬─JD─┬─┤
│ └─DJ─┘ │
└─N──────┘
Where:
You can find more information on any parameters not listed here in 1.8.1.3, “Common
Forecast Parameter Descriptions” on page 1-25.
FROM
Specifies the beginning date and time for the time interval to be forecast. FROM is
required.
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Required. Leading zero is required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted, 01 is assumed. Leading
zero is required.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If omitted, the current year is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If omitted, 0000 is assumed.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
TO
Specifies the ending date and time for the time interval to be forecast. Either TO or
SPAN is required. If TO is omitted, SPAN must be specified.
mmddyy
Specifies the date.
mm
Is the month (01 through 12). Required. Leading zero is required.
dd
Is the day (01 through 31). Optional. If omitted, last day of month is
assumed. Leading zero is required.
yy
Is the year. Optional. If omitted, the current year is assumed.
hhmm
Specifies the time. Optional. If omitted, 2359 is assumed.
hh
Is the hour (00 through 23).
mm
Is the minute (00 through 59).
SPAN
Specifies the length of the time interval to be forecast. This value is added to the
FROM date and time-of-day to determine the ending date and time of the forecast
time interval.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhhh with the minimum value
is 1 hour and maximum value is 8784 hours
Required: Yes, unless TO is used
2.81.2 Examples
FTAPE,FROM=32,TO=(3232,1733)
FTAPE,FROM=(373533,3833),SPAN=48,SYS=PAYROLL
FTAPE,FROM=35,SPAN=72,TRIG=JD
< FTAPE,FROM=(3336,3333),SPAN=8
=
FTAPE DATE 32-27-33 PAGE 3332
TAPE PULL LIST FOR CA-7 JOBS
PERIOD : 33-36-33 AT 3333 HRS TO 33-36-33 AT 3833 HRS
2.82 FWLP
Use the FWLP command to select information from the CA-7 database and queues for
use as input for the CA-7 WLP simulator and PROJECTION reports. This input supplies
all critical information about the resource configuration(s) and jobs scheduled for a speci-
fied time frame. The file created by FWLP consists of card-image, fixed format records
to facilitate additions, deletions, and updates for possible resource and job specification
changes through a standard text editor (CA-7, TSO, CA-Roscoe, and so forth).
2.82.1 Syntax
FWLP
──FWLP──┬─────────────────────┬──┬───────────────────┬───────────
└─,FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┘ └─,TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)─┘
──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬──────────────────
│ ┌─NONE───┐ │ │ ┌─33─┐ │
└─,DDNAME=─┴─ddname─┴──┘ └─,DEMAND=─┴─nn─┴──┘
──┬────────────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────────────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname─────────────────┼──┘
├─jobname#────────────────┤
└─(jobname1,...jobname1%)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└─,JOBNET=─┼─name──┼──┘ └─,MAINID=─┼─SYn──┼──┘
└─name#─┘ └─/SYn─┘
──┬────────────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ │ ┌─3───┐ │
└─,─┬─RESA=─┴─UCC7Rxxx─┴──┬──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
│ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─RESP=─┴─UCC7Rxxx─┴──┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬───────────────────┬─────────────────────
│ ┌─8────┐ │ │ ┌─M──────┐ │
└─,SPAN=─┴─hhhh─┴──┘ └─,SYS=─┴─system─┴──┘
──┬───────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────────
│ ┌─J─┐ │ │ ┌─ACTUAL─┐ │
└─,TRIG=─┴─N─┴──┘ └─,TYPE=─┴─ALL────┴──┘
Where:
FROM=(mmddyy,hhmm)
Specifies the beginning date and time for the time frame to be generated for the
simulation. FROM is optional. If omitted, the default is current date and time, and
all current jobs are generated, including jobs currently in the request, ready, and
active queues. If the current date but not the current time is to be used, the format
may be specified as (,hhmm). If FROM is specified, the queue information is not
included.
TO=(mmddyy,hhmm)
Specifies the ending date and time for the time frame to be generated. TO is
optional. If omitted, SPAN data is added to FROM data to calculate TO. (See
2.82.2, “FWLP Notes” on page 2-192.) If the current date but not the current time is
to be used, the format may be specified as (,hhmm).
DDNAME
Specifies the ddname in the CA-7 execution JCL which defines the data set which
contains the data cards written as a result of the FWLP command.
Default: NONE
Required: No
NONE
Indicates no data is to be written to a WLP data set. In this case, only the
online portion of WLP is executed and only a Workload Planning Summary
report is generated.
ddname
Identifies the ddname to which WLP information is written. (This name must
correspond to a DD statement in the CA-7 online execution JCL. It points to the
same data set which is referenced as input by the batch simulation execution of
WLP. It must not reference a U7xxxxxx DD statement that is used to allocate a
volume.)
DEMAND
Specifies the percentage of DEMAND work to be generated. This causes dummy
job data to be generated on the output file (specified by DDNAME). Each dummy
JOB card has attributes representing average values of the actual JOB data cards
created. The due-out times of these dummy jobs are spaced at equal intervals
throughout the specified time frame. DEMAND is optional. If omitted, the default
is 0. The value may be derived from APA averages (see Job category graphs 20,
900, 1240, and so forth).
JOB
Specifies the job(s) to be selected for simulation.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs are to be considered.
jobname
Specifies the job name(s) to be considered for simulation. Job name may be
specific or generic.
(jobname1,jobname2,...,jobname10)
Indicates a list of job names. Up to 10 specific job names may be specified.
JOBNET
Specifies the job network field as the selection criteria for the jobs to be forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Specifies all names.
name
Specifies a specific name.
name*
Specifies a generic name terminated with an asterisk.
Note: If value contains blank, comma, or quote, it may not be possible to specify
the value through batch input.
MAINID
Specifies the CPU as selection criteria for the jobs to be included in the WLP input
data. If jobs input to the simulation impose CPU restrictions as specified by
MAINID, these jobs are included or excluded as indicated. MAINID is optional, but
if used, one of the following is required.
ALL
Indicates MAINID is to be disregarded as a basis for job selection. This is the
default.
SYn
Indicates the CPU where n is the CA-7 system number.
/SYn
Indicates not this CPU.
RESA
Identifies the initial resource picture module name to be used. Using RESA instead
of RESP causes FWLP to produce a resource (RES) data card each time it encounters
scheduled changes in the WLB processing objectives criteria in the specified time
frame. (The A indicates ascending.)
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates that the initial resource picture for the simulation process is the one
currently in use within CA-7.
UCC7Rxxx
Identifies a CA-7 WLB processing objectives definition module, which exists on
the Load library, to be referenced by a WLP batch execution. (See the Work-
load Balancing and Performance Management section in the CA-7 Systems Pro-
grammer Guide.) This module is loaded during the batch simulation processing
to supply resource specifications. This module overrides the current module on
the first RES card which is generated.
RESP
Identifies one resource picture module name to be used to generate RES card in the
data file. If RESP is specified instead of RESA, the module or default defined here
is to be used throughout the simulation process. (The P indicates permanent.)
Values are the same as described for RESA.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID value as the selection criteria for jobs to be forecast.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 255
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: Only if job has no defined schedule
SPAN
Specifies the time interval in hours, with a minimum value of 1 and a maximum
value of 8784 (approximately one year). This value is added to the FROM value to
determine the ending date and time for the interval. SPAN is optional. If omitted
and TO is also omitted, the default is 8 hours. (See 2.82.2, “FWLP Notes” on
page 2-192.)
SYS
Specifies system name(s) as a selection criteria for the jobs to be selected for simu-
lation.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all systems are to be considered.
system
Designates a system to be considered for simulation. System may be specific or
generic. If JOB=J*,SYS=S* is specified, only those jobs whose names start with
J and which belong to systems with names starting with S are selected for the
simulation.
TRIG
Specifies whether the WLP simulator input data generated is to include job-triggered
jobs.
Default: J
Required: No
J
Indicates job-triggered jobs are to be included.
N
Indicates no job-triggered jobs are to be included.
TYPE
Specifies whether the "don't schedule before/after" criteria defined on the DB.1
screen is to be honored when generating the data cards. (See 2.82.2, “FWLP
Notes.”)
Default: ACTUAL
Required: No
ACTUAL
Honor "don't schedule before/after" criteria.
ALL
Ignore the "don't schedule before/after" criteria.
The online Workload Planning Summary report provides a summary of the data generated
by the FWLP command.
< =
FWLP DATE 31-31-33 PAGE 3331
MM W O R K L O A D P L A N N I N G S U M M A R Y MM
RESTART ACTIVITY
Indicates estimated resource requirements calculated from individual job rerun rate
frequencies and average run requirements. These values represent the statistical
average amount of restart activity to be expected. They do not necessarily repre-
sent the amount of restart activity reflected in the batch WLP Projection reports,
however, since batch WLP allows the user to specify alternate ways of estimating
the restart requirements.
DEMAND ACTIVITY
Indicates estimated percent requirements for DEMAND jobs. Values are a per-
centage of the total WLP jobs for this FWLP command. The percentage corre-
sponds with the value of the DEMAND parameter of FWLP.
TOTALS
Indicates summary figures for this FWLP command, including regularly scheduled
jobs, restarts and demanded jobs.
2.83 GRAPHc
Use the GRAPHc top line command to request graphs. It is available as an alternative to
the APA Menu and prompt screens on 2.42, “APA” on page 2-83. The graphs are
divided into five categories. Each category may be invoked independently through use of
one of the two following top line command formats:
2.83.1 Syntax
GRAPHc
──GRAPHc──,ID=─┬─nnnn───────┬───┬───────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─,──┐ │ └─,─┬─FROM=mmddyy────┬──┘
!nnnn┴─)─┘
└─(── ├─TO=mmddyy──────┤
├─SCALE=nnnnnnnn─┤
├─DIV1=nnnnnnnn──┤
└─DIV2=nnnnnnnn──┘
──┬───────────────────┬──────────────────────────────────────────
└─,GLINE=─┬─PRIM─┬──┘
├─SCND─┤
└─CALC─┘
or
GRAPHc
──GRAPHc──,LIST=─┬─HELP─┬───────────────────────────────────────
├─DETL─┤
└─ALL──┘
Where:
c
Indicates the graph category. Value can be one of the following:
D
Database statistics
J
Job statistics
N
Network statistics
R
Report statistics
S
System statistics
ID=nnnn|(nnnn,nnnn,...,nnnn)
Specifies the graph(s) to be displayed where nnnn is the 4-digit graph identification
number as listed in the graph directory. Leading zeros are not required. Up to 10
such numbers can be specified. Each graph identification number must be defined in
the appropriate graph definition table. This parameter is required unless the LIST
format of the command is used.
FROM=mmddyy
Specifies the beginning date to start displaying statistical data. Value must not be
less than current date minus two years, nor greater than the current date. When only
the month is entered, the default is the first of the month specified and the current
year. Optional; if omitted, the current date is assumed.
TO=mmddyy
Specifies the ending date, in the format mmddyy, to end displaying statistical data.
Value must be greater than or equal to the date specified in FROM and not greater
than the current date. When only the month is entered, the default is the last day of
the month specified and the current year. Optional; if omitted, the current date is
assumed.
SCALE=nnnnnnn
Temporarily overrides the default scale value defined for the graph ID being dis-
played. This value contains up to 7 digits and does not affect the actual numbers to
be displayed, only the scale numbers and the length of the graph line. This param-
eter is optional.
DIV1=nnnnnnn
Temporarily overrides the default division factor for the primary counter of the graph
being displayed (7 digits maximum). This parameter is optional.
DIV2=nnnnnnn
Temporarily overrides the default division factor for the secondary counter of the
graph being displayed. This keyword is valid only for comparison graphs (7 digits
maximum). This parameter is optional.
GLINE
This keyword is optional. It temporarily overrides the predefined counter used on the
graph line. Valid values are:
PRIM
Uses the primary counter.
SCND
Uses the secondary counter (comparison graphs only).
CALC
Uses the calculated value (comparison graphs only).
LIST
This keyword is optional, and if specified, must be the only parameter listed. Valid
values are:
HELP
Displays the graph directory.
DETL
Displays the values chosen for all parameters used in defining each graph in the
category specified. See LIST=DETL Function Example on page 2-198 for an
example of the LIST=DETL function. (See the Changing Graph Definitions
topic in the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide for the available values of these
parameters.) See the CA-7 Reports Guide for a complete listing of the graphs
available through the Automated Performance Analysis (APA) facility.
ALL
Displays the current counters of all graphs in the category specified for that par-
ticular moment. Each graph is listed separately with individual totals and com-
plete totals. See LIST=ALL Function Example on page 2-198 for an example of
a partial listing of the LIST=ALL function.
2.83.2 Examples
LIST=DETL Function
< GRAPHS,LIST=DETL =
MM COMPUTER ASSOCIATES INTERNATIONAL, INC. MM
...GRAPH DETAIL DEFINITION SCREEN... PAGE 3331
DESCRIPTION / ID TYPE TOTALS SCALE GRAPH CALCULATION DIV1 DIV2
K L
LIST=ALL Function
< GRAPHS,LIST=ALL =
MM COMPUTER ASSOCIATES INTERNATIONAL, INC. MM
.....CURRENT STATUS - 12/22/yy..... PAGE 3331
GRAPHJ,ID=373,FROM=mmddyy
Where mmddyy is the beginning of the time period to be reported in month, day and year
format. Current time is the default period ending time for the graph. This gives up-to-
the-second information.
For example:
GRAPHS,ID=(13,23,73,133,153),FROM=313133,TO=313133
would display System graphs 0010, 0020, 0070, 0130, and 0150 with statistics captured
from 01/01/00 to 01/31/00.
2.84 HELP
Use the HELP facility for a quick means of obtaining tutorials about the CA-7 applica-
tions and commands.
This facility is informational only with no direct effect on the CA-7 system or its opera-
tion.
To exit:
Press PF3 to return to the HELP screen.
Enter a top line command.
Change the command shown to any other batch format HELP option.
Replace the command shown with EXIT to return to the HELP screen.
FUNCTION
This field is only used to transfer to some other menu or some other formatted
screen function which is only offered on some other menu. To transfer to some
other screen, enter the name of the desired screen.
INDEX
Enter Y to display an index listing of all commands. The display includes:
Names of all commands
Application name to which each command belongs
Brief description of each command's purpose
If used, remaining fields on this screen are ignored. Leave blank if APPLICA-
TION or COMMAND are used.
APPLICATION
This field is used to display information about a specific CA-7 application.
Numeric value from the list on the screen may be entered or, if already known, the
specific four character application name may be entered.
If used, the remaining fields on the screen are ignored. Leave blank if INDEX or
COMMAND are used.
The display includes:
General discussion of the application
List of all available commands in the application with a short description of
each command
Example of the format of each command
COMMAND
This field is used to display information about a specific command. To use, enter
the name of the command just as it would be entered on the top line (for example,
LJOB, /MSG).
This field is ignored if INDEX or APPLICATION are used.
If all HELP information for that command is wanted, leave the following fields
blank. The display includes all of the parts that can be individually selected with
the following fields. Use the following fields to display only selected portions of
HELP information. Y in all of them displays the same information as if none of
them were selected.
FORMAT
Enter Y to display a sample format for the command.
EXAMPLE
Enter Y to display examples of the command.
GENERAL
Enter Y to display a general discussion of the command and its purpose.
DETAIL
Enter Y to display a detailed discussion of each command keyword.
2.85 HOLD
Use the HOLD command to interrupt the normal scheduling progress by holding the
forward movement of a job. It may also be used to hold the contents of an entire queue.
This function is available on the QM.1, QM.6, and QM.7 screens with a FILL value of
H. Depending on the timing and whether there are any other predecessor situations, this
can sometimes be accomplished with the QM.3 screen.
2.85.1 Syntax
HOLD
──HOLD──┬────────────────────────────┬──────────────────────────
└─,─┬─JOB=─┬─jobname───┬──┬──┘
│ ├─jobnumber─┤ │
│ └─refnumber─┘ │
└─Q=─┬─REQ─┬──────────┘
└─RDY─┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the individual job or workstation network to be held. JOB must be omitted
if Q is specified.
Required: Yes (unless the Q parameter is used)
jobname
Specifies the job name of the CPU job to be held.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Specifies the job number of the CPU job to be held.
refnumber
Specifies the value for a workstation network task must be entered as the CA-7
assigned reference number in the format nnnnrrs.
nnnn
Is the CA-7 job number.
rr
Is the relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associ-
ated with the job. For input workstation networks, the value is 00.
s
Identifies the position of the station within the network. The first station
would be position 1.
Q
Indicates the contents of an entire queue are to be held. Q must be omitted if JOB is
specified.
Required: Yes (unless the JOB parameter is used)
REQ
Indicates to hold all jobs currently in the request queue.
RDY
Indicates to hold all jobs currently in the ready queue.
When a HOLD is issued by job name, all jobs and workstation networks with that name
are held. There may be multiple jobs with the same name.
A specific input workstation network may be held in the preprocess queue. All output
workstation networks associated with a specific (CPU) job name or CA-7 job number
may be held in the postprocess queue.
Workstation networks are held only if a station is found logged in but not logged out.
A HOLD command issued for an entire queue affects only those jobs in the queue at the
time the command is processed. Jobs entering the queue after the HOLD are not placed
in hold status unless done individually.
Jobs may also be moved into the request queue in HOLD status when the DEMANDH,
RUNH, or LOADH commands are used.
2.85.3 Examples
HOLD,JOB=CA7JOB9
HOLD,JOB=163
HOLD,Q=REQ
HOLD,JOB=3378312
2.86 IN
Each workstation task has a unique reference number. CA-7 generates this reference
number each time the network associated with the workstation enters a CA-7 queue. This
number may be obtained by using the LPRE or LPOST commands. The number is then
used to log in the start of the workstation task(s). This indicates that the task is in-
process and automatically logs the start time for the task being performed.
This function is available as the LOGIN or FORCE LOGIN options on the QM.6 and
QM.7 screens.
2.86.1 Syntax
IN
──IN──,REF=─┬─nnnnrrs──────┬───┬────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─,────┐ │ └─,FORCE=YES─┘
!nnnrrs┴─)─┘
└─(──
Where:
REF
Identifies the workstation tasks to be logged in.
Required: Yes
nnnnrrs
Identifies a single workstation task reference number.
Note: Workstation task reference numbers can be obtained by using an LPRE
or LPOST command.
nnnn
Is the CA-7 job number. (Leading zeros may be omitted.)
rr
Is the relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associ-
ated with the job. For input workstation networks, the value is 00.
(Leading zeros may not be omitted.)
s
Identifies the relative position of the station within the network. The first
station is position 1.
(nnnnrrs,...,nnnnrrs)
Identifies up to 10 workstation task reference numbers. Must be enclosed by
parentheses.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 numeric characters
FORCE
Allows the logging in of an output network prior to completion of the CPU job to
which it is associated. If used, the value must be entered as shown. FORCE=YES
only has meaning for output networks.
Required: No
Each workstation task and its associated network are assigned a unique CA-7 reference
number when the network is placed in the preprocess queue. The unique reference
number must be used by each workstation, except the first in the network, to log the start
and completion of work.
Workstations within a network must log in and log out in the workstation sequence
defined to CA-7. Only one workstation at a time may be logged in for a given network.
A single workstation may be logged in for more than one network at a time. Each work-
station must log in before it may log out. A workstation may not log in until the pre-
ceding workstation in the network has logged out.
A workstation may be prompted for an activity that has already completed if CA-7 was
not properly notified of the completion. In response to the prompt, LOGIN and
LOGOUT commands should be used to notify CA-7 of task completion. You can use the
IN command instead of LOGIN. You can use the IO command to log in and log out
with a single command. See 2.87, “IO” on page 2-211 for more information.
If the same station is defined in the network more than once, the LOGIN and LOGOUT
commands should not be used.
All output networks connected to the job (through DB.3.4 screen) are assigned the same
CA-7 job number used to identify the job in the request queue. This job number must be
used by each workstation, except the first, to log the start and completion of its activity.
Since multiple output networks may exist for a single job (and job number), network
and/or SUBID information must also be used when logging starts or an activity com-
pletes.
When CA-7/RPT is used to request networks based on report creation, the output net-
works are scheduled independently of any jobs, are assigned unique numbers in the
queue, and are not connected through DB.3.4.
Workstations within a network must log in and log out in their defined sequence. Only
one workstation at a time may be logged in for a given network. A single workstation
may be logged in to more than one network at the same time. Each workstation must log
in before it may log out. A workstation may not log in until the preceding workstation in
the network has logged out (for that activity).
A workstation may be prompted for an activity that has already been completed if CA-7
was not properly notified of the completion. LOGIN and LOGOUT commands should be
used in response to the prompt to notify CA-7 of task completion. You can use the IN
Command Response in place of LOGIN. See 2.86.4, “IN Command Response” on
page 2-208 for more information. The IN top line command is used to indicate the
beginning of a workstation task. The IO command in this chapter may be used to log in
and log out with a single command.
If the same station is defined in a network more than once, LOGIN and LOGOUT should
not be used.
< IN,REF=3331331 =
REF JOB NETWORK SUBID STATION -------------REMARKS------ -------
K L
Remarks: Following is a list of possible IN command remarks. Each is described in
detail, followed by the required action to be taken where applicable. These appear on the
screen under the heading REMARKS.
ALREADY LOGGED IN
Explanation: The station specified by the reference number is already logged in.
User Response: If the reference number on the original input is correct, no action is required. If
not, correct and reenter the IN request.
DOTM=*RUSH*
Explanation: The first station has been successfully logged in. The due-out time for the station
indicates the work is critical and should be done as soon as possible.
User Response: Process the work as soon as possible, then log out.
DOTM=yyddd/hhmm
Explanation: The first station has been successfully logged in and the due-out time for that station
is printed. yyddd is a variable of 5 characters representing the due-out date; hhmm the due-out
time-of-day.
User Response: None.
FROM xxx...x,DOTM=*RUSH*
Explanation: The next station(s) has been successfully logged in for work that was last handled by
station xxx...x. The due-out time for the station(s) indicates the work is critical and should be done
as soon as possible.
User Response: Process the work as soon as possible, then log out.
FROM xxx...x,DOTM=yyddd/hhmm
Explanation: The next station(s) has been successfully logged in for work that was last handled by
station xxx...x. The preceding station and the due-out time for the current station are indicated.
User Response: Perform the task as scheduled.
JOB HELD
Explanation: The task specified by the reference number is in hold status.
User Response: Determine why the task is being held. After the task is released, reenter the
request.
Q ANALYSIS INCOMPLETE
Explanation: CA-7 is not finished with a previous activity using the requested reference number's
queue record.
User Response: Wait a few moments then reenter the request. If the message persists, contact the
CA-7 coordinator in your data center.
2.86.5 Examples
IN,REF=3311311
Login workstation task 0011011 referenced by CA-7 job 0011, network sequence 01 and
station position 1.
IN,REF=11311
Same as above, only leading zeros of job number have been omitted.
IN,REF=(9332,11312)
IN,REF=11311,FORCE=YES
Login workstation task 0011011 even if the CPU job to which it is associated has not
completed.
2.87 IO
Use the IO command in place of and as a combination of the IN and OUT commands. It
results in simultaneous log in and log out of one or more workstation tasks. The IO
command uses reference numbers to identify each workstation.
2.87.1 Syntax
IO
──IO──,REF=─┬─nnnnrrs──────┬───┬────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─,────┐ │ └─,FORCE=YES─┘
!nnnrrs┴─)─┘
└─(──
Where:
REF
Identifies the workstation tasks to be both logged in and logged out.
Required: Yes
nnnnrrs
Identifies a single workstation task reference number.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 numeric characters
Note: Workstation task reference numbers can be obtained by using an LPRE
or LPOST command.
nnnn
Is the CA-7 job number (leading zeros may be omitted).
rr
Is the relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associ-
ated with the job. For input workstation networks, the value is 00. Leading
zeros may not be omitted.
s
Identifies the relative position of the station within the network. The first
station is position 1.
(nnnnrrs,...,nnnnrrs)
Identifies up to 10 workstation task reference numbers. Must be enclosed in
parentheses.
FORCE
Allows the logging of an output network prior to completion of the CPU job to
which it is associated. If used, the value must be entered as shown. FORCE=YES
only has meaning for output networks.
Required: No
< IO,REF=3331331 =
REF JOB NETWORK SUBID STATION -------------REMARKS------ -------
JOB PURGED
Explanation: The last station in the postprocess queue was successfully logged out. All other
output networks for the job are complete. Therefore, job processing is considered to be complete.
User Response: For information only.
NETWORK COMPLETE
Explanation: The station has been successfully logged out. This was the last station defined in the
network.
User Response: For information only.
SEND TO xxx...x,DLTM=*RUSH*
Explanation: The station has been successfully logged out. The work has been flagged as critical
and should be sent to the next station (xxx...x) as soon as possible. (Not returned for last station in
network.)
User Response: Forward the work to the indicated station as soon as possible.
SEND TO xxx...x,DLTM=yyddd/hhmm
Explanation: The specified station has been successfully logged out. The deadline (start)
time-of-day for the next station in the network (xxx...x) is indicated. (Not returned for last station in
network.)
User Response: Make sure the work is forwarded to the next station.
2.87.3 Examples
IO,REF=3311311
IO,REF=(9332,11312)
IO,REF=11311,FORCE=YES
2.88 JCLOVRD
Use the JCLOVRD command to establish or satisfy JCL override requirements. This
command is primarily used when the job does not have a permanent JCL override
requirement assigned. The job for which the JCL override is being established (or satis-
fied) must be in the request queue.
This function is available as the J value for FILL FUNCTION on the QM.1 screen. It
can also be accomplished with the QM.2 and QM.3 screens.
2.88.1 Syntax
JCLOVRD
──JCLOVRD──,JOB=jobnumber──,SET=─┬─ON──┬────────────────────────
└─OFF─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the CA-7 job number of the job in the request queue for which the override
requirement is to be established or removed.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes
SET
Establishes or satisfies JCL override requirements. When a job fails with a JCL
error, the JCL override requirement is automatically set to ON when the job returns
to the request queue. The JCL override must be set to OFF before the job can be
submitted again.
Required: Yes
ON
Establishes a JCL override requirement for the specified job. The SET=ON
option is used for jobs in the request queue to indicate that an override is needed
before execution is to occur.
OFF
Satisfies a JCL override requirement for the specified job. The SET=OFF option
indicates that a previously defined need (requirement) for override(s) has been
satisfied and execution can be safely attempted. When a JCL override require-
ment is set to OFF, that requirement no longer appears on a requirements list for
the job. When a REPL is done from the QM.5 screen, the JCL override require-
ment is automatically set to OFF.
For other related override functions, see the DB.1 screen JCL-OVRD field, the #JCL
control statement, scheduled override (#JI, #JO, #XI and #XO) control statements, the
QM.5 screen REPL function, and the CA-7 Editor SAVE command.
2.88.3 Examples
JCLOVRD,JOB=163,SET=ON
JCLOVRD,JOB=163,SET=OFF
2.89 LACT
Use the LACT command to provide general status information on CPU jobs in the active
queue. Parameters allow you to indicate which job or group of jobs is desired, what
information is to be reviewed, and the sequence of displayed data. The active queue only
contains information on jobs that have started executing on a CPU. Other commands are
also available to display other types of data for CPU jobs which reside in the active
queue.
2.89.1 Syntax
LACT
──LACT──┬────────────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬─────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=option─┘
└────,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼─────┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ └─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─NATV─────┐ │ └─,ST=option─┘
└─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼──┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose active queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Specifies options for the amount of active queue information to be displayed.
Required: No
ALL
List all data related to the job(s) being displayed.
JCL
List JCL information only.
Depending on the security options selected for your installation, the following
values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
PROS
List documentation information only.
Q
List job data only.
RQMT
List all requirements information only.
When LIST and JOB are not specified, a default display consisting of a description
line for each queue record is received. If SEG is specified, the default is
LIST=PROS.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation to be listed. If a subsegment,
use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy). SEG and subsegments are both optional.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of the segment.
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
The names of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy) in up to 8
characters each, enclosed in parentheses and separated by a comma.
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Required: No
Default: NATV
NATV
Information appears in native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
Information appears in CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Information appears in deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Information appears in due-out time sequence.
JOB
Information appears in job name sequence.
ST
Specifies a selection option to be used in determining which jobs are listed.
Required: No
ABND
Displays jobs abnormally terminated due to abend, condition code failure, or JCL
error.
CBAD
Displays jobs which are flagged due to condition code failure.
HELD
Selects jobs in HOLD status.
JCLO
Selects jobs with an outstanding JCL override or verification requirement.
JCLR
Selects jobs which have failed due to JCL error.
LATE
Displays jobs which are late.
MANV
Displays jobs with an outstanding manual verification requirement.
NOID
Selects jobs flagged due to undetermined or invalid security ID during sub-
mission.
REQU
Displays jobs which have been requeued manually.
RSTR
Selects jobs in restart status.
RTRY
Shows jobs flagged for retry due to JCL attach failures related to dynamic allo-
cation.
SKEL
Displays jobs in skeleton status due to JCL attach failures.
SUBM
Selects jobs which have been submitted to a host CPU.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose active queue information is to be
listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.89.2 Examples
LACT,SEQ=JOB
LACT,JOB=G431M,SEQ=JOB
< LACT
=
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME NUM DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
CA7BTI31 ACT 3325 233/1245 MNONEM 233/1245 ALL-IPO1 331 DEMD 333
ENTRY MODE
How the job was brought into the queue. Values are:
ARFJ ARF recovery job.
AUTO TRIGGERed job.
DEMD DEMANDed job.
EXTL Job submitted external to CA-7.
LOAD Job record to be LOADed (brought in by LOAD command).
PS Job submitted by Personal Scheduling System.
RUN Job brought in by the RUN command.
SSCN Job record brought in by schedule scan.
XDEM Job brought in by the DEMAND command from an XPS client.
XPS Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command with the
REF option.
XRUN Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command.
Note: If ARF detects an exception condition for the job, the last character of this
field has an asterisk as in the following: DEM*
MSTR REQ
The number of outstanding master requirements for a job record.
JOB STATUS
The indication of the job's current disposition. Values and their meanings are:
A-Snnnn The job has failed with a system abend.
A-Unnnn The job has failed with a user abend.
C-Cnnnn The job has completed successfully and is going through completion
processing.
LATE The job has not either started by the DEADLINE DAY/TIME or has
not completed by its DUE-OUT DAY/TIME.
R-#nnnn The job has failed a condition code test made at the step level.
R-Cnnnn The job has failed a condition code test made at the job level.
R-JCLERR If the job is in the request queue with this status, then there was
either a runtime JCL error (for example, data set not found) or an
IEFUJV exit canceled the job. If the job is in the ready queue with
this status, then a job purge record was received before a job initial-
ization record.
R-NOUID During submission, if no valid USERID is available, a check of the
SUBNOID parameter is done to determine if a job may be submitted
without an ID. With SUBNOID set to NO, the job is moved back to
the request queue with a status of R-NOUID.
R-TRLFUL At the time the job was active, CA-7 required another track to be
obtained from the trailer queue to hold outputs. At the time that
CA-7 tried to get another track, either an out of space condition or
an I/O error occurred.
RETRY A dynamic allocation error occurred during the attach of JCL for this
job. At a user-specified time interval, a retry of the JCL attach
occurs.
RQMT-INC A job record is in the queue without its requirements attached.
RUSH The RUSH command was entered for this job.
SKELETON
A job record is in the queue without JCL attached.
2.90 LACTR
Use the LACTR command to provide resource requirement information on jobs in the
active queue. This lets you review the resource requirements of the currently active CPU
workload. This command is similar to the LQR command.
2.90.1 Syntax
LACTR
──LACTR──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │
└─,CPUID=─┴─smfid─┴──┘
──┬────────────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ │ ┌─ALL──┐ │
└────,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼─────┘ └─,MAINID=─┼─SYn──┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤ ├─/SYn─┤
└─jobnumber─┘ └─-SYn─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ │ ┌─NATV─────┐ │
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼──┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
CPUID
Indicates the CPU ID(s) for which jobs are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all CPU IDs.
smfid
Indicates only jobs with this specific CPU ID. The value is the SMF system ID.
CPUID as a search argument in the inquiry command, must match the SMF
system identifier as defined to the OS system by the user and received by CA-7
in the SMF records.
JOB
Indicates the job(s) whose active queue resource information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
MAINID
Indicates that only those jobs with this MAINID (as defined on the DB.1 screen) are
to be listed. Jobs defined with MAINID of ALL are selected regardless of MAINID
entered.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Indicates all MAINIDS.
SYn
Where n indicates a CPU associated number for which information is to be listed
as defined in the initialization file CPU statement. The value of n may range
from 1 to 7. If a slash (/) precedes the SYn, then the only jobs selected are
those that are denoted to execute on /SYn.
-SYn
Where n indicates a CPU associated number for which information is not to be
listed. The value of n may range from 1 to 7.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose active queue resource information is
to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.90.2 Examples
LACTR,MAINID=SY2
LACTR,JOB=FXABA32M
< LACTR
=
JOB=FXABA32M DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB SYSTEM MAIN JOB CPU CA-7# CPU/ELAPS TOTAL TAPES CPU% SUBMIT
NAME -NAME- -ID- C/PRT -ID NUMBR --TIME--- TP1 TP2 UTIL DATE/TIME
2.91 LARF
Use this command to list ARFSETs in summary or in detail. The ARFSETs are stored in
alphabetical order by ARFSET name. Each ARFSET contains one or more ARFSET
definitions. Each ARFSET definition defines a specific job processing condition which
may arise during the course of the job's execution, such as a system D37 abend. Associ-
ated with each test is a list of ARF responses which is carried out by ARF if the desig-
nated condition should arise. This response set may include directives for issuing CA-7
commands or submitting other jobs on behalf of the CA-7 job which met the ARF test
conditions.
2.91.1 Syntax
LARF
──LARF──┬───────────────────────┬──┬───────────────┬────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │ └─,LIST=listopt─┘
└─,ARFSET=─┼─arfset──┼──┘
└─arfset#─┘
Where:
ARFSET
Identifies the ARFSET name.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all ARFSETs.
arfset
Indicates a specific ARFSET name.
Size/Type 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
arfset*
Indicates a generic ARFSET name.
Size/Type 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
LIST
This parameter can be used to override the default list option. The possible values
are:
DEFS
Forces the detail listing of the ARFSET definitions.
NODEFS
Forces the summary listing of the ARFSET definitions.
2.91.2 Examples
< LARF =
ARFSET=M LIST=NODEFS DATE=yy.364 PAGE 3331
ARF SET ARF LAST CHANGE NBR EC EE JC LA LB LE LS SC IS
NAME UID DATE TIME DEF # # # # # # # # #
< LARF,ARFSET=MULTI =
ARFSET=MULTI LIST=DEFS DATE=yy.364 PAGE 3333
RSTC
Restart count condition where this test is to apply.
EM Entry Mode under which the job is running for this test to apply.
FROM TO
The From and To dates defining the time frame within which the tests are to apply.
TESTS RUN
The ARF tests which are run at the time of the intercept. These vary greatly
depending upon the intercept. In this example, the job completion intercept tests
are shown.
STEP
Identifies the step name where the tests are to be applied.
PROC
Identifies the PROC step name where the tests are to be applied.
PGM
Identifies the program name to which the tests apply.
SYS Identifies a system abend condition.
CC Identifies a completion code condition.
USER
Identifies a user abend condition.
FLSH
Identifies a flush condition.
JCL Identifies a JCL error condition.
RESPONSE SET
The set of responses to be attempted by ARF when the test conditions are met. In
the example, several possible ARF responses are illustrated:
M= An example ARF Message response; ARF sends a message to the designated target
and then moves to the next response.
TIME=
An example ARF Wait response; ARF waits the designated number of minutes and
then moves to the next response.
AC An example ARF Command response; ARF issues the designated CA-7 command
and then moves to the next response.
AJ An example ARF Job response; ARF submits another job, waits for that job to
complete, and then moves to the next response.
DISP
The final disposition to assign to the job if all ARF responses complete normally.
M1 The final disposition control detail line 1.
DISP
The disposition directive: R - Restart; C - Cancel; F - Force Complete.
CA-11
Indicates whether CA-11 should be used for the restart.
BYPGDG
Instructs CA-11 in the handling of GDGs during the restart.
USAGE
The CA-11 usage code to be used in restart.
PROCESS
The CA-11 process code to be used in restart.
CC The condition code value to be used in CA-11.
START
The first step in the job where CA-11 should be restart processing.
END
The last step in the job that should be processed when CA-11 is controlling the
restart.
COMPLETED AT
The completion message indicating all processing for this command has completed.
2.92 LARFQ
Use this command to list the ARF queue. The ARF queue identifies all pending and
in-process response activities which were initiated by CA-7 jobs being tracked by ARF
where the designated ARF test conditions were met. Each queue entry defines the pres-
ence of an ARF response set for a single job. The ARF queue is ordered in a first-in,
first-out sequence. A given job may only have one queue entry active at a time. If a
given CA-7 job has met multiple ARFSET tests, the subsequent response sets are queued
up "behind" the one active response set for that job. The active response set for a given
job is referred to as that job's "current" response set. When a job's current response set
comes to a conclusion, ARF "promotes" the next response set which was queued up
behind the current one. The promotion process deletes the previous current response set
and sets up a new current response set for a given job. When all response sets for a
given job have been completed, the job's ARF queue entry is deleted altogether.
2.92.1 Syntax
LARFQ
──LARFQ──┬────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │
└────,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼─────┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the job(s) whose ARF queue resource information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
2.92.2 Examples
< LARFQ =
JOB=M DATE=yy.343 PAGE 3331
JOB JOB ARF SET SET EVENT RSP RSP RSP RESPONSE
NAME NBR NAME IX STATUS CD # TOT TYPE STATUS
2.93 LCTLG
Use the LCTLG command primarily to list data set information from the CA-7 index data
set. You can also use it to list special entries such as documentation, networks, triggers,
or requirements from the CA-7 database. When used to list data sets, volume information,
creation dates and times, and device information are displayed. Also, use this command
to list information from a specific CVOL catalog.
2.93.1 Syntax
LCTLG
──LCTLG──,DSN=dsname──┬────────────────┬────────────────────────
└─,VOLSER=volser─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOLSER
Specifies the volume serial number of a catalog, instead of the CA-7 database index
data set, from which information is to be listed. The value must be the volume serial
of the pack on which the desired catalog data set resides. VOLSER is not used when
listing information from the CA-7 database; only when listing from a catalog on
some other volume.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.93.2 Examples
LCTLG,DSN=CA7.DSN1
LCTLG,DSN=CA7.
LCTLG,DSN=CA7.,VOLSER=CATLG
LCTLG,DSN=NW.STATION1.NETWK1
LCTLG,DSN=AUTO.
LCTLG,DSN=JDEP.
LCTLG,DSN=TRGD.
< LCTLG,DSN=JDEP.
=
DSN=JDEP. DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3332
< LCTLG,DSN=AUTO.
=
DSN=AUTO. DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
AUTO.DS333335 (CA7.TRNG1)
TESTJOB1 333 1233D 3133 3333
AUTO.DS333339 (CA7.TEST9)
DUSAXX13 333 3133Q 3333 3333
AUTO.DS333311 (CA7.TRNG2)
DUTSXX34 333 3323Q 3333 3333
DUSGXX35 331/332 3333Q 3333 3333
K L
DATASET NAME
This is the DSNBR (prefixed by AUTO.) followed by the data set name enclosed in
parentheses of the data set whose creation triggers a job or jobs, or the DSNBR
(prefixed by AUTO.) followed by the input network name enclosed in parentheses
of an input network whose completion triggers a job or jobs.
TRIGGERED JOB
The name of the job that is triggered.
SCHID
The data set must be created or updated or the input network completed under this
schedule ID for the trigger to occur; optionally, followed by a different schedule ID
which the triggered job runs under.
QTM/DOTM
Either the queue time or the due-out time (defined on the appropriate screen) for
this trigger entry in hhmm format.
LEADTM
The lead time for this trigger entry as defined through the appropriate screen in
hhmm format.
SUBMTM
The submit time as defined on the appropriate screen in hhmm format.
< LCTLG,DSN=PP.
=
DSN=PP. DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
< LCTLG,DSN=TRGD.
=
DSN=TRGD. DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
< LCTLG,DSN=PRED.
=
DSN=PRED. DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
< LCTLG,DSN=ABC.
=
DSN=ABC. DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
2.94 LDSN
Use the LDSN command to list data set information from the database including data set
attributes, device and volume information, and information on which jobs use the data set
or are trigger scheduled as a result of its creation.
2.94.1 Syntax
LDSN
──LDSN──,──┬─DSN=dsname─────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬────
└─DSNBR=─┬─DSnnnnnn───┬──┘ │ ┌─DSN────┐ │
├─DS33nnnnnM─┤ └─,LIST=─┴─option─┴──┘
└─DSM────────┘
──┬────────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────
│ ┌─3,32333───────────┐ │
└─,USERS=─┴─(minimum,maximum)─┴──┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set. For partial qualification, the name
may end at a period or may be delimited with an asterisk (*).
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes (unless DSNBR is used)
DSNBR
Specifies a single or generic CA-7 data set number identifying the member(s) whose
records are to be listed. Must be entered with the DS prefix. With this option, the
major sequence of the output listed is by data set number.
Required: Yes (unless DSN is used)
DSnnnnnn
Is the value for a single CA-7 assigned data set number in up to 6 digits with a
prefix of DS. Leading zeros may be omitted.
DS00nnnnn*
Is a generic data set number in up to 7 digits preceded with DS and terminated
with an asterisk. Leading zeros must not be omitted. For example, to list all
DSNBRs that are in the range 7000-7999, use DSNBR=DS00007*.
DS*
Causes all data set records to be listed.
LIST
Specifies list options for data set information.
Default: DSN
Required: No
DSN
List data set information only.
ALL
List data set information, "using-jobs" and documentation entries.
EXTL
List data sets which are classified external to CA-7.
INTL
List data sets which are classified internal to CA-7.
NORM
List data sets shown as NORM on the DB.6 screen. Includes internal and
external data sets.
NOUSER
List data sets which have no "using-jobs."
PERM
List data sets shown as PERM on the DB.6 screen.
TRIG
List all the jobs that are triggered by the data set.
USERS
List all users of a data set. These are jobs which reference the data set in their
JCL. Jobs with large JCL may not show in the list (for example, over 100 steps
and 500 DDs).
Note: LIST=TRIG and LIST=ALL cannot be used for generic requests by DSN or
DSNBR.
USERS
Indicates to select data sets meeting minimum and maximum number of using jobs.
Size/Type: 5 numeric characters from 00000 to 32767
Required: No
minimum
Indicates to select data sets with the specified minimum of using jobs.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select data sets in the specified range of using jobs.
2.94.2 Examples
LDSN,DSN=CA7.DSN1
LDSN,DSN=CA7.DSN1,LIST=USERS
LDSN,DSN=DS53,LIST=ALL
LDSN,DSNBR=DSM,LIST=NOUSER
LDSN,DSNBR=DS33333M
LDSN,DSNBR=DSM,LIST=PERM
LDSN Screen
< LDSN,DSN=SSDDEV.CA37.R333.BATCHO,LIST=ALL
=
LIST=ALL DSN=SSDDEV.CA37.R333.BATCHO DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
< LDSN,DSN=SYS2.PROCLIB =
LIST=DSN DSN=SYS2.PROCLIB DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
LDSN,DSNBR=DS* Screen
< LDSN,DSNBR=DSM =
LIST=DSN DSNBR=DSM DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
BLKSZ
Specifies the blocksize for this data set.
DEVTYP
Specifies the device type (DASD or TAPE) for this data set. (UNKNOWN indi-
cates that the data set was added using the DSN screen without specifying the
device.)
J-USE
Specifies the number of jobs that use this data set as input.
J-CRT
Specifies the number of jobs that created or updated this data set.
#RO Specifies the number of jobs that have had a manual connection made on the
DB.3.1 screen for this data set.
MDATE/TIME
Specifies the date and time of the last maintenance performed on this data set entry.
MTYPE
Indicates the method used for the last maintenance performed on this data set.
ANLZ - for updating that occurred through the RESANL command.
DBM - for updating of this record through the DSN screen.
LOAD - for updating of this record by the load of a job.
SMF - for updating that occurred through SMF data.
2.95 LDTM
Use the LDTM command to display an analysis of outstanding requirements for jobs in
the request queue which involve fixed satisfaction lead times. These are job, data set,
and network requirements where a fixed satisfaction lead time has been specified either
on the requirement definition itself or on the Job definition screen (DB.1).
The LDTM command can be used to determine which outstanding requirements should
be manually posted after an application or system outage has disrupted the normal flow
of the production workload.
2.95.1 Syntax
LDTM
──LDTM──┬────────────────────────────┬──┬───────────┬────────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=ALL─┘
└────,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼─────┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬─────────────────────────────────────────────────────────┬─────
└─,OUTAGE=─┬─duration──────────────────────────────────┬──┘
├─(start date,start time,duration)──────────┤
└─(start date,start time,end date,end time)─┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘
└─system#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which information is to be selected.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs in the request queue.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates multiple jobs specified by a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Can be used in combination with the OUTAGE keyword. If the OUTAGE keyword
is specified and the LIST keyword is not specified, only requirements which match
the outage window are listed. If LIST=ALL is specified, all outstanding require-
ments with fixed satisfaction lead times are listed regardless of whether they match
the outage window.
Required: No
OUTAGE
Specifies the duration and/or time frame of the application or system outage which
has occurred. If an outage is specified, the outstanding requirements with fixed satis-
faction lead times are subjected to further analysis to determine if the requirement
might have been satisfied if the outage had not occurred. See 2.95.2, “Usage Notes”
on page 2-250.
Required: No
duration
Use this format to specify an outage duration without any date/time reference.
The duration can be expressed as a number of hours (1-3 digits), or as hours and
minutes (4 digits).
SYS
Specifies an application system name(s) to be matched by the system ID in the job
data in order for the job to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
system
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
system*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
The LDTM command attempts to analyze the processes which occurred when the job first
came into the queue and the determination was made whether to initially satisfy a
requirement, or leave it outstanding. When an outage duration or an outage window is
supplied, the process can screen out requirements which obviously do not match the
outage criteria. This leaves you with fewer requirements to be manually evaluated based
on the type of outage that occurred and your knowledge of the workload you are running.
The command selects outstanding requirements for jobs in the request queue based upon
the following criteria:
1. Outstanding job, data set, and input network requirements with a fixed satisfaction
lead time are selected.
2. The difference between the look back point and the last run point is compared with
the outage duration. If the difference is greater than the outage, then the requirement
is not marked as matching the outage. If the requirement is for a job, the last run
date/time used during initial requirement satisfaction process is carried in the require-
ment segment itself. For data sets and networks, this information is obtained from
the appropriate database record.
3. The following qualifications are made only if the outage is specified as an specific
date/time range (an outage window). If the outage was specified as a simple dura-
tion, further checks cannot be made since there is no specific outage date/time range
to reference.
4. If the deadline date and time is less than the beginning of the outage window, the
requirement is not marked as matching the outage. If the job entered the system
before the outage occurred, then it had no effect on the initial requirement satisfac-
tion calculations.
5. If the required element has no last run date/time the requirement is not marked as
matching the outage. This is because now there is no date/time reference to compare
with the outage window.
6. If the look back point minus the outage duration does not reach back to some part of
the outage window, the requirement is not marked as matching the outage.
2.95.3 Examples
LDTM
LDTM,OUTAGE=8
Evaluate all fixed LDTM requirements with a nonspecific eight hour outage.
LDTM,JOB=PAYM,OUTAGE=(311696,1233,311896,1433)
Evaluate fixed LDTM requirements for jobs beginning with PAY. Use an Outage
window from January 16, 1996 at noon to January 18, 1996 at 2:00 p.m. as a reference.
< LDTM,JOB=PM,OUTAGE=5
=
DATE=yy.383 PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME JOB# DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
A
P3 REQ 3792 323/1731 MNONEM 323/1731 ALL- 331 DEMD 333 LATE
G Outage Factor Indicator. If an outage is specified on the command and the require-
ment fits the parameters of that outage, the character string *OUTAGE* is dis-
played. Otherwise, it is blank.
Note: If an outage is specified on the command and LIST=ALL is NOT specified,
then ONLY requirements which match the outage criteria are listed.
H Data Set Number. If the requirement is for a data set, the CA-7 data set number is
displayed.
I Creation Job. If the requirement is for an internal data set, the name of the job
which updates or creates the data set is displayed.
2.96 LIST
Use the LIST command to list information on jobs in the request queue that are waiting
for a restart.
2.96.1 Syntax
LIST
──LIST──┬────────────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ │ ┌─NO──┐ │
└────,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼─────┘ └─,PROSE─┴─YES─┴──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the job(s) in the request queue, flagged for restart, for which the list is
desired.
Default: *
Required: Yes
*
Indicates all jobs that are flagged for restart.
jobname
Indicates a specific CA-7 job name in up to 8 characters.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
PROSE
Indicates whether restart documentation (#RESTART segment) is to be listed.
Default: NO
Required: No
2.96.2 Examples
LIST,JOB=M,PROSE=NO
COMMENTS
Specifies the reason for job failure and indicates if this job is restartable at job or
step level. Values which can appear in the COMMENTS column of LIST output
are:
#STEPCC Failed step-level condition code test(s) based on #SCC statements
included in the JCL.
COND-CD Failed job-level condition code test(s) based on DB.1 screen fields
COND-CODE and RO.
JCLERR Terminated due to JCL error.
REQUE Was manually requeued by the user.
RSTBL A CA-11 restart step is being inserted by CA-7.
2.97 LISTDIR
Use the LISTDIR command to list the member names of any PDS accessible by CA-7.
Date, time, and version of the creation or last update are shown for members which were
saved through the JCL function of DBM. This function is also offered on the UT Menu
screen as function 14.
2.97.1 Syntax
LISTDIR
──LISTDIR──,DSN=dsname──┬─────────────┬──┬─────────────┬────────
└─,VOL=volume─┘ └─,MEM=member─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the PDS data set for which directory information
is to be listed. If you are using online Base Calendar Maintenance, you can specify
DSN=*SCAL* to list calendar names residing on the CA-7 Calendar PDS.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates the volume on which the PDS data set resides. If omitted, the system
catalog is used to locate the PDS data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Default: System catalog
Required: No
MEM
Indicates the starting PDS member name at which listing is to begin. If omitted, the
entire directory is listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: Entire directory
Required: No
2.97.2 Examples
LISTDIR,DSN=CA7.JCLDS1
LISTDIR,DSN=SYS1.MACLIB,MEM=OPEN
LISTDIR,DSN=CA7.JCLDS12,VOL=DSK335
< LISTDIR,DSN=CAI.CA7.LOADLIB =
PAGE 3331
2.98 LJCK
Use the LJCK command to list JCL for a CA-7 job. JCL is fetched from the source
indicated on the DB.1 panel. If no member name is provided on the DB.1 panel, then the
member name is assumed to be the same as the job name. JCL is fetched from the
library indicated by the JCL ID (or its alternate) on the DB.1 panel unless the
USE-OVRD-LIB value is Y, in which case LJCK attempts to locate the JCL on the over-
ride library (JCLID=254). LJCK keyword values for DATE, TIME, and SCHID may
affect the display if scheduled overrides such as #JI and #JO are used. The RMS step is
inserted if required. If the CA-7 interface with CA-Driver is active, LJCK displays
CA-Driver JCL modifications. Calls to CA-Driver are made after scheduled overrides are
applied and the RMS step is inserted. Defaults for run-time specific CA-7 reserved-name
variables such as CA-7 job number are used when CA-Driver is invoked through LJCK.
See the CA-7 Interfaces Guide for additional information on the use of CA-Driver.
You can also use the LJCK command to validate JCL for a job that is not defined on the
CA-7 database. However, the JCL must reside on a CA-7 JCL library.
2.98.1 Syntax
LJCK
──LJCK──,JOB=jobname──┬─────────────┬────────────────────────────
└─,DATE=yyddd─┘
┌─MERGE──┐
──┬───────────────────────────────┬──,LIST=─┼─ERRORS─┼────────────
└─,JCLLIB=─┬─nnn─────────────┬──┘ └─ONLY───┘
└─&xxxxxxxxxxxxxx─┘
──┬───────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────┬────────
└─,MEM=xxxxxxxx─┘ │ ┌─331─┐ │ └─,TIME=hhmm─┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose JCL is to be listed.
Required: Yes
DATE
Specifies the Julian date to be used in evaluating scheduled overrides (for example,
#JI and #JO statements).
Default: Current system date
Required: No
JCLLIB
Overrides or specifies the library where the JCL resides. It may be used to override
the JCLID/JCLLIB value on the DB.1 screen for this display if the JOB keyword is
used. For example, if the JCLLIB for the library where the JCL for job X resides is
&A but test JCL to be evaluated for the job resides on the library defined as
JCLLIB=&ABC, then the following command may be used:
LJCK,JOB=X,JCLLIB=&ABC
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID to be used in evaluating scheduled overrides (for example,
#JI and #JO statements).
Default: 001
Required: No
TIME
Specifies the time-of-day to be used in evaluating scheduled overrides (for example,
#JI and #JO statements).
Default: Current system time
Required: No
Concealed Values: Depending on the security options selected for your installation,
the following values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
2.99 LJCL
Use the LJCL command to list the JCL for any CA-7 job when the job name is supplied.
It can access any PDS, CA-Panvalet, or CA-Librarian data sets defined to CA-7. This
command lists the data set name and the member name specified (or defaulted) on the
DB.1 screen for each job.
Note: Any undisplayable hexadecimal characters in the JCL are shown as periods (.) in
the output from the LJCL command.
2.99.1 Syntax
LJCL
──LJCL──,JOB=─┬─jobname──┬──────────────────────────────────────
├─jobname#─┤
└─M────────┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose JCL is to be listed.
Required: Yes
jobname
Identifies a job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Identifies a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
*
Indicates all jobs defined in the database. The output from this specification can
be quite lengthy and should be done using a batch terminal.
2.99.2 Examples
LJCL,JOB=CA7JOB4
LJCL,JOB=CA7M
List JCL for all jobs whose name begins with CA7.
LJCL,JOB=M
Concealed Values: Depending on the security options selected for your installation,
the following values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
LJCL Screen
< LJCL,JOB=ROSDAILY
=
DSN=CSDCA7.JCLLIB(ROSDAILY) PAGE 3331
JOB=ROSDAILY
2.100 LJES
Use the LJES command to display the JES job number for all CPU jobs submitted by
CA-7 which reside in the active or prior-run queues. The active queue contains informa-
tion about jobs which are currently executing, while the prior-run queue contains informa-
tion about the last successful completion of each job. For jobs which are executing, the
name of the most recently completed job step is provided. It also shows the CPU (local
or remote) on which execution occurred, start time, and other execution-related informa-
tion.
2.100.1 Syntax
LJES
──LJES──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬────────────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ │ ┌─ACT─┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname──┼──┘ └─,Q=─┼─PRN─┼──┘
├─jobname#─┤ └─M───┘
└─nnnn─────┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │
└─,CPUID=─┴─smfid─┴──┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
nnnn
Indicates a JES job number that is to be displayed (active queue only). Multiple
JES systems (nonshared spools) may create duplicate JES job numbers; however,
depending upon timing, duplicates may or may not occur in a single display.
Q
Specifies the queue(s) from which the job(s) should be listed.
Default: ACT
Required: No
ACT
Indicates only active queue job information.
PRN
Indicates only prior-run queue job information. Valid only when a specific job
name is supplied. Jobs in the prior-run queue show a condition code value
instead of the name of the last step executed.
*
Indicates to list both active and prior-run queue data for the job name specified.
This is valid only when a specific job name is supplied.
CPUID
Indicates the CPU ID(s) for which jobs are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all CPU IDs.
smfid
Indicates only this specific CPU ID. The value is the SMF system ID. CPUID,
as a search argument in the inquiry command, must match the SMF system iden-
tifier as defined to the OS system by the user and received by CA-7 in the SMF
records.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 alphanumeric characters
If CA-7 NCF is installed, another column, CPU LOCATION appears on the display. The
CPU LOCATION column indicates the location name in the node table for where the job
executes.
2.100.3 Examples
LJES
LJES,JOB=372
LJES,CPUID=8132
LJES,JOB=DUSAZZ31,Q=PRN
< LJES
=
JOB=M,Q=ACT,CPUID=M
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
U7BATCH1 3383 2193 331 ACT 319/1335 319/1353 U11STEP ALL IPO1
CPU RUN
The SMF identifier of the CPU that the job executed or is executing.
2.101 LJOB
Use the LJOB command to list job information from the CA-7 database. Optional
keywords and values are used to provide such job selection criteria as Julian date, time-
of-day, number of DD statements, and job name(s). Information displayed can include
job characteristics, scheduling parameters, interdependencies with other work, JCL, doc-
umentation, and so forth.
Use the LJOB command to list information on CPU jobs. If scheduling has been inten-
tionally suspended with a DEMAND,SET=SKP or NXTCYC command, the JOB INFOR-
MATION section of the list indicates NXTCYC=SKP or NXTCYC=OFF.
2.101.1 Syntax
LJOB
┌─,───────────────┐
!┬───────────────┬┴──┬────────────────────┬──────────
──LJOB──,───
└─keyword=value─┘ │ ┌─JOB────┐ │
└─,LIST=─┴─option─┴──┘
Optional keywords and values are used to provide job selection criteria. They may be
used in any combination to list the desired job(s). LIST specifies format of display.
Keywords and acceptable values are as follows. Unless specifically indicated, there are
no defaults for these keywords. If a keyword is not entered, jobs are listed regardless of
that keyword's corresponding value in the database. If no keywords are provided, all jobs
in the database are listed. See the DB.1 screen in the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide
for more information on most of the following keywords.
Note: Generic requests may cause too many pages of output for online terminals. If so,
the message CA-7.020 results. To correct this problem, indicate a specific
request. Alternatively, use the Batch Terminal Interface.
Where:
ADATE
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) Julian date range
in the date portion of DB.1 screen field DONT SCHEDULE AFTER (YYDDD
format).
Size/Type: 5 numeric characters from 00000 to 99999
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum Julian date range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum Julian date range.
ARFSET
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field ARFSET.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
*
Indicates all ARFSET name(s).
arfset
Indicates a specific ARFSET name.
arfset*
Indicates a generic ARFSET name.
ATIME
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) time-of-day range
in the time portion of DB.1 screen field DONT SCHEDULE AFTER (hhmm format).
Size/Type: 4 numeric characters from 0000 to 2400
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum time-of-day range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum time-of-day range.
BDATE
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) Julian date range
in the date portion of DB.1 screen field DONT SCHEDULE BEFORE (YYDDD
format).
Size/Type: 5 numeric characters from 00000 to 99999
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum Julian date range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum Julian date range.
BTIME
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) time-of-day range
in the time portion of DB.1 screen field DONT SCHEDULE BEFORE (hhmm
format).
Size/Type: 4 numeric characters from 0000 to 2400
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum time-of-day range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum time-of-day range.
CLS
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field CLASS.
Size/Type: 1 alphanumeric character from A to Z or 0 to 9
x
Specifies the class value of the job to select.
COND
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field COND-CODE (nnnn format).
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters from 0 to 4096
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
CPU
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric per-
centage value range for CPU time as a percentage of elapsed time (nn format).
Size/Type: 1 to 2 numeric characters from 0 to 99
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric percentage value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric percentage value
range.
CPUTIME
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field CPU-TIME.
Size/Type: 5 numeric characters specified as mmmss, where mmm is minutes
and ss is seconds
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
DDS
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range for number of DD statements in its JCL (nnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
DSNLEAD
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field LEAD-TIME DSN (nn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
DSNMSG
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field DSN NOT FOUND. The
value must be N or Y.
ELT
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field CLOCK-TIME (hhmm format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
EXEC
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field EXEC. The value must
be N or Y.
HOLD
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field HOLD. The value must
be N or Y.
JCLID
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field JCL ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters. The valid range is 0 to 254
JCLLIB
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field JCLLIB.
Size/Type: 2 to 16 alphanumeric characters beginning with an ampersand (&)
JCLOVRD
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field JCL-OVRD. The value
must be N or Y.
JOB
Indicates job name(s) to be selected. See the DB.1 screen field JOB.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
*
Indicates all job name(s).
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
JOBLEAD
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field LEAD-TIME JOB (nn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
JOBNET
Indicates JOBNET name(s) to be selected. See DB.1 screen field JOBNET.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
*
Indicates all JOBNET name(s).
jobnet
Indicates a specific JOBNET name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnet*
Indicates a generic JOBNET name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
LATES
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range of the number of times the job completed later than scheduled due-out time
(nnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
LIST
Specifies the information to be listed for each job selected by the other keywords. If
LIST is not specified on a generic request, a single line describing each job is output.
Default: JOB
JOB
Job data only.
ALL
All data related to the job (for example, schedules, documentation, steps, DDs,
requirements, networks).
DEPJ
Jobs which are dependent on the job.
NODD
Like ALL but exclude STEPDD information.
PROS
Documentation information only.
RPTID
Report IDs associated with the job.
RQDSN
Data set requirement information only.
RQEXCP
Exception requirements only (NEXT-RUN=SKIP or ONLY).
RQJOB
Job requirement information only.
RQMT
Input requirements and output network information only.
RQNWK
Input network requirements only.
RQUSR
User requirements only.
RQVRM
Virtual resource requirements only.
SCHD
Schedule information only.
STEPDD
Job, step, and DD statement information.
TRIG
All jobs, data sets, and networks that trigger the job, as well as all jobs that are
triggered by the job.
LMNTDATE
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) Julian date range
for date of last maintenance update to the database (YYDDD format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum Julian date range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum Julian date range.
LMNTTIME
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) time-of-day range
for time-of-day of last maintenance update to the database (hhmm format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum time-of-day range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum time-of-day range.
LMNTTYPE
Indicates to select job(s) depending on type of last database maintenance performed
on them. Acceptable values are:
ANLZ
Last maintenance by CA-7 analyze commands.
DBM
Last maintenance by CA-7 database maintenance facilities.
LOAD
Last maintenance by CA-7 LOAD process.
SMF
Last maintenance by System Management Facility feedback.
LRUNDATE
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) Julian date range
for date of the last run of the job (YYDDD format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum Julian date range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum Julian date range.
LRUNTIME
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) time-of-day range
for time-of-day of the last run of the job (hhmm format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum time-of-day range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum time-of-day range.
LTERM
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field LTERM. The value is a
logical terminal name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
MAINID
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field MAINID.
ALL
Indicates all main IDs.
SYn
Indicates main ID n.
/SYn
Indicates not main ID n.
MAINT
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field MAINT. The value must
be N or Y.
MEMBER
Indicates JCL member name(s) to be selected.
Default: *
*
Indicates all JCL member name(s).
member
Indicates a specific JCL member name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
member*
Indicates a generic JCL member name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
MSGCLASS
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field MSGCLASS. The value
must be a 1 alphanumeric character message class.
NXTCYC
Indicates to select jobs with DEMAND,SET=SKP or NXTCYC command functions
active.
OFF
Indicates scheduling has been discontinued.
SKP
Indicates skip only the next scheduled run.
OVRDLIB
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field USE-OVRD-LIB. The
value must be N or Y.
OWNER
Indicates owner value to be selected. See the DB.1 screen field OWNER.
Default: *
*
Indicates all owner values.
owner
Indicates a specific owner value.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
owner*
Indicates a generic owner value.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
PROMPTS
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field PROMPTS. The value
must be N or Y.
PROSE
Indicates to select jobs which have documentation defined through DB.4.1 screen.
The value must be N or Y.
PRTY
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field PRTY (nnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
REGION
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field REGION (nnnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
RELOAD
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field RELOAD. The value
must be N, Y, or X.
RESTARTS
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range of the number of times the job has been restarted (nnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
RETAIN
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field RETAIN-JCL. The value
must be N or Y.
RMS
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field INSERT-RMS. The
value must be N or Y.
RO
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field RO. The value must be
1 to 2 alphanumeric characters.
RQLIST
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field REQUIREMENT-LIST.
The value must be N or Y.
RQMTMSG
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field RQMTS NOT USED.
The value must be N or Y.
RUNS
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range of the number of times the job has been executed (nnnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
SCHEDULE
Indicates to select jobs which have a calendar schedule defined. The value must be
N or Y.
STEPREST
Indicates to select jobs that can be restarted at step level. The value must be N or Y.
STEPS
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range of the number of job steps in its JCL (nnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
SYS
Indicates system name(s) to be selected. See the DB.1 screen field SYSTEM.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
*
Indicates all system name(s).
system
Indicates a specific system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
system*
Indicates a generic system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
TP1
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range for the number of TYPE1 tape drives (nnn format). See the DB.1 screen field
TAPE DRIVES. Selection is based on TYPE1 M value unless TYPE1 M is zero or
less than for the specified TP1 minimum value; selection is then based on TYPE1 C
value.
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
TP1C
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum or (minimum,maximum) numeric value
range in DB.1 screen field TYPE1 C (nnn format).
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
TP1M
Same as TP1C keyword except values are for field TYPE1 M.
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
TP2
Same as TP1 keyword except values are for TYPE2 tape drives.
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
TP2C
Same as TP1C keyword except values are for field TYPE2 C.
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
TP2M
Same as TP1M keyword except values are for field TYPE2 M.
minimum
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum numeric value range.
(minimum,maximum)
Indicates to select jobs meeting minimum,maximum numeric value range.
USERID
Indicates to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field UID.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters
VERIFY
Used to select jobs with this value in DB.1 screen field VERIFY. The value must be
N or Y.
2.101.2 Examples
LJOB,JOB=CA7JOB1,LIST=ALL
LJOB,JOBNET=WEEKLYS,SYS=PAYROLL
LJOB,JOB=CA7M
List all jobs with names beginning with CA7. Even though only one line per job is listed
for any generic job name request, the output from this type of request could be quite
lengthy and should be done using a batch terminal.
LJOB,JOB=M,LIST=RQMT
List all jobs with output network information and input requirements. Even though only
one line per job is listed for any generic job name request, the output from this type of
request could be quite lengthy and should be done using a batch terminal.
< LJOB,JOB=M
=
JOB=M DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
DUSAXX31 333 DUSAXX31 PAYROLL 333 ALL 333326 333314 334 312 3331 YYDDD/1433
PERAA31A 333 PERAA31A PERSONEL 333 ALL MNONEM MNONEM 333 313 3333 33333/3333
PERAB31A 333 PERAB31A PERSONEL 333 ALL MNONEM MNONEM 331 334 3333 33333/3333
PERAC31A 333 PERAC31A PERSONEL 333 ALL MNONEM 333327 335 317 3331 YYDDD/1413
ACPBA31W 331 ACPBA31W PAYABLES 333 ALL MNONEM MNONEM 334 312 3331 YYDDD/1411
ACPCA31W 331 ACPCA31W PAYABLES 333 ALL MNONEM MNONEM 333 339 3331 YYDDD/1411
K L
LJOB,LIST=JOB Screen
< LJOB,JOB=DUSAXX31,LIST=JOB
=
JOB=DUSAXX31 LIST=JOB DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
DUSAXX31 333 DUSAXX31 PAYROLL 133 /SY3 333339 333333 333 312 3373 YYDDD/1333
MAIN ID
The value from the MAINID field on the DB.1 screen.
PROSE DSNBR
The CA-7 generated DSNBR for the job documentation defined for this job.
SCHD DSNBR
The CA-7 generated DSNBR for the schedule member defined for this job.
NUMBER OF STP
The number of steps executed within this job.
NUMBER OF DDS
The number of DDs referenced by this job.
NUMBER OF RUNS
The number of times this job has successfully executed under CA-7.
LAST RUN DATE/TIME
The last time (start time) that the job ran successfully under CA-7.
JOB INFORMATION
All job information values are either Y or N.
SCHD RESOLUTION REQUIRED
The indication as to whether this job's schedule information entered
through the DB.2.1 screen needs to be RESOLVed.
OVERRIDE OF JCL REQUIRED
The indication of whether the QJCL requires modifying before job sub-
mission (see JCL-OVRD field on the DB.1 screen).
MANUAL VERIFICATION REQUIRED
The indication of whether this job has an initial requirement in the
request queue for verification (see VERIFY field on the DB.1 screen).
REQUIREMENTS TO BE LISTED
The indication of whether this job's requirements should be written to
the LTERM indicated on the DB.1 screen upon initial queue entry.
AUTO-GENERATION OF 7 RMS
The indication of whether CA-7 is to insert the RMS step (see
INSERT-RMS field on the DB.1 screen).
ERRORS FOR RQMT NOT USED
The indication of whether an error message should be produced and
sent to the LTERM specified on the DB.1 screen if this job shows to
use a data set, but while the job was executing, CA-7 did not receive
SMF data indicating its use (see RQMTS NOT USED field on the
DB.1 screen).
C CLASS. Workload balancing class to be used for job submission (see CLASS field
on the DB.1 screen).
MSGCLASS. JES class that is used by this job (information only).
REGION. Region used by this job (information only).
PRTY. Initial workload balancing priority that is assigned to this job upon initial
queue entry.
CPUTM. CPU time (weighted average) for this job.
ELAPTM. Time (weighted average) between job submission and job termination.
D TAPE1. CALC. High-water mark number of TYPE1 tape drive(s) used by any step
within this job as calculated by CA-7.
TAPE1. MANL. Override of the CA-7 calculated number of TYPE1 tape drives
used by this job (see TAPE DRIVES TYPE1 M field on DB.1 screen).
TAPE2. CALC. High-water mark number of TYPE2 tape drive(s) used by any step
within this job as calculated by CA-7.
TAPE2. MANL. Override of the CA-7 calculated number of TYPE2 tape drives
used by this job (see TAPE DRIVES TYPE2 M field on DB.1 screen).
E LTERM. The logical terminal (STATION) that is to receive various messages
regarding this job.
JOBNET. Value entered in the JOBNET field on the DB.1 screen.
NXTCYC. If the normally scheduled processing cycles of the job have been sus-
pended by the NXTCYC command, this value is SKP (for single cycle) or OFF (for
all cycles until reset by the NXTCYC command).
F Dates and times to be resolved at the time a job record is to be brought into the
request queue by schedule scan or a trigger (see the DONT SCHEDULE --
BEFORE and AFTER fields on the DB.1 screen). A job is not brought in automat-
ically if it is a true condition.
G Number of times the job has been considered late, and the number of times the job
has been restarted.
H Requirement initial satisfaction lead time values for job and data set requirements.
(See SATISFACTION LEAD TIME field on the DB.1 screen.)
LJOB,LIST=SCHD Screen
< LJOB,JOB=DUSAXX31,LIST=SCHD
=
JOB=DUSAXX31 LIST=SCHD DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
DUSAXX31 333 DUSAXX31 PAYROLL 133 /SY3 333339 333333 333 312 3373 YYDDD/1333
-------------------------------- SCHEDULES -----------------------------------
CALENDAR SCALyy33
ID=331 ROLL=D INDEX=+333
SCAL= DOTM=3833 LEADTM=3133 STARTM=3633
WEEKLY DAY=MON,FRI
ID=332 ROLL=D INDEX=+333
SCAL=7D DOTM=1233 LEADTM=3133 STARTM=1133
DAILY
< LJOB,JOB=DUSAXX31,LIST=PROS
=
JOB=DUSAXX31 LIST=PROS DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
DUSAXX31 333 DUSAXX31 PAYROLL 133 /SY3 333339 333333 333 312 3373 YYDDD/1333
---------------------------------- PROSE -------------------------------
THIS IS THE FIRST JOB IN THE TESTNTWK TO BE EXECUTED AND IS A
SCHEDULED JOB. IT CONSISTS OF TWO STEPS. THE FIRST STEP RECEIVES
A SET OF CONTROL CARDS AS INPUT, CREATES A DATASET CA7.TEST1 AS
OUTPUT AND DEMANDS THE NEXT JOB DUSAXX32 TO BE STARTED.
K L
LJOB,LIST=TRIG Screen
< LJOB,JOB=DUSATAPE,LIST=TRIG
=
JOB=DUSATAPE LIST=TRIG DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
DUSATAPE 333 DUSATEST PAYROLL 133 /SY3 333339 333333 333 312 3373 YYDDD/1333
< LJOB,JOB=DUSAXX31,LIST=STEPDD
=
JOB=DUSAXX31 LIST=STEPDD DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
DUSAXX31 333 DUSAXX31 PAYROLL 133 /SY3 333339 333333 333 312 3373 YYDDD/1333
LJOB,LIST=RQMT Screen
< LJOB,JOB=DUSAXX31,LIST=RQMT
=
JOB=DUSAXX31 LIST=RQMT DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
DUSAXX31 333 DUSAXX31 PAYROLL 133 /SY3 333339 333333 333 312 3373 YYDDD/1333
< LJOB,SYS=A/P,LIST=DEPJ
=
JOB=M LIST=DEPJ DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3332
JOB ----JCL--- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
JOB31 333 JOB31 A/P 333 ALL 333333 nnnnnn 333 333 333 33333/3333
JOB32 333 JOB32 A/P 333 ALL 333333 333333 333 333 333 33333/3333
JOB33 333 JOB33 A/P 333 ALL 333333 333333 333 333 333 33333/3333
JOB35 333 JOB35 A/P 333 ALL 333333 333333 333 333 333 33333/3333
JOB36 333 JOB36 A/P 333 ALL 333333 333333 333 333 333 33333/3333
2.102 LJOBR
Use the LJOBR command to list computer resource requirement information on jobs.
This command is similar to the LQR command, except that it lists resource information
on any job in the database.
2.102.1 Syntax
LJOBR
┌─,───────────────┐
!┬───────────────┬┴─────────────────────────────────
──LJOBR──,───
└─keyword=value─┘
Optional keywords and values are used to specify the job(s) to be displayed. Only the
job(s) meeting all selection criteria specified are displayed. See 2.101.1, “Syntax” on
page 2-268 for selection keywords and values available to both the LJOB and LJOBR
commands.
2.102.3 Examples
LJOBR,TP1=(35,13),SYS=BLM
LJOBR,TP1=(35,13),TP2=3,CPU=53
LJOBR,CLS=A,ELT=(3353,3131)
LJOBR,JOBNET=WEEKLYS,SYS=PAYROLL,TP1=(32,35)
< LJOBR,JOB=D463XX31
=
JOB=D463XX31 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB SYSTEM MAIN JOB CPU/ELAPS TAPE1 TAPE2 NBR REGN CPU% LAST-RUN
NAME -NAME- -ID- C/PRT --TIME--- M/CAL M/CAL RUNS SIZE UTIL DATE/TIME
D463XX31 TESTNTWK ALL A/332 33331/3331 33/33 33/33 3332 3343K 31.67 33234/1416
2.103 LLIB
Use the LLIB command to list a member of a CA-Panvalet or CA-Librarian data set.
Although intended to be used for reviewing JCL, any card-image data can be displayed
from either of the two types of data sets.
Note: Any undisplayable hexadecimal characters in the member are shown as periods (.)
in the output from the LLIB command.
2.103.1 Syntax
LLIB
──LLIB──,DSN=dsname──,MEM=member──┬─────────┬───────────────────
└─,LIST=N─┘
Where:
DSN
Used to specify the fully qualified data set name of the CA-Panvalet or CA-Librarian
library which contains the member (MEM) to be listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
MEM
Used to identify which member of the named library (DSN) is to be listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
LIST
Used to indicate that "includes" are not to be expanded. This is an optional keyword
and the only value allowed is N for no expansion.
2.103.2 Examples
LLIB,DSN=PROD1.JCL,MEM=XXXXXXXX
"includes" expanded.
LLIB,DSN=PROD1.JCL,MEM=XXXXXXXX,LIST=N
Concealed Values: Depending on the security options selected for your installation,
the following values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
LLIB Screen
< LLIB,DSN=PROD1.JCL,MEM=ROSDAILY
=
DSN=PROD1.JCL PAGE 3331
2.104 LLOCK
Use the LLOCK command to list the database elements which are locked. Locked means
CA-7 has detected some element which is in error or which has not been defined to the
CA-7 database, and therefore is preventing the processing of a job, network, or data set.
In addition to lock conditions, the list also indicates if scheduling of a CPU job has been
intentionally suspended with a DEMAND,SET=SKP or NXTCYC command.
2.104.1 Syntax
LLOCK
──LLOCK──,──┬────────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬─────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ └─,LIST=NXTCYC─┘
(1)
├─JOB── =─┼─jobname──┼────┤
│ └─jobname#─┘ │
├─DSN=NW.networkname─────┤
└─DSNBR=─┬─xxnnnnnn───┬──┘
└─xx%%nnnnn#─┘
──┬─────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,SYS=systemname─┘
Note:
1 JOB, DSN, or DSNBR is required if SYS is omitted.
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job(s) which are to be listed. If SYS is used, JOB is optional and if
omitted, JOB=* is assumed.
Default: *
Required: Yes (unless DSN OR DSNBR is specified)
jobname
Is a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Is a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
*
All jobs are to be considered based on the SYS parameter. This is the default
only if SYS= is provided. systemname must be a specific application name; it
cannot be generic.
DSN
Specifies a database index entry for network(s) to be listed. Enter either a specific
network or just the 3 characters NW. to list all networks. DSN is required unless
DSNBR, JOB, or SYS is used, in which case it must be omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters following NW. prefix
Required: Yes (unless JOB, SYS, or DSNBR is specified)
DSNBR
Specifies a specific or generic CA-7 assigned network or schedule number identifying
the element(s) to be listed.
Required: Yes (unless JOB, SYS, or DSB is specified)
xxnnnnnn
Specifies a specific network or schedule number where xx is the prefix denoting
the type of entry desired, and nnnnnn is the CA-7 assigned number (leading
zeros may be omitted). Valid prefix values are NW, SI, SJ, or SO.
xx00nnnnn*
Specifies a generic network or schedule number where xx is the prefix denoting
the type of entry desired and nn...* is the generic CA-7 assigned number
(maximum of 7 digits). An asterisk appears after the last significant digit. Do
not omit leading zeros from the number value specified. Valid prefix values are
NW, SI, SJ, or SO. Use a value of S* to list all SI, SJ, and SO schedules.
LIST
Specifies that only those schedules modified with a NXTCYC or
DEMAND,SET=SKP command are to be listed. NXTCYC is the only valid entry.
Required: No
SYS
Specifies an application system name whose locked jobs are to be listed. The value
must be the specific application system name as defined for each job on the DB.1
screen. If SYS is used with JOB, the job(s) specified must have a system name
matching the SYS value to be listed. If SYS is used, DSN and DSNBR must be
omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
If this job is currently loading, wait for the load to complete then reissue the LLOCK
command.
If the display shows SCHEDULE INFORMATION IS LOCKED, this indicates that the
job or network schedule needs resolution. Issue the RESOLV command for the job or
network to correct the problem.
If the display shows TO BE SKIPPED on NEXT SCHEDULED CYCLE, the job is not
locked. However, scheduling of the job has been suspended with a DEMAND,SET=SKP
or NXTCYC,SET=SKP command.
2.104.4 Examples
LLOCK,DSN=NW.
LLOCK,JOB=CA7JOB1
LLOCK,JOB=CA7M,SYS=CA7
LLOCK,DSNBR=SJM
LLOCK,DSNBR=SJ3333332M
LLOCK,DSNBR=SJ333332M
< LLOCK,JOB=DUSAXX31
=
JOB=DUSAXX31 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB=DUSAXX31 SYSTEM=PAYROLL
.IS LOCKED FOR THE FOLLOWING REASON(S):
THE JOB SCHEDULE INFORMATION IS LOCKED
2.105 LNTWK
Use the LNTWK command to list workstation network information from the CA-7 data-
base. Optional keywords and values control the amount of data presented and the format
of the data.
2.105.1 Syntax
LNTWK
──LNTWK──,──┬─NW=network───────────────┬─────────────────────────
├─DSN=─┬─NW.────────────┬──┤
│ └─NW.networkname─┘ │
└─DSNBR=─┬─NWnnnnnn───┬────┘
├─NW33nnnnn#─┤
└─NWM────────┘
──┬───────────────────┬──────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─DSN───┐ │
└─,LIST=─┼─ALL───┼──┘
├─PROS──┤
├─SCHD──┤
├─STN───┤
└─USERS─┘
Where:
NW
Specifies the network name. Use NW. for generic network requests.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes (unless DSN or DSNBR is specified)
DSN
Specifies the CA-7 index data set entry name for the network information to be
listed.
Required: Yes (unless NW or DSNBR is specified)
NW.
When coded by itself, causes all networks to be listed in network name
sequence.
NW.network
Specifies a specific network name, in up to 8 characters (following the NW.
prefix), to be listed.
DSNBR
Specifies the CA-7 assigned database network number for the network whose infor-
mation is to be listed.
Required: Yes (unless NW or DSN is specified)
NWnnnnnn
Is the CA-7 assigned network number in up to 6 characters with a prefix of NW.
Leading zeros may be omitted.
NW00nnnnn*
Is a CA-7 generic network number in up to 7 digits preceded with NW and
terminated with an asterisk. Leading zeros MUST NOT be omitted.
NW*
Causes all networks to be listed in network number sequence.
LIST
Specifies the options for the amount of database information to be listed.
Default: DSN
Required: No
DSN
Network data.
ALL
All network data, including documentation and schedules. This option is not
valid for a generic request.
PROS
All documentation and network data. This option is not valid for a generic
request.
SCHD
All schedules and network data. This option is not valid for a generic request.
STN
All station names and network data.
USERS
All jobs connected to the network and network data.
2.105.2 Examples
LNTWK,NW=DATASET1
LNTWK,NW=NW.DATASET1,LIST=USERS
LNTWK,NW=NW.DATASET1,LIST=ALL
LNTWK,DSNBR=NW6
LNTWK,DSNBR=NW6,LIST=USERS
LNTWK,DSNBR=NWM
LNTWK,DSN=NW.,LIST=USERS
LNTWK,LIST=ALL Screen
< LNTWK,DSNBR=NW2,LIST=ALL
=
LIST=ALL DSNBR=NW2 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
K L
< LNTWK,DSNBR=NWM
=
LIST=DSN DSNBR=NWM DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
NUMBER ST
The number of workstation entries within this network.
NUMBER JOB
The number of jobs connected to this network.
LAST MAINTENANCE DATE TIME
The last date and time an update was made to the network definition.
LAST MAINTENANCE TYPE
Means of the update:
ANLZ XREF analyze command
DBM Database maintenance
NETWORK SUBID
Sub-ID of the network.
Use the LOAD/LOADH command to create or re-create job profile data in the database.
Job profiles should agree with the current JCL. Therefore, any changes to the JCL must
be resynchronized with the database by LOADing the job. See the RELOAD field in the
DB.1 screen as an alternative to this command.
Use the LOADH command to indicate that the job is to be entered into the queue in
CA-7 hold status to allow for manual release at a future time.
Use of this command causes the rest of the job's JCL to be flushed. The job returns to
the request queue with a JCL error.
2.106.1 Syntax
LOAD LOADH
──┬─LOAD──┬──,JOB=jobname──┬──────────┬──┬────────────┬──────────
└─LOADH─┘ └─,CLASS=x─┘ └─,DOTM=hhmm─┘
──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──────────────────────
└─,─┬─JCLID=nnn─────┬──┘ └─,LEADTM=hhmm─┘
└─JCLLIB=&x...x─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────┬───────────────────────────
│ ┌─1───┐ │ └─,TIME=hhmm─┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name of the job to be loaded. Value is the job name defined in the
database or the member name in a JCL library where the JCL for the job resides.
See JCLID below.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
CLASS
Specifies the workload balancing class for resource checking.
Size/Type: 1 alphanumeric character
Required: No
DOTM
Specifies a due-out time-of-day for load processing.
Size/Type: 2 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhmm where hh can be hours
0 through 24 and mm can be minutes 0 through 59
Default: Assumes current time plus lead time
Required: No
JCLID
Identifies the JCL data set which contains the execution JCL to be submitted. If
used, the value must be a numeric INDEX associated with the desired JCL data set
(on the JCL statement in the initialization file). See the CA-7 Systems Programmer
Guide for further information on the initialization file. This field or the JCLLIB field
is required if the job is not defined in the database. JCLID and JCLLIB are mutually
exclusive.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 254
Required: No, unless job is not defined in database
JCLLIB
Identifies the JCL data set which contains the execution JCL to be submitted. If
used, the value must be a symbolic INDEX associated with the desired JCL data set
(on the JCL statement in the initialization file). See the CA-7 Systems Programmer
Guide for further information on the initialization file). This field or the JCLID field
is required if the job is not defined in the database. JCLID and JCLLIB are mutually
exclusive.
Size/Type: 2 to 16 alphanumeric characters beginning with ampersand (&)
Required: No, unless job is not defined in database
Note: A dynamic allocation failure on a JCL data set specified by JCLLIB causes
the job to enter the request queue in SKELETON status.
LEADTM
Specifies an elapsed lead time for load processing.
Size/Type: 2 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhmm where hh can be hours
0 through 24 and mm can be minutes 0 through 59
Default: 1 hour (if omitted)
Required: No
SCHID
Identifies the job schedule ID to be used for this job.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters 1 through 255
Default: 1
Required: No (See Note)
Note: If the SCHEDULE statement in the initialization file specifies
SCHID=YES, then this parameter is required.
TIME
Establishes a submit time requirement for the job.
Size/Type: 2 to 4 numeric characters specified as hhmm where hh can be hours
0 through 23 and mm can be minutes 0 through 59
Required: No
2.106.2 Examples
LOAD,JOB=USERJOB1,SCHID=14
LOADH,JOB=USERJOB2,JCLID=3
LOADH,JOB=USERJOB9,DOTM=1433,LEADTM=23
If workload balancing is being used, the job being loaded is scheduled using the
default WLB job class for LOAD if the CLASS= keyword is not specified. (See the
description of the LOADCLASS parameter on the OPTIONS statement in the initial-
ization file in the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide.)
The LOAD command cannot be used for a job that has been marked as nonexecut-
able (for example, EXEC=N) on the DB.1 screen.
If the LOADDSNS keyword is used on the DBASE statement in the initialization
file, then the LOAD process does not build any DD or data set information for jobs
that are marked MAINT=Y on the DB.1 (JOB) screen.
If the job statement of a job being loaded has the RESTART keyword specifying a
step for the job to begin execution, the LOAD step does not execute. To LOAD this
job, the RESTART keyword should be omitted.
If VRMDD=DEF or VRMDD=YES is coded on the OPTIONS statement in the
CA-7 initialization file, then VRM resource definitions for this job are dynamically
modified when the job is LOADed. See the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide for
more information on VRM Device Control.
2.107 LOC
Use the LOC command to list catalog contents for one or more data sets. This function
is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 19 or on any other menu or
formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.19.
2.107.1 Syntax
LOC
──LOC──,DSN=dsname──┬────────────────┬──────────────────────────
└─,VOLSER=volser─┘
DSN
Identifies the data set whose catalog contents are to be listed. The name may be a
fully qualified name, a generic request, or a relative request for a generation data set.
A generic request is specified by the desired index levels followed by a period.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOLSER
Identifies the volume serial number which contains the CVOL catalog to be listed. If
the high-level node is defined in the master catalog, this parameter is not needed.
Otherwise, it should be coded.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.107.3 Examples
LOC,DSN=USER.
LOC,DSN=USER.FILE1,VOLSER=12B345
LOC,DSN=USER.GDG.FILE(-1)
2.108 LOGIN/LOGOUT
Use the LOGIN command to log the start of workstation tasks for both networks.
Use the LOGOUT command to log the completion of workstation tasks for both net-
works.
2.108.1.1 Syntax
LOGIN LOGOUT
──┬─LOGIN──┬──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬───,STATION=station─────────────
└─LOGOUT─┘ └─jobnumber─┘
──┬─────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,INITS=xxxxxxxx─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the unique CA-7 job name or the job number that was assigned when the
network was placed in the preprocess queue. The job name may be used to log the
first station only and the job number must be used thereafter.
Required: Yes
jobname
Specifies the job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Specifies the job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
STATION
Specifies the name of the workstation that is to be logged in or out.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes (unless first station in the network)
INITS
Specifies any user information to be posted to the workstation record.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
Note: This could be used to allow the user to enter his or her name or initials with
the command. This information is placed in the log and appears on inquiries.
2.108.1.2 Examples
LOGIN,JOB=17,STATION=KEYPUNCH
Log in workstation KEYPUNCH which is part of the network referenced by CA-7 job
number 17. No user information to be posted.
LOGOUT,JOB=17,STATION=KEYPUNCH,INITS=CLERK1
Log out workstation KEYPUNCH which is part of the network referenced by CA-7 job
number 17. CLERK1 is the user information to be posted to the workstation and logged.
2.108.2.1 Syntax
LOGIN LOGOUT
──┬─LOGIN──┬──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬───,NW=network──────────────────
└─LOGOUT─┘ └─jobnumber─┘
──,STATION=station──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬───────────
└─,FORCE=YES─┘ └─,INITS=xxxxxxxx─┘
──┬──────────────┬───────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,SUBID=subid─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the unique CA-7 job name or the job number assigned to the job and its
output workstation networks. Job name may be used only for the first station in a
network and the job number must be used thereafter.
Required: Yes
jobname
Specifies the job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Specifies the job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
NW
Specifies the name of the network to which the station belongs. The value must be
the network name defined in the database.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes (for first station unless SUBID is used)
STATION
Specifies the station to be logged in or out. Value must be the station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes (unless first station in the network)
FORCE
Allows the logging in of an output workstation network prior to completion of the
CPU job to which it is associated. If used the value must be entered as shown.
Required: No
INITS
Specifies any user information to be posted to the workstation record.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
Note: This could be used to allow the user to enter his or her name or initials with
the command. This information is placed in the log and appears on inquiries.
SUBID
Supplies additional information to identify the station and network to be logged in or
out. If used, the value is as defined in the database (or specified when the network
was demanded). SUBID may be used instead of NW for the first station in a
network. When substituting for NW, SUBID is required.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: Spaces
Required: No
2.108.2.2 Examples
LOGIN,JOB=163,NW=REPTS,STATION=STAT1,INITS=ABC
LOGIN,JOB=294,NW=REPTS,STATION=STAT1,SUBID=PAYR1234
LOGOUT,JOB=163,NW=REPTS,STATION=STAT1
LOGOUT,JOB=WORKNET,SUBID=RPTN31,INITS=DIST
2.109 LPDS
Use the LPDS command to list a card-image member of a partitioned data set (PDS) or a
sequential data set. This command enables the user to review data in any PDS or sequen-
tial data set. See JCL Inquiries on page 1-14 for other commands which can be used to
review JCL.
Note: Any undisplayable hexadecimal characters in the member are shown as periods (.)
in the output from the LPDS command.
2.109.1 Syntax
LPDS
──LPDS──,DSN=dsname──┬─────────────┬──┬────────────────┬────────
└─,MEM=member─┘ └─,VOLSER=volume─┘
Where:
DSN
Specifies the fully qualified data set name of either a sequential data set or the name
of a PDS containing a member (MEM) to be listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
MEM
Identifies which member of a named PDS (DSN) is to be listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, if listing from a PDS
VOLSER
Specifies the DASD volume on which the data set (DSN) resides. If VOLSER is
omitted, the data set must be a cataloged data set.
Required: No
2.109.2 Examples
LPDS,DSN=CA7.DSN1,MEM=M123,VOLSER=DBS131
LPDS,DSN=CA7.DSN2,MEM=M456
LPDS,DSN=CA7.SEQ.DATASET
Concealed Values: Depending on the security options selected for your installation,
the following values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
LPDS Screen
< LPDS,DSN=CA7.MACLIB,MEM=SASSSWKD
=
DSN=CA7.MACLIB(SASSSWKD) PAGE 3331
MACRO 33333133
SASSSWKD 33333233
SPACE 5 33333333
M--------------------------------------------------------------------M 33333433
M DSECT FOR THE SCHEDULE ELEMENT TO PRINT ROUTINE 'SASSCISE' 33333533
M--------------------------------------------------------------------M 33333633
SPACE 2 33333733
SWKDSECT DSECT 33333833
SWKLEN DS H - LENGTH OF THIS WORK AREA 33333933
SWKISE# DS H - NUMBER OF ISE'S LEFT TO PRINT 33331333
SPACE 33331133
SWKSRADR DS F - ADDRESS OF SCHEDULE RECORD 33331233
SPACE 33331333
SWKDBL DS D - DOUBLE WORD WORK AREA 33331433
SPACE 33331533
SWKISEAD DS F - ADDR OF CURRENT ISE ENTRY 33331633
SPACE 33331733
SWKSAVE DS 16F - SAVE AREA FOR CALLER'S REG'S 33331833
K L
2.110 LPOST
Use the LPOST command to list output network information from the postprocess queue.
This includes the status of all networks and whether they are late. Information, including
documentation, may be listed in a variety of sequences.
2.110.1 Syntax
LPOST
──LPOST──┬───────────────────────────┬──┬─────────┬──────────────
└────,JOB=─┬─M────────┬─────┘ └─,LIST=Q─┘
├─jobname──┤
└─jobname#─┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬────────────────────────────────
└────,NW=─┬─M────────────┬─────┘
├─networkname──┤
└─networkname#─┘
──┬────────────────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬─────
└─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘ │ ┌─NATV─────┐ │
└─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘ └─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬───────────────────────────────┬───────────
│ ┌─M────┐ │ └────,STN=─┬─M────────────┬─────┘
└─,ST=─┼─LATE─┼──┘ ├─stationname──┤
└─HELD─┘ └─stationname#─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────
└─,SUBID=─┬─M──────┬──┘
├─subid──┤
└─subid#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which information is to be selected.
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates multiple jobs specified by a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
LIST
Specifies the amount of queue information requested. When specified, the value
must be Q to list station data only. When LIST is not specified, the display consists
of a single description line for each queue record.
Required: No
NW
Specifies the network name(s) for which information is to be selected.
Required: No
*
Indicates all networks.
networkname
Indicates a specific network name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
networkname*
Indicates multiple networks represented by a generic network name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation to be listed. If a subsegment,
use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy).
Required: No
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of a segment.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
The names of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy) enclosed in
parentheses and separated by a comma.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters each
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 assigned job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
NW
Network name sequence.
STA
Station name sequence.
SUBID
Sub-ID name sequence.
ST
Limits the display to postprocess queue tasks with a particular status.
Default: *
Required: No
*
All tasks.
HELD
Only tasks in hold status.
LATE
Only the late tasks.
STN
Specifies the station name(s) for which information is desired.
Required: No
*
Indicates all stations.
stationname
Indicates a specific station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
stationname*
Indicates multiple stations represented by a generic station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
SUBID
Specifies the sub-ID(s) of the network for which information is to be selected.
Required: No
*
Indicates all sub-IDs.
subid
Indicates a specific sub-ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
subid*
Indicates multiple sub-IDs represented by a generic sub-ID name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.110.2 Examples
LPOST
LPOST,SEQ=SUBID,SUBID=RPTM
LPOST,ST=LATE,STATION=OUTDEST
LPOST,LIST=Q Screen
< LPOST,LIST=Q
=
LIST=Q DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
NETWORK SUBID
Either the value from the JOBCONN,NWK (DB.3.4) screen, the SUBID entered on
a DMDNW command, or blank if the network was brought into the postprocess
queue with the DMDNW command with no SUBID= keyword.
NETWORK DESC
The value from either the DB.3.4 screen, the DESC entered on the DMDNW
command, or blank if no DESC keyword was entered on the DMDNW command.
STATION NAME
The LTERM name defined as a workstation within this network.
JOB NAME
This is either the job whose connection on the DB.3.4 screen caused the network to
be brought into the postprocess queue, the JOB entered on a DMDNW command,
or a system-generated name of DMD#nnnn for a network demanded with the
DMDNW command with no JOB= keyword (the nnnn being the job number).
DEADLINE
The date and time that this workstation entry should be logged in to be completed
by the due-out time.
LOGIN
The date and time that this workstation entry was logged in. If a login has not
been done, this field is *NONE*.
DUE-OUT
The date and time that this workstation entry should be logged out.
NW/LGOUT
This is either the date and time that this workstation entry was logged out or the
network name if a logout has not been done for this workstation entry.
STATION INFORMATION
This contains the network name, the name of the previous workstation (ORIGIN) if
it is not the first workstation, the name of the next workstation (DESTINATION) if
it is not the last workstation, and the SCHEDULE ID of this network. If the output
network was brought in by a connection to a job and the job was demanded or
triggered in, then that is reflected here also.
LPOST Screen
< LPOST =
LIST= DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
2.111 LPRE
Use the LPRE command to list input network information from the preprocess queue.
This includes the status of all networks and whether they are late. Information, including
documentation, may be listed in a variety of sequences.
2.111.1 Syntax
LPRE
──LPRE──┬───────────────────────────┬──┬─────────┬───────────────
└────,JOB=─┬─M────────┬─────┘ └─,LIST=Q─┘
├─jobname──┤
└─jobname#─┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬────────────────────────────────
└────,NW=─┬─M────────────┬─────┘
├─networkname──┤
└─networkname#─┘
──┬────────────────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬─────
└─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘ │ ┌─NATV─────┐ │
└─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘ └─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬───────────────────────────────┬───────────
│ ┌─M────┐ │ └────,STN=─┬─M────────────┬─────┘
└─,ST=─┼─LATE─┼──┘ ├─stationname──┤
└─HELD─┘ └─stationname#─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────
└─,SUBID=─┬─M──────┬──┘
├─subid──┤
└─subid#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which information is to be listed.
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates multiple jobs specified by a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
LIST
Specifies the amount of queue information requested. When specified, the value
must be Q to list station data only. When LIST is not specified, the display consists
of a single description line for each queue record.
Size/Type: 1 alpha character
Required: No
NW
Specifies the network name(s) for which information is to be listed.
Required: No
*
Indicates all networks.
networkname
Indicates a specific network name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
networkname*
Indicates multiple networks represented by a generic network name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation to be listed. If a subsegment,
use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy).
Required: No
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of the segment.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
The name of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy) enclosed in
parentheses and separated by a comma.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
NW
Network name sequence.
STA
Station name sequence.
SUBID
Sub-ID name sequence.
ST
Limits the display to preprocess queue tasks with a particular status.
Default: *
Required: No
*
All tasks.
HELD
Only tasks in hold status.
LATE
Only late tasks.
STN
Specifies the station name(s) for which information is desired.
Required: No
*
Indicates all stations.
stationname
Indicates a specific station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
stationname*
Indicates multiple stations represented by a generic station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
SUBID
Specifies the sub-ID(s) of the network for which information is to be selected.
Required: No
*
Indicates all sub-IDs.
subid
Indicates a specific sub-ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
subid*
Indicates multiple sub-IDs represented by a generic sub-ID name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.111.2 Examples
LPRE
LPRE,ST=LATE,SEQ=NW
LPRE,STATION=KEYPUNCH
LPRE,LIST=ALL Screen
< LPRE,LIST=ALL
=
LIST=ALL DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
< LPRE
=
LIST= DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
NETWORK DESC
This is either the network name or the DESC entered on a DMDNW command.
STATION NAME
The LTERM name defined as a workstation within this network.
JOB NAME
This is either the job name from the DB.5 screen, the JOB= value on a DMDNW
command or a system-generated name of DMD#nnnn for a network demanded with
the DMDNW command and no JOB= keyword (the nnnn being the job number).
DEADLINE
The date and time that this workstation entry should be logged in to be completed
by the due-out time.
LOGIN
The date and time that this workstation entry was logged in. If a login has not
been done, this field shows *NONE*.
DUE-OUT
The date and time that this workstation entry should be logged out.
NW/LGOUT
This is either the date and time that this workstation entry was logged out or the
network name if a logout has not been done for this workstation entry.
STATION INFORMATION
This contains the network name, the name of the previous workstation (ORIGIN) if
it is not the first workstation, the name of the next workstation (DESTINATION) if
it is not the last workstation, and the SCHEDULE ID of this network. If the
network was brought in by the DMDNW command, then this is reflected here also.
2.112 LPROS
CA-7 allows you to define documentation for each portion of the production workload
through the CA-7 documentation facility. You can define documentation in the CA-7
database for each individual network. Network documentation can be very helpful at the
time a network is being processed. The CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide describes
how this information is entered into the database.
Once defined, this documentation is available at any level, from the general description of
a network to the specific operating instructions for a workstation task. Documentation
can be listed by using the LPROS top line command or the DB.4 screen. Either can be
used in batch or online. It is your responsibility to keep documentation accurate, current,
and consistent with data center standards using the CA-7 database maintenance documen-
tation facilities.
2.112.1 Syntax
LPROS
──LPROS──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
──,─┬─UID=user────────────────────────────────────────┬───────────
├─DSN=dsname──────────────────────────────────────┤
├─DSNBR=─┬─PPM────────┬───────────────────────────┤
│ ├─PPnnnnnn───┤ │
│ └─PP33nnnnn#─┘ │
├─JOB=jobname─┬────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┤
│ └─,STEP=stepname─┘ └─,DD=ddname─┘ │
├─SYS=system──────────────────────────────────────┤
└─NW=network──────────────────────────────────────┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────────┬─────
└─,LIST=─┬─ALL────┬──┘ └─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘
└─NOLINK─┘ └─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘
Where:
UID
Specifies a user-defined name for which the user ID level documentation data is to
be listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters (using OS data set standards)
Required: No (at least one keyword is required)
DSN
Specifies the data set name(s) of the data set level documentation member(s) to be
listed. May be entered either with or without the PP. prefix which is used in the
CA-7 index entry for the documentation data. Value may be specified as a specific
or generic data set name. A generic name is indicated by coding the required levels
of index (nodes) terminated by a period. At least one index level is required.
Required: No (at least one keyword is required)
DSNBR
Specifies a single or generic CA-7 database documentation member number to be
listed.
Required: No (at least one keyword is required)
PP*
Indicates all documentation members in the database.
PPnnnnnn
Specifies a specific database documentation member number where PP is con-
stant and nnnnnn is the CA-7 database documentation member number. Leading
zeros may be omitted.
PP00nnnnn*
Indicates a generic database documentation member number specified in the
PP00nnnnnn format, up to 7 digits, and terminated with an asterisk after the last
significant digit. Leading zeros may not be omitted.
JOB
Specifies a specific job name for which the job level documentation data is to be
listed. Used by itself to list job level documentation.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No (at least one keyword is required)
STEP
Used only with JOB and DD keywords to list DD level documentation.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
DD
Used with JOB and STEP keywords to list the documentation data for the DD in the
STEP of the JOB.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
SYS
Specifies a specific application system name for which the system level documenta-
tion data is to be listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No (at least one keyword is required)
NW
Specifies a specific network name for which the network level documentation data is
to be listed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No (at least one keyword is required)
LIST
Specifies the desired options for listing documentation text. If omitted on a generic
member request, one line giving member level information is listed for each member.
If omitted on a specific member request, information is listed as if ALL had been
specified.
Required: No
ALL
May be used with specific or generic member request to cause documentation
text to be listed. For specific member request, any documentation members
linked to the requested member are listed following text for the primary member.
For generic member request, text from each member is listed as the member is
read.
Note: Documentation members are linked to a member through the LINK field
on the CA-7 Database Maintenance DB.4 screens.
NOLINK
May be used with specific or generic member request to indicate that linked doc-
umentation is not to be listed with primary text.
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation to be listed. If a subsegment,
use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy).
Required: No
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of the segment.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
The name of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy) enclosed in
parentheses and separated by a comma.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters each
2.112.3 Examples
LPROS,DSN=CA7.DSN1
LPROS,DSN=PP.CA7.
LPROS,DSN=PP.CA7,SEG=QDESC
LPROS,JOB=CA7JOB1,LIST=NOLINK
LPROS,DSNBR=PP29,SEG=(HTERM,QDESC)
LPROS,DSNBR=PP33333M
< LPROS,JOB=DUSAXX31
=
DSN=PP.DUSAXX31.JOB DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
. PROSE-TYPE=JOB,JOB=DUSAXX31,SYS=PAYROLL
. DESC=
. LAST MAINTENANCE ON yy.ddd AT hh:mm:ss VIA xxx BY OPERATOR: yyyyyyy
< LPROS,DSN=PP.
=
DSN=PP. DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
2.113 LPRRN
Use the LPRRN command to list job information from the prior-run queue. The prior-run
queue contains information about the last successful completion of each job. Parameters
allow the user to indicate which job or group of jobs is desired, what information is to be
reviewed, and the sequence of the displayed data.
2.113.1 Syntax
LPRRN
──LPRRN──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬───────────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ └─,LIST=option─┘
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname──┼──┘
└─jobname#─┘
──┬────────────────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────
└─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘ │ ┌─NATV─┐ │
└─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘ └─,SEQ=─┴─JOB──┴──┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
LIST
Specifies the amount of information desired.
Default: Single description line for each queue record
Required: No
ALL
All data relative to the queue.
JCL
JCL information from the last good run of the job only. The JCL is listed only
for jobs marked RETAIN-JCL=Y on DB.1 screen. No JCL is listed for non-
executable jobs.
Depending on the security options selected for your installation, the following
values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
PROS
Documentation data as it currently resides in the database only.
Q
Job data only.
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation are to be listed. If a subseg-
ment, use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy).
Required: No
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of the segment.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
Specifies the name of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy)
enclosed in parentheses and separated by a comma.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters each
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the requested information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
JOB
Job name sequence.
SYS
Specifies an application system name(s) to be matched by the system ID in the job
data in order for the job to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.113.2 Examples
LPRRN
LPRRN,JOB=PAYROLL
LPRRN,SEQ=JOB,LIST=Q
LPRRN,JOB=PAYROLL,LIST=JCL
LPRRN Screen
< LPRRN,JOB=D463M
=
LIST=STATUS JOB=D463M DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB CA-7 DEADLINE START DUE-OUT COMPLETE CPU SCH ENTRY JOB
NAME JOB# DDD/HHMM DDD/HHMM DDD/HHMM YYDDD/HHMM SPEC/RUN ID MODE STATUS
D463CLEN 3315 334/1512 334/1415 334/1512 YYDDD/1415 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
D463XX38 3317 334/1513 334/1416 334/1513 YYDDD/1416 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
D463XX39 3322 334/1517 334/1418 334/1517 YYDDD/1418 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
D463XX31 3316 334/1513 334/1416 334/1513 YYDDD/1416 ALL-IPO1 331 AUTO C-C3333
D463XX13 3323 334/1517 334/1419 334/1523 YYDDD/1419 ALL-IPO1 331 AUTO C-C3333
D463XX37 3325 334/1519 334/1422 334/1524 YYDDD/1422 ALL-IPO1 331 DEMD C-C3333
D463LIST 3335 343/1527 343/1433 343/1527 YYDDD/1433 ALL-IPO1 331 DEMD C-C3333
D4638VCT 3331 345/1818 345/1723 345/1818 YYDDD/1733 ALL-IPO1 331 AUTO C-C3333
D463BTI 3332 317/1213 317/1113 317/1213 YYDDD/1113 ALL-IPO1 331 AUTO C-C3333
D463LOGP 3332 355/1232 355/1137 355/1232 YYDDD/1138 ALL-IPO1 331 DEMD C-C3333
D463ICOM 3332 344/1439 344/1339 344/1439 YYDDD/1339 ALL-IPO1 331 AUTO C-C3333
D463XX33 3318 334/1517 334/1418 334/1523 YYDDD/1418 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
D463XX34 3319 334/1517 334/1418 334/1522 YYDDD/1418 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
D463XX32 3321 334/1517 334/1418 334/1517 YYDDD/1418 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
D463XX35 3323 334/1518 334/1419 334/1523 YYDDD/1419 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
D463XX36 3324 334/1518 334/1421 334/1523 YYDDD/1421 ALL-IPO1 331 SSCN C-C3333
JOB NAME
The name of the job as defined in the database. See NAME field on the DB.1
screen.
CA-7 JOB#
The CA-7 job number that was assigned on initial queue entry.
DEADLINE
A calculated time by which this job should have started to have been completed by
the due-out time.
START
The time that the job actually started.
DUE-OUT
The original due-out time for this job.
COMPLETE YYDDD
The date that this job actually completed.
COMPLETE HHMM
The time that this job actually completed.
CPU SPEC/RUN
The MAINID specified for this job to be submitted to/and the system that it ran on.
SCHID
The schedule ID that this job was brought into the request queue and ran under.
ENTRY MODE
How the job was brought into the queue. Values are:
ARFJ ARF job.
AUTO TRIGGERed job.
DEMD DEMANDed job.
EXTL Job submitted external to CA-7.
PS Job submitted by Personal Scheduling System.
SSCN Job record brought in by schedule scan.
XDEM Job brought in by the DEMAND command from an XPS client.
Note: If ARF detects an exception condition for the job, the last character of this
field has an asterisk as in the following: DEM*
JOB STATUS
The highest condition code passed by any step within this job.
2.114 LQ
Use the LQ command to list information on CPU jobs from the request, ready, and active
queues. The queue information provided shows the status on all production activity
known to CA-7. This command is helpful in determining the queue in which a job cur-
rently resides.
2.114.1 Syntax
LQ LQUE
──┬─LQ───┬──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬───────────
└─LQUE─┘ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=option─┘
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ └─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬─────────────┬────────────────────────
│ ┌─NATV─────┐ │ └─,ST=display─┘
└─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which information is to be selected.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates multiple jobs specified by a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Specifies the amount of queue information requested.
Required: No
ALL
All data related to the job(s).
JCL
JCL information only.
Depending on the security options your installation selected, the following values
may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
PROS
Documentation information only.
Q
Job data only.
RQMT
All requirements information only. This can include a possible ARF error
message as described in 2.114.3, “ARF Error Messages” on page 2-339.
STATUS
Unsatisfied requirements information only.
When a specific job is requested through the JOB parameter, the default is
LIST=STATUS and all unsatisfied job requirements are listed. When JOB and LIST
are not specified, a default display consisting of one description line for each queue
record is listed. If SEG is specified, the default is LIST=PROS.
Note: If RQMT or STATUS is specified, VRM requirements are listed for jobs in
the ready queue with a status of W-RSRC.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation to be listed. If a subsegment,
use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy).
Required: No
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of the segment.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
The name of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy) enclosed in
parentheses and separated by a comma.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters each
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
ST
Specifies the display criteria for the queue information. If omitted, all jobs in the
request, ready, and active queues are displayed.
Default: All jobs in the request, ready, and active queues
Required: No
ABND
Displays only the jobs in the request queue or active queue that are in ABEND
status.
ARAE
Displays only jobs which encountered an ARF attach error.
ARF
Displays only jobs which are being tracked by ARF.
ARFH
Displays only jobs which are in ARF recovery status.
ARFJ
Displays only ARF recovery jobs (entry mode=ARFJ).
CBAD
Displays only the jobs in the request queue or active queue that are in BAD
COMPLETION CODE status.
COMP
Displays jobs in the request queue that have completed successfully and are
waiting for CA-7 completion processing.
HELD
Displays jobs in hold status.
JCLO
Displays jobs requiring JCL overrides.
JCLR
Displays only the jobs in the request queue, ready queue, or active queue that are
in JCL ERROR status.
LATE
Displays late jobs.
MANV
Displays jobs requiring manual verification.
NOID
Displays only the jobs in the request queue, ready queue, or active queue that are
in SECURITY ERROR status.
REQU
Displays only the jobs in the request queue that are in REQUEUE status.
RSTR
Displays jobs in the request queue requiring restart.
RTRY
Displays only the jobs in the request queue that are in RETRY status.
SKEL
Displays only the jobs in the request queue that are in SKELETON status.
SUBM
Displays jobs in the ready queue which have been submitted to the host system
for execution.
WRSC
Displays jobs in the ready queue that are waiting for resources.
SYS
Specifies an application system name(s) to be matched by the system ID in the job
data in order for the job to be listed.
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
2.114.2 Examples
LQ
LQUE,ST=LATE,SEQ=JOB
LQUE,LIST=STATUS,JOB=15
LQ,JOB=MYJOB1,LIST=ALL
LQ,JOB=MYM
LQ,ST=HELD,SEQ=CA7
LQ,SEQ=CA7
< LQ
=
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME NUM DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
HISTORY REQ 3135 398/1325 MNONEM 398/1325 ALL- 331 DEMD 332
CA7LJESX REQ 3132 398/1324 398/1333 398/1333 ALL- 331 SSCN 331
C7TST331 REQ 3136 398/1325 MNONEM 398/1325 ALL- 331 DEMD 331
C7TST332 REQ 3137 398/1325 MNONEM 398/1325 ALL- 331 DEMD 331
< LQ,JOB=DUSAZZ31,LIST=RQMT
=
LIST=RQMT JOB=DUSAZZ31 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME NUM DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
DUSAZZ31 REQ 3335 128/1611 MNONEM 128/1611 /SY2- 331 DEMD 333 LATE
---------------------------REQUIREMENTS STATUS ---------------------
_ _ _ _ JCL OVERRIDES REQUIRED
_ _ _ _ INTERNAL JOB=DUSAZZ13 DATE/TIME=YYDDD/HHMM
< LQ,JOB=DUSAZZ31,LIST=JCL
=
LIST=JCL JOB=DUSAZZ31 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME NUM DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
DUSAZZ31 REQ 3335 128/1611 MNONEM 128/1611 /SY2- 331 DEMD 334 R-REQUE
---------------------------- JCL INFORMATION -----------------------
//DUSAZZ31 JOB HE67YFSH,PAYROLL,REGION=43K,TIME=3333,CLASS=B 3313
/MROUTE PRINT RMT2 3323
/MJOBPARM ROOM=543 3333
//MUCC7RESTART UCC7
K L
< LQ,JOB=215,SEG=QDESC =
LIST=PROS CA-7#=3215 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
SEG=(QDESC)
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME NUM DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
CA37XX31 REQ 3215 173/1943 MNONEM 173/1943 ALL- 331 DEMD 331
-------------------------- PROSE INFORMATION --------------------------
MMM JOB CA37XX31
MMM SCHEDULED JOB, FIRST IN THE NETWORK
MMM FIRST STEP
K L
LQ,LIST= Screen
< LQ =
LIST= DATE=33.295 PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME JOB# DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
JOEJOB1 RDY 3332 288/1135 MNONEM 288/1135 ALL- 331 DEMD 333 W-RSRC
JOEJOB15 RDY 3338 288/1327 MNONEM 288/1327 ALL- 331 DEMD 333 W-RSRC
SCA1333D RDY 3321 295/3954 295/3919 295/1333 ALL- 399 SSCN 333 LATE
TESTJOBA RDY 3324 295/1116 MNONEM 295/1116 ALL- 331 DEMD 333 W-RSRC
K L
JOB NAME
The name of the job as defined in the database. See NAME field on the DB.1
screen.
QUEUE NAME
The queue where this job record currently resides. Values are REQ for request
queue, RDY for ready queue, and ACT for active queue.
CA-7 JOB#
The CA-7 assigned job number.
DEADLINE
A calculated time by which this job should be active on the CPU to be completed
by the due-out time.
SUB/START
For a job in the request queue, this is the time of a submit time requirement. (The
requirement can be manually posted, leaving a date/time value with no outstanding
submit time requirement.) If there is a value for a job in the ready queue, then this
is the time that the JCL was written to the submit data set or internal reader. Until
the first SMF step termination record is received, this field is *NONE* for a job in
the active queue.
DUE-OUT
The due-out time for this job.
CPU SPEC/RUN
The SPEC value is what CPU this job should be submitted to (see MAINID field
on DB.1 screen). The RUN value is what CPU the job has been submitted to. For
7UNI jobs the RUN value can be 7UWT, which indicates that the process has not
started on the submitted to platform.
SCHID
The schedule ID assigned when this job was brought into the request queue.
ENTRY MODE
How the job was brought into the queue. Values are:
ARFJ ARF recovery job.
AUTO TRIGGERed job.
DEMD DEMANDed job.
EXTL Job submitted external to CA-7.
LOAD Job record to be LOADed (brought in by the LOAD command).
PS Job submitted by Personal Scheduling System.
RUN Job brought in by the RUN command.
SSCN Job record brought in by schedule scan.
XDEM Job brought in by the DEMAND command from an XPS client.
XPS Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command with the
REF option.
XRUN Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command.
Note: If ARF detects an exception condition for the job, the last character of this
field has an asterisk as in the following: DEM*
MSTR REQ
The number of outstanding master requirements for a job record.
JOB STATUS
The indication of the job's current disposition. Values and their meanings are:
A-Snnnn The job has failed with a system abend.
A-Unnnn The job has failed with a user abend.
C-Cnnnn The job has completed successfully and is going through completion
processing.
E-ARFATT An error occurred during the attempt to attach ARF definitions. This
can result if the ARFSET specified is not defined. A diagnostic
message may have been written to the CA-7 log, the OS console, or
to the trailer queue for the job (in which case it can be displayed
using LQ,JOB=x,LIST=ALL).
E-ARFERR The job encountered an error in the ARF processing. Do a LARFQ
command for the job to get more specific information.
E-SEGERR The job has been requeued to the request queue because the CA-7
job submission task was unable to read a security segment for the
job.
LATE The job has not either started by the DEADLINE DAY/TIME or has
not completed by its DUE-OUT DAY/TIME.
2.115 LQP
Use the LQP command to list current job workload balancing priority information from
the request and ready queues. The display shows the current resources and priorities
assigned to each job in the queue. When workload balancing is active, priorities are in a
continuous state of being dynamically reconsidered and recalculated. You can also use
this command when workload balancing is not active.
2.115.1 Syntax
LQP
──┬─LQP───┬──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──────────
└─LQUEP─┘ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=STATUS─┘
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬───────────────────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ │ ┌─PRTY─┐ │
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,SEQ=─┴─JOB──┴──┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Displays itemized status information messages about the job(s) in the queues. When
specified, the value must be LIST=STATUS. If omitted, displays a single line for
each job.
Required: No
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: PRTY
Required: No
PRTY
Descending job priority sequence. The current priority is determined by the
workload balancing system.
JOB
Job name sequence.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.115.2 Examples
LQP,JOB=DUSM,SYS=M,LIST=STATUS
LQP,SEQ=PRTY
LQUEP,JOB=DUSAXX31
< LQP
=
SEQ=PRTY
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUE CA-7 JOB TAPE1 TAPE2 CPU START TIME PRIORITY NON-SUB
NAME NAME NMBR CLS NBR/PRTY NBR/PRTY %UTLIL/PRTY MINS/PRTY ORIG/NEW REASON
< LQP,LIST=STATUS
=
LIST=STATUS SEQ=JOB
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUE CA-7 JOB TAPE1 TAPE2 CPU START TIME PRIORITY NON-SUB
NAME NAME NMBR CLS NBR/PRTY NBR/PRTY %UTLIL/PRTY MINS/PRTY ORIG/NEW REASON
K L
LQP,SEQ=JOB Screen
< LQP,SEQ=JOB
=
SEQ=JOB
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUE CA-7 JOB TAPE1 TAPE2 CPU START TIME PRIORITY NON-SUB
NAME NAME NMBR CLS NBR/PRTY NBR/PRTY %UTLIL/PRTY MINS/PRTY ORIG/NEW REASON
2.116 LQR
Use the LQR command to list workload balancing information on all job resource
requirements from the CA-7 queues. The queue information provided shows current
resource requirements for each job.
2.116.1 Syntax
LQR
──┬─LQR───┬──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬────
└─LQUER─┘ │ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │
└─,CPUID=─┴─smfid─┴──┘ └─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────
│ ┌─ALL──┐ │ │ ┌─333─┐ │
└─,MAINID=─┼─SYn──┼──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
├─/SYn─┤
└─-SYn─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────────────┬──────
│ ┌─NATV─────┐ │ │ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘ └────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
CPUID
Indicates the CPU ID(s) for which jobs are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all CPU IDs.
smfid
Indicates only jobs with this specific CPU ID. The value is the SMF system ID.
CPUID as a search argument in the inquiry command, must match the SMF
system identifier as defined to the OS system by the user and received by CA-7
in the SMF records.
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
MAINID
Indicates that only those jobs with this MAINID (as defined on the DB.1 screen) are
to be listed. Jobs defined with MAINID of ALL are selected regardless of MAINID
entered.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Indicates all MAINIDs.
SYn
Where n indicates a CPU assigned number as defined in the initialization file
CPU statement for which information is to be listed. (See the CA-7 Systems
Programmer Guide for further information on the initialization file.) The value
of n may range from 1 to 7. If a slash (/) precedes the SYn, then the only jobs
selected are those that are denoted to execute on /SYn.
-SYn
Where n indicates a CPU assigned number for which information is not to be
listed. The value of n may range from 1 to 7.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.116.2 Examples
LQR,JOB=DUSM,MAINID=SY3
LQUER,MAINID=SY1
< LQR
=
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB SYSTEM MAIN JOB CPU CA-7# CPU/ELAPS TOTAL TAPES CPU% SUBMIT
NAME -NAME- -ID- C/PRT -ID NUMBR --TIME--- TP1 TP2 UTIL DATE/TIME
2.117 LRDY
Use the LRDY command to list job information from the ready queue. This information
provides details on jobs which have all preexecution requirements satisfied and are only
waiting to be submitted to the host system. Jobs which have been submitted but have not
yet begun to execute remain in this queue until execution does begin and show a submit
time. Status, documentation, and JCL are among the information that can be displayed.
2.117.1 Syntax
LRDY
──LRDY──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬───────────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=option─┘
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ └─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬─────────────┬────────────────────────
│ ┌─NATV─────┐ │ └─,ST=display─┘
└─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which information is to be selected.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates multiple jobs specified by a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Specifies the amount of queue information requested.
Required: No
ALL
All data related to the job.
JCL
JCL information only.
Depending on the security options selected for your installation, the following
values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
PROS
Documentation information only.
Q
Job data only.
RQMT
All requirements information only.
STATUS
Requirements information only.
When LIST is not specified, a default display consisting of a single description line
for each queue record is listed. However, when a specific job is requested by the
JOB parameter, the default is LIST=STATUS and all job requirements are listed. If
SEG is specified, the default is LIST=PROS.
Note: If RQMT or STATUS is specified, VRM requirements are listed for jobs in
the ready queue with a status of W-RSRC.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation to be listed. If a subsegment,
use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy).
Required: No
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of the segment.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
The name of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy) enclosed in
parentheses and separated by a comma.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters for each segment
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 assigned job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
ST
Specifies the display criteria for the queue information. If omitted, all jobs in the
ready queue are displayed.
Required: No
HELD
Jobs in hold status.
JCLR
Jobs with a JCL error status.
LATE
Late jobs.
SUBM
Jobs submitted to the host system for execution.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.117.2 Examples
LRDY
LRDY,JOB=G431
< LRDY
=
LIST= DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME NUM DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
PERAC31D RDY 3316 384/1649 384/1549 384/1649 SY2- 331 DEMD 333 LATE
WHSAA31D RDY 3319 384/1733 MNONEM 384/1833 ALL- 335 AUTO 333 RUSH
SUB/START
If there is a date and time value here, then this is the time that the job was written
either to a submit data set or to the internal reader. A value of *NONE* denotes
that this job has not yet been submitted.
DUE-OUT
The due-out time for the job.
CPU SPEC/RUN
The SPEC value is what CPU this job should be submitted to (see MAINID field
on DB.1 screen). The RUN value is what CPU the job has been submitted to.
SCHID
The schedule ID assigned when this job was brought into the request queue.
ENTRY MODE
How the job was brought into the queue. Values are:
ARFJ ARF recovery job.
AUTO TRIGGERed job.
DEMD DEMANDed job.
EXTL Job submitted external to CA-7.
LOAD Job record to be LOADed (brought in by the LOAD command).
PS Job submitted by Personal Scheduling System.
RUN Job brought in by the RUN command.
SSCN Job record brought in by schedule scan.
XDEM Job brought in by the DEMAND command from an XPS client.
XPS Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command with the
REF option.
XRUN Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command.
Note: If ARF detects an exception condition for the job, the last character of this
field has an asterisk as in the following: DEM*
MSTR REQ
The master requirement count. This field is zero for a job in the ready queue.
JOB STATUS
Indication of a condition on this job record. Possible values are:
LATE The job has not started by the DEADLINE DAY/TIME.
R-JCLERR If the job is in the ready queue with this status, then a job purge
record was received before a job initiation record.
RUSH The RUSH command was entered for this job.
2.118 LRDYP
Use the LRDYP command to list current job workload balancing priority information
from the ready queue for jobs which are awaiting submittal or execution. This command
is similar to the 2.115, “LQP” on page 2-340. You can also use this command when
workload balancing is not active.
2.118.1 Syntax
LRDYP
──LRDYP──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──────────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=STATUS─┘
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬───────────────────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ │ ┌─PRTY─┐ │
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,SEQ=─┴─JOB──┴──┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Displays status information about the job(s) in the queue. When specified, the value
must be LIST=STATUS. When omitted, lists only a single line for each job.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: PRTY
Required: No
PRTY
Information appears in descending job priority sequence. The current priority is
determined by the workload balancing system.
JOB
Information appears in job name sequence.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.118.2 Examples
LRDYP
LRDYP,LIST=STATUS,SEQ=PRTY
< LRDYP
=
SEQ=PRTY DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUE CA-7 JOB TAPE1 TAPE2 CPU START TIME PRIORITY NON-SUB
NAME NAME NMBR CLS NBR/PRTY NBR/PRTY %UTLIL/PRTY MINS/PRTY ORIG/NEW REASON
NON-SUB REASON
The number of nonsubmittal reasons. Enter LQP,LIST=STATUS to view the
reason(s).
2.119 LRDYR
Use the LRDYR command to list outstanding (unsatisfied) job resource requirement
information on CPU jobs in the ready queue. This command is similar to 2.116, “LQR”
on page 2-344.
2.119.1 Syntax
LRDYR
──LRDYR──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │
└─,CPUID=─┴─smfid─┴──┘ └─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────
│ ┌─ALL──┐ │ │ ┌─333─┐ │
└─,MAINID=─┼─SYn──┼──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
├─/SYn─┤
└─-SYn─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────────────┬──────
│ ┌─NATV─────┐ │ │ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘ └────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
CPUID
Indicates the CPU ID(s) for which jobs are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all CPU IDs.
smfid
Indicates only jobs with this specific CPU ID. The value is the SMF system ID.
CPUID as a search argument in the inquiry command, must match the SMF
system identifier as defined to the operating system by the user and received by
CA-7 in the SMF records.
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
MAINID
Indicates that only those jobs with this MAINID (as defined on the DB.1 screen) are
to be listed. Jobs defined with MAINID of ALL are selected regardless of MAINID
entered.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Indicates all MAINIDs.
SYn
Where n indicates a CPU for which information is to be listed. The value of n
may range from 1 to 7. If a slash (/) precedes the SYn, then the only jobs
selected are those that are denoted to execute on /SYn.
-SYn
Where n indicates a CPU assigned number for which information is not to be
listed. The value of n may range from 1 to 7.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
Information appears in CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Information appears in deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Information appears in due-out time sequence.
JOB
Information appears in job name sequence.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.119.2 Examples
LRDYR
LRDYR,MAINID=SY2
< LRDYR
=
JOB=FXABA32M DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB SYSTEM MAIN JOB CPU CA-7# CPU/ELAPS TOTAL TAPES CPU% SUBMIT
NAME -NAME- -ID- C/PRT -ID NUMBR --TIME--- TP1 TP2 UTIL DATE/TIME
2.120 LREQ
Use the LREQ command to list job information from the request queue for jobs which
have been scheduled into the queue, but still have preexecution requirements which must
be satisfied before the job can execute. Jobs which have completed successfully return
temporarily to the request queue for job completion processing. Jobs which run and
abnormally terminate are also returned to this queue to await restart by the user. See
2.96, “LIST” on page 2-254 for information on how to display information on jobs
waiting for a restart.
2.120.1 Syntax
LREQ
──LREQ──┬──────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬─────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=─┬─ALL────┬──┘
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘ ├─JCL────┤
├─jobname#──┤ ├─PROS───┤
└─jobnumber─┘ ├─Q──────┤
├─RQMT───┤
└─STATUS─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ └─,SEG=─┬─xxxxxxxx────────────┬──┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬──┬─────────────┬────────────────────────
│ ┌─NATV─────┐ │ └─,ST=display─┘
└─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which information is to be selected.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates multiple jobs specified by a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Specifies the amount of queue information requested.
Required: No
ALL
All data related to the job(s).
JCL
JCL information only.
Depending on certain security options selected for your installation, the following
values may be concealed in the display:
JOB statement USER keyword
JOB statement GROUP keyword
JOB statement PASSWORD keyword
//*LOGONID statement
//*PASSWORD statement
//*JOBFROM statement
PROS
Documentation information only.
Q
Job data only.
RQMT
All requirement information only.
STATUS
Unsatisfied requirement information only.
When LIST is not specified, a default display consisting of a single description line
for each queue record is listed. However, when a specific job is requested by the
JOB parameter, the default is LIST=STATUS and all unsatisfied job requirements are
listed. If SEG is specified, the default is LIST=PROS.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEG
Specifies a segment and subsegment of documentation to be listed. If a subsegment,
use the form (xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy).
xxxxxxxx
Is the name of a segment.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
(xxxxxxxx,yyyyyyyy)
The names of a segment (xxxxxxxx) and subsegment (yyyyyyyy) enclosed in
parentheses and separated by a comma.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters each
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
ST
Specifies the display criteria for the queue information. If omitted, displays all jobs
in the request queue.
Required: No
ABND
Displays only the jobs that are in ABEND status.
CBAD
Displays only the jobs that are in BAD COMPLETION CODE status.
COMP
Displays jobs in the request queue that have completed successfully and are
waiting for CA-7 completion processing.
HELD
Displays jobs in hold status.
JCLO
Displays jobs requiring JCL overrides.
JCLR
Displays only the jobs that are in JCL ERROR status.
LATE
Displays late jobs.
MANV
Displays jobs requiring manual verification.
NOID
Displays only the jobs that are in SECURITY ERROR status.
REQU
Displays only the jobs that are in REQUEUE status.
RSTR
Displays jobs requiring restart.
RTRY
Displays only the jobs that are in RETRY status.
SKEL
Displays only the jobs that are in SKELETON status.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.120.2 Examples
LREQ,ST=HELD,SEQ=JOB
< LREQ
=
JOB=ACPBA31W DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB QUEUE CA-7 -DAY(DDD) AND TIME(HHMM)-- CPU SCH ENTRY MSTR JOB
NAME NAME NUM DEADLINE SUB/START DUE-OUT SPEC/RUN ID MODE REQ STATUS
ACPBA31W REQ 3316 384/1649 384/1549 384/1649 SY2- 331 DEMD 333 LATE
ENTRY MODE
How the job was brought into the queue. Values are:
ARFJ ARF recovery job.
AUTO TRIGGERed job.
DEMD DEMANDed job.
EXTL Job submitted external to CA-7.
LOAD Job record to be LOADed (brought in by the LOAD command).
PS Job submitted by Personal Scheduling System.
RUN Job brought in by the RUN command.
SSCN Job record brought in by schedule scan.
XDEM Job brought in by the DEMAND command from an XPS client.
XPS Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command with the
REF option.
XRUN Job brought in from an XPS client using the RUN command.
Note: If ARF detects an exception condition for the job, the last character of this
field has an asterisk as in the following: DEM*
MSTR REQ
The number of outstanding master requirements for a job record.
JOB STATUS
The indication of the job's current disposition. Values are:
A-Snnnn The job has failed with a system abend.
A-Unnnn The job has failed with a user abend.
C-Cnnnn The job has completed successfully and is going through completion
processing.
E-ARFATT An error occurred during the attempt to attach ARF definitions. This
can result if the ARFSET specified is not defined. A diagnostic
message may have been written to the CA-7 log, the OS console, or
to the trailer queue for the job (in which case it can be displayed
using LQ,JOB=x,LIST=ALL).
E-SEGERR The job has been requeued to the request queue because the CA-7
job submission task was unable to read a security segment for the
job.
LATE The job has not either started by the DEADLINE DAY/TIME or has
not completed by its DUE-OUT DAY/TIME.
LOADING The job completed execution of a LOAD-only run and is completing
the LOAD process. This status is for jobs in the request queue.
QJCL This job is in the request queue with zero master requirements. At
the time the command was issued, CA-7 was processing a SAVE or
REPL function on the QM.5 (QJCL) screen for this job.
R-#nnnn The job has failed a condition code test made at the step level.
R-Cnnnn The job has failed a condition code test made at the job level.
R-JCLERR If the job is in the request queue with this status, then there was
either a runtime JCL error (for example, data set not found) or an
IEFUJV exit canceled the job. If the job is in the ready queue with
this status, then a job purge record was received before a job initial-
ization record.
R-NOUID During submission, if no valid USERID is available, a check of the
SUBNOID parameter is done to determine if a job may be submitted
without an ID. With SUBNOID set to NO, the job is moved back to
the request queue with a status of R-NOUID.
R-REQUE The job has been requeued to the request queue using the
REQUEUE command or the Q function on the QM.1 screen.
R-TRLFUL At the time the job was active, CA-7 required another track to be
obtained from the trailer queue to hold outputs. At the time that
CA-7 tried to get another track, either an out of space condition or
an I/O error occurred.
RETRY A dynamic allocation error occurred during attach of JCL for this
job. At a user-specified time interval, a retry of the JCL attach
occurs.
RQMT-INC A job record is in the queue without its requirements attached.
RUSH The RUSH command was entered for this job.
SKELETON
A job record is in the queue without JCL attached.
2.121 LREQP
Use the LREQP command to list current job priority information on each job in the
request queue. This command is similar to the 2.115, “LQP” on page 2-340.
2.121.1 Syntax
LREQP
──LREQP──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──────────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ └─,LIST=STATUS─┘
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬───────────────────────
│ ┌─333─┐ │ │ ┌─PRTY─┐ │
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘ └─,SEQ=─┴─JOB──┴──┘
──┬──────────────────────────────┬───────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Displays status information about the job(s) in the queue. When specified, the option
must be LIST=STATUS. When omitted, only one line is listed for each job.
Required: No
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: PRTY
Required: No
PRTY
Descending workload balancing job priority sequence. The priority is deter-
mined by workload balancing.
JOB
Job name sequence.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.121.2 Examples
LREQP,JOB=DUSAM,SEQ=PRTY,SYS=SYS1
2.122 LREQR
Use the LREQR command to list CPU resource requirement information for jobs in the
request queue. This command is similar to 2.116, “LQR” on page 2-344.
2.122.1 Syntax
LREQR
──LREQR──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─M─────┐ │ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │
└─,CPUID=─┴─smfid─┴──┘ └─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬────────────────────
└─,MAINID=─┬─ALL──┬──┘ │ ┌─333─┐ │
├─SYn──┤ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
├─/SYn─┤
└─-SYn─┘
──┬─────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────────────┬──────────
│ ┌─NATV─┐ │ │ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┼─CA7──┼──┘ └────,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼─────┘
├─DLTM─┤ └─systemname#─┘
├─DOTM─┤
└─JOB──┘
Where:
CPUID
Indicates the CPU ID(s) for which jobs are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all CPU IDs.
smfid
Indicates only jobs with this specific CPU ID. The value is the SMF system ID.
CPUID as a search argument in the inquiry command, must match the SMF
system identifier as defined to the operating system by the user and received by
CA-7 in the SMF records.
JOB
Identifies the job(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
MAINID
Indicates that only those jobs with this MAINID (as defined on the DB.1 screen) are
to be listed. Jobs defined with MAINID of ALL are selected regardless of MAINID
entered.
Required: No
ALL
Indicates all MAINIDs.
SYn
Where n indicates a CPU assigned number as defined in the initialization file
CPU statement for which information is to be listed. (See the CA-7 Systems
Programmer Guide for further information on the initialization file.) The value
of n may range from 1 to 7. If a slash (/) precedes the SYn, then the only jobs
selected are those that are denoted to execute on /SYn.
-SYn
Where n indicates a CPU assigned number for which information is not to be
listed. The value of n may range from 1 to 7.
SCHID
Specifies the schedule ID for which information is to be selected.
Default: 0 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the desired information.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 job number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
SYS
Identifies the application system name(s) whose queue information is to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.122.2 Examples
LREQR,MAINID=SY1
< LREQR
=
DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB SYSTEM MAIN JOB CPU CA-7# CPU/ELAPS TOTAL TAPES CPU% SUBMIT
NAME -NAME- -ID- C/PRT -ID NUMBR --TIME--- TP1 TP2 UTIL DATE/TIME
2.123 LRES
Use the LRES command to list the resources needed for jobs in the database or queues.
Magnetic tape, memory and CPU time requirements are shown for any job or group of
jobs specified by the user.
2.123.1 Syntax
LRES
──LRES──,───┬─Q=queue───────────┬───────────────────────────────
├─SYS=system────────┤
└─JOB=─┬─jobname─┬──┘
└─NO──────┘
Where:
Q
Specifies the resource information desired. If Q is specified, SYS must be omitted.
ACT
Active queue
ALL
All queues
RDY
Ready queue
RDYACT
Ready and active queues
REQ
Request queue
REQACT
Request and active queues
REQRDY
Request and ready queues
SYS
Specifies that resource information is desired about all jobs in the database for this
application system. The option must be a system name. If SYS is specified, Q must
be omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, unless Q is specified
JOB
Specifies the job about which resource information is desired. If JOB is omitted,
resource information on all jobs is given based on whether SYS or Q was specified.
2.123.2 Examples
LRES,SYS=BLM
LRES,Q=ACT
LRES,SYS=S168 Screen
< LRES,SYS=S168
=
SYS=S168 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3334
2.124 LRLOG
Use the LRLOG command to list information from the CA-7 run log. The run log con-
tains the information on certain events which occur during CA-7 processing. These
events include job and network completions and exception events such as restarts, force
completes, and cancels.
The run log maintains data for the previous n number of days. The default is to retain 5
days of run log data. That is the current date, up to the moment, and the four previous
calendar days.
An option in the CA-7 initialization file controls the number of days retained. Refer to
the RLOGDAYS keyword on the DBASE statement in the CA-7 Systems Programmer
Guide.
2.124.1 Syntax
LRLOG
──LRLOG──┬────────────────────┬──┬───────────────────────────┬───
│ ┌─M──────┐ │ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,DATE=─┴─#yyddd─┴──┘ └────,JOB=─┼─jobname──┼─────┘
└─jobname#─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬──────────────────
│ ┌─ALL────┐ │ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,LIST=─┴─option─┴──┘ └─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘
└─network#─┘
──┬──────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬──────────────────────────
│ ┌─3─┐ │ │ ┌─333─┐ │
└─,OPT=─┴─1─┴──┘ └─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
──┬─────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─DATE─────┐ │
└─,SEQ=─┴─sequence─┴──┘
──┬───────────────────────────────────────────────────────┬───────
│ ┌─current date──────────────────────────────┐ │
└─,SPAN=─┼─M─────────────────────────────────────────┼──┘
├─scope─────────────────────────────────────┤
├─date──────────────────────────────────────┤
├─(start date,start time,scope)─────────────┤
└─(start date,start time,end date,end time)─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬───────────────────
│ ┌─M──────┐ │ │ ┌─M──────┐ │
└─,ST=─┴─option─┴──┘ └─,SUBID=─┼─subid──┼──┘
└─subid#─┘
──┬────────────────────┬─────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M───────┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─system──┼──┘
└─system#─┘
Where:
DATE
Specifies the date(s) of the information requested.
Required: No
*
Indicates all days in the run log. As supplied, the system contains five (5) days
of data.
*YYDDD
Indicates a specific date. If specified, the date must be in the form *YYDDD,
where yy is the year and ddd is the Julian day and must be within the last 5
calendar days.
JOB
Identifies the job(s) to be displayed from the run log.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
LIST
Controls what types of objects are selected.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Selects all types of objects (all jobs and networks).
JOB
Selects only job related events.
XJOB
Selects only external job related events. An external job is one which is tracked
by CA-7 even though CA-7 did not submit it.
NW
Selects only network related events.
INW
Selects only input network related events.
ONW
Selects only output network related events.
Note: The old option RSTR is still accepted. It is processed as if ST=RSTR
were entered.
NW
Specifies the network(s) to be displayed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all networks.
network
Indicates a specific network.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
network*
Indicates a generic network.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
OPT
Controls the output format of the data displayed. This keyword allows you to have
the run log data displayed in the pre-Version 3.2 format. If you wish to see run log
data in the same manner it was presented in previous versions, specify OPT=1 on the
LRLOG command.
Default: 0
Required: No
0
Displays run log data in the Version 3.2 and above format.
1
Displays run log data in the pre-Version 3.2 format.
Note: If you have Batch Terminal (BTI) jobs which extract run log data for
further processing and it is expecting the pre-Version 3.2 format, you can
specify a default Batch LRLOG format in the CA-7 initialization file.
See the RLOGBDEF keyword on the OPTIONS statement in the CA-7
Systems Programmer Guide.
SCHID
Indicates to only select events with a specific schedule ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric from 1 to 255
Default: 000 (all schedule IDs)
Required: No
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the selected run log data.
Default: DATE
Required: No
DATE
Date and time sequence.
JOB
Job name, and date/time sequence within jobs with the same name.
NW
Network name, and date/time sequence within networks with the same name.
REV
Reverse date and time sequence.
SUBID
Sub-ID, and date/time sequence within networks with the same Sub-ID.
Note: The old option NATV is still accepted. However, it is processed the
same as the DATE option.
SPAN
Run log records are searched for the time period specified or implied by this
keyword. It can be expressed as a scope, a starting date/time and scope, or as a date
and time range. This keyword is mutually exclusive with the DATE= keyword.
Default: Current date
Required: No
*
Indicates all run log data should be searched.
scope
Use this format to search most current information in the run log for a fixed
period. The starting time is calculated as the current time minus the scope. The
ending time is the current time. The scope can be expressed as a number of
hours (1-3 digits), or as hours and minutes (4 digits).
date
Use this format to search the run log data for a specific date. The date can be
expressed as a 5 digit Julian date (YYDDD), or as a 6 digit Gregorian date
(MMDDYY).
ST
Controls what types of events are selected.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Selects all types of events.
COMP
Selects only job and network completion events.
LATE
Selects only job and network completion events where the completion was con-
sidered late by CA-7.
CANCEL
Selects only job and network cancel events.
FORCE
Selects only force complete events.
RSTR
Selects only restart events.
EXCP
Selects only exception events. That is, only non-completion events are selected
(cancel, force complete, requeue, and restart).
Note: The old option CANC is still accepted. It is processed the same as the
CANCEL option.
SUBID
Specifies the sub-ID(s) to be displayed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all sub-IDs.
subid
Indicates a specific sub-ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
subid*
Indicates a generic sub-ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
SYS
Identifies the system(s) to be selected from the run log.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all systems.
system
Indicates to select only jobs with a specific system name.
Size/Type : 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
system*
Indicates to select only jobs whose system name begins with the generic system
name.
Size/Type : 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.124.2 Examples
LRLOG Screen
< LRLOG =
DATE=YY.361 PAGE 3331
OBJECT TYPE
Describes the type of object that was involved with this event.
J Job
J External Job
I Input Network
O Output Network
OBJECT NAME
The name of the job or network that the event relates to. If it is a network related
event, this field reflects the actual network name.
CA-7#
The CA-7 assigned job or network reference number.
SCH
The CA-7 schedule ID.
SYSTEM
For job entries, the system name. For network entries, the generated job name for
this execution of the network.
STATUS
The status of the network or system status of the job.
COMP Normal Completion
S nnn Abnormal System Completion (nnn = abend code)
U nnn Abnormal User Completion (nnn = completion code)
Cnnnn Job level condition code.
#nnnn Step level condition code.
JCLER JCL Error
CANCL Cancel (network only)
FCOMP Force Complete
REQUE Requeued
FAIL Special job UCC7Rxx failed
ENTRY MODE
The entry mode of the job or network.
ARFJ ARF recovery job.
AUTO Trigger.
DMND DEMAND command.
LOAD LOAD command.
PS Personal Scheduling.
RUN RUN command.
SSCN Schedule scan.
XDEM DEMAND command from an XPS client.
XPS XPS client using the RUN command with the REF option.
XRUN XPS client using the RUN command.
TRGR CA7#
If the object was brought into the system through a trigger, or as an ARF recovery
job, this field contains the CA-7 job number of the triggering object. Otherwise, it
is zero.
START
Starting date and time for event type of C (and other event types as available).
END
Completion date and time for event type of C (and other event types as available).
LATE
An L at the end of the completion time indicates that the job or network was con-
sidered late by CA-7.
SUBID=
For input and output network events, an additional line is displayed showing the
network sub-ID, description and any initials supplied during the logout of the last
workstation.
REASON=
For force complete, restart, and cancel events, if a reason was supplied for the
action an additional line is displayed containing the reason text.
2.125 LRMD
Use the LRMD command to list reminder (prompting) information from the CA-7 pre-
process queue. Such information is first defined into an active area using the CA-7
editor, and scheduled for display at a workstation with the REMIND command. A free-
form message can be defined to communicate anything to a workstation at a predeter-
mined time. The workstation operator is prompted, repeatedly if necessary, to review the
defined text. See 2.152, “REMIND” on page 2-468 for a discussion of how to schedule
these free-form messages.
2.125.1 Syntax
LRMD
──LRMD──┬──────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬────────────
│ ┌─M─────────┐ │ │ ┌─NATV─┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘ └─,SEQ=─┼─CA7──┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤ ├─DLTM─┤
└─jobnumber─┘ ├─DOTM─┤
├─JOB──┤
└─STA──┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬────────────────────
│ ┌─M────┐ │ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,ST=─┴─LATE─┴──┘ └─,STN=─┼─station──┼──┘
└─station#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which information is to be selected.
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
SEQ
Controls the display sequence of the remind messages.
Default: NATV
Required: No
NATV
Native sequence (the order in which it is in the queue).
CA7
CA-7 assigned number sequence.
DLTM
Deadline time sequence.
DOTM
Due-out time sequence.
JOB
Job name sequence.
STA
Station name sequence.
ST
Specifies the display criteria of the remind messages.
Default: *
Required: No
*
All of the reminder text.
LATE
Only the late reminder text.
STN
Specifies the station name(s) for which information is to be selected.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all stations.
station
Indicates a specific station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
station*
Indicates a generic station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
2.125.2 Examples
LRMD
LRMD,ST=LATE,STATION=KEYPUNCH
LRMD,JOB=RMD#3334
LRMD,ST=LATE,SEQ=STA
LRMD Screen
< LRMD
=
LIST=JCL DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
M
M DON'T FORGET !!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
M
M THERE WILL BE A MEETING JULY 13, 2333 AT 13:33 AM,
M IN THE 5TH FLOOR CONFERENCE ROOM,
M TO REVIEW THE DISASTER CONTINGENCY PLAN FOR THE DATA CENTER.
M
M ALL COMPUTER OPERATIONS DEPT. SUPERVISORY PERSONNEL MUST ATTEND.
M
2.126 LSCHD
Use the LSCHD command to list schedule information from the database for jobs or net-
works. You can limit this display to certain systems or stations. You can review sched-
ules for networks and stations as well as processing calendars for input networks.
Information provided includes scheduling parameters, variations by schedule ID, and
month-by-month calendars.
2.126.1 Syntax
LSCHD
──LSCHD──,──┬─DSNBR=─┬─Sxnnnnnn───┬──┬──┬────────────────────┬───
│ ├─Sx%%nnnnn#─┤ │ └─,LIST=─┬─BYSID──┬──┘
│ └─Sx#────────┘ │ ├─CALS───┤
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ ├─SCHD───┤
├─JOB=─┼─jobname──┼──────┤ └─SIDnnn─┘
│ └─jobname#─┘ │
├─NW=network─────────────┤
│ ┌─M───────┐ │
└─STN=─┴─station─┴───────┘
──┬──────────┬──┬───────────────┬──┬────────────────────────┬────
└─,SCAL=xx─┘ └─,ST=─┬─EXP─┬──┘ │ ┌─M───────────┐ │
├─JAN─┤ └─,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼──┘
├─JUL─┤ └─systemname#─┘
├─MOD─┤
└─NRV─┘
Where:
DSNBR
Specifies a single or generic database schedule member number.
Required: Yes, unless NW, JOB, STN, or SYS is used
Sxnnnnnn
Specifies a single database member number.
x
Is either I, J, or O for input workstation network, CPU job, and output work-
station network schedules, respectively.
nnnnnn
Is a database schedule member number assigned by CA-7. Leading zeros
may be omitted.
Sx00nnnnn*
Is a generic schedule database member number. Leading zeros may not be
omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 numeric characters terminated with an asterisk
Sx*
Causes listing of all schedule members. You can list all members of a specific
schedule type by using one of the following:
DSNBR=SI*
All input network schedule members are listed.
DSNBR=SJ*
All job schedule members are listed.
DSNBR=SO*
All output network schedule members are listed.
JOB
Specifies the jobs whose schedule members are to be listed. JOB may be used with
SYS. It is recommended that online LSCHD commands limit the number of jobs
displayed.
Default: *
Required: Yes, unless DSNBR, NW, or STN is used
*
Indicates all job schedules.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
NW
Specifies the network(s) whose schedule members are to be listed. If DSNBR, JOB,
or SYS is used, both NW and STN must be omitted.
Required: Yes, unless DSNBR, JOB, STN, or SYS is used
STN
Specifies the station(s) within a network whose schedule members are to be listed.
The information displayed depends on the value of STN keyword. Otherwise, infor-
mation pertaining only to the station name specified is displayed. STN must be
omitted if DSNBR, JOB, or SYS is specified.
Default: *
Required: Yes, unless DSNBR, JOB, NW, or SYS is used
*
Indicates all stations.
station
Indicates a specific station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
LIST
Specifies list options for the schedule data to be printed. If omitted, only information
used to define selected schedule(s) is displayed. If a generic DSNBR is coded, LIST
is invalid. For schedule members that have not been resolved, no schedule day cal-
endars are available for display. This keyword is mutually exclusive with ST.
Required: No
BYSID
A month-by-month schedule day calendar for each schedule ID in the selected
members. Valid only for RESOLVed schedules.
CALS
A month-by-month schedule day calendar using the schedule data selected. This
is a composite calendar reflecting all selected schedule IDs. If used with JOB=*,
the display could be very lengthy. A batch terminal should be used for this
combination. Valid only for RESOLVed schedules.
Note: Output workstation network schedule members do not have composite
calendars. Therefore, no calendar is printed for output workstation
network schedules.
SCHD
All schedules. Where jobs are involved (through keywords JOB, SYS or
DSNBR=SJnnnnnn) information about all the jobs and/or data sets that trigger
the job under consideration is listed as well as all jobs triggered by the job under
consideration.
SIDnnn
A month-by-month schedule day calendar for one schedule ID specified by the
nnn value (leading zeros are required). Valid only for RESOLVed schedules.
SCAL
Designates a specific base calendar identifier. Used for selecting only schedules that
reference this calendar.
ST
Specifies a type of schedule to be selected. Primarily for generic requests. If
omitted, all types are listed according to other selection criteria. This keyword is
mutually exclusive with LIST.
Required: No
EXP
Schedules which have expired.
JAN
January through December schedules.
JUL
July through June schedules.
MOD
Schedules which have been changed through DB.2.7 screen.
NRV
Schedules which have never been resolved.
SYS
Specifies an application system name as defined on the DB.1 screen for each job, for
which the display is desired. If JOB is also used, only those jobs meeting both the
JOB and SYS criteria are displayed. (The SYS=systemname parameter is not valid
when a specific job name is specified.)
Default: All systems
Required: No
*
Indicates all application system names.
systemname
Indicates a specific application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
systemname*
Indicates a generic application system name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters, terminated with an asterisk
2.126.2 Examples
LSCHD,DSNBR=SJ13,LIST=CALS
LSCHD,DSNBR=SOM
LSCHD,LIST=CALS,NW=M
LSCHD,NW=JOBNET6
LSCHD,NW=JOBNETA,STN=STATION
LSCHD,JOB=CA7JOB1,LIST=BYSID
The COMMENTS field on the display always contains values similar to the ST options,
even if ST was not requested, to indicate type of schedule and its current status.
LSCHD,JOB=DUSAXX01,LIST=BYSID Screen
< LSCHD,JOB=DUSAXX31,LIST=BYSID
=
LIST=BYSID JOB=DUSAXX31 DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
PROS NUM
The DSNBR assigned to the documentation for this job.
COMMENTS
Under this heading one of the following may appear:
SCHED NEEDS RESOLUTION
The schedule has been changed through the DB.2.1-E screen
and SAVEd to the database but not RESOLVed.
SCHEDULE IS EXPIRED
The schedule needs to be reRESOLVed because it has been
over a year since the last RESOLV.
JANUARY SCHEDULE JULY SCHEDULE
A schedule RESOLVed between January 1 and June 30 has a
January (JAN) schedule, and one RESOLVed between July 1
and December 31 has a July (JUL) schedule.
SCHDMOD CURRENT
The schedule member has been updated through the
SCHDMOD screen.
SCHDMOD OVERLAID
The schedule member had received a modification through
the DB.2.7 screen, and a top line RESOLV command was
issued that caused the schedule to revert to the original
schedule information.
SCHED BEG mmm yy
The schedule will begin in the month mmm (JAN or JUL) of
the year yy.
LSCHD,NW=INPUTNWK,LIST=BYSID Screen
< LSCHD,NW=INPUTNWK,LIST=BYSID
=
LIST=BYSID NW=INPUTNWK DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
COMMENTS
Under this heading one of the following may appear.
SCHED NEEDS RESOLUTION
The schedule has been changed through the DB.2.1-E screen and
SAVEd to the database but not RESOLVed.
SCHEDULE IS EXPIRED
The schedule needs to be reRESOLVed because it has been over a year
since the last RESOLV.
JANUARY SCHEDULE JULY SCHEDULE
A schedule RESOLVed between January 1 and June 30 has a January
(JAN) schedule, and one RESOLVed between July 1 and December 31
has a July (JUL) schedule.
DB.2.7 CURRENT
The schedule member has been updated through the DB.2.7 screen.
DB.2.7 OVERLAID
The schedule member had received a modification through the DB.2.7
screen, and a top line RESOLV command was issued that caused the
schedule to revert to the original schedule information.
SCHED BEG mmm yy
The schedule will begin in the month mmm (JAN or JUL) of the year
yy.
< LSCHD,DSNBR=SJM
=
LIST=DSNBR=SJM DATE=YY.DDD PAGE 3331
2.127 LSYS
Use the LSYS command to list database information for all jobs defined in a specific
application system. This includes input/output data set cross references for each job. The
information is similar to that included with the LJOB command. It allows you to review
all jobs within an application system with just one command.
2.127.1 Syntax
LSYS
──LSYS──,──┬─SYS=system──┬──┬──────────────┬────────────────────
└─JOB=jobname─┘ └─,LIST=option─┘
Where:
SYS
Identifies an application system for which information is to be listed. The value is a
specific application system name. If SYS is specified, JOB must be omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, unless JOB is used
JOB
Identifies a particular job name for which information is to be listed. If JOB is
specified, SYS must be omitted.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, unless SYS is used
LIST
Specifies list options for the information to be printed. If LIST is not specified, a
single line describing each job is output.
Required: No
ALL
Jobs, schedules, steps, and data set dependencies for the application system spec-
ified.
DEP
Jobs, steps, and data set dependencies for the application system(s) specified.
This is the default for the JOB option.
JOBS
Job data only for jobs in the application system(s) specified.
SCHD
Jobs within the application system(s) specified along with their schedule(s).
2.127.2 Examples
LSYS,SYS=CA7JOBS
LSYS,SYS=CA7JOBS,LIST=JOBS
LSYS,SYS=CA7JOBS,LIST=SCHD
< LSYS,SYS=TESTNTWK
=
SYS=TESTNTWK DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
JOB ----JCL---- SYSTEM USR MAIN PROSE SCHED --NUMBER OF- LAST-RUN
NAME ID MEMBER -NAME- -ID -ID- DSNBR DSNBR STP DDS RUNS DATE/TIME
CUSAXX31 333 DUSAXX31 TESTNTWK 333 ALL MNONEM MNONEM 333 333 3333 33333/3333
DUSAXX32 333 DUSAXX32 TESTNTWK 333 /SY2 333312 MNONEM 331 334 3118 33126/1331
DUSAXX33 333 DUSAXX33 TESTNTWK 333 /SY1 333311 MNONEM 331 334 3112 33126/1333
DUSAXX34 333 DUSAXX34 TESTNTWK 333 ALL 333313 MNONEM 331 334 3133 33126/1331
DUSAXX35 333 DUSAXX35 TESTNTWK 333 ALL 333331 MNONEM 332 338 3393 33126/1331
DUSAXX36 333 DUSAXX36 TESTNTWK 333 ALL 333332 MNONEM 331 336 3382 33126/1332
K L
JOB NAME
The name defined in the database for this job.
JCL ID
The index of the data set (defined in the initialization file, JCL statement) where
this member resides.
JCL MEMBER
The member name of the JCL that this job executes.
SYSTEM NAME
The value from the SYSTEM field on the DB.1 screen.
USR ID
The value from the UID field on the DB.1 screen.
MAINID
The value from the MAINID field on the DB.1 screen.
PROSE DSNBR
The CA-7 generated DSNBR for the job documentation defined for this job.
SCHED DSNBR
The CA-7 generated DSNBR for the schedule member defined for this job.
NUMBER OF STP
The number of steps executed within this job.
NUMBER OF DDS
The number of DDs referenced by this job.
NUMBER OF RUNS
The number of times this job has successfully executed under CA-7.
LAST-RUN DATE/TIME
The last time (start time) that the job ran successfully under CA-7.
2.128 LWLB
Use the LWLB command to list currently active workload balancing processing objective
information. If the resource criteria have been loaded by the CA-7 system, then actual or
in-use values are displayed. Default Resource Balancing criteria are displayed following
CA-7 cold type of startups and until any user-defined criteria are loaded. Display options
are provided that permit the review of available and/or in-use workload balancing values,
as well as definitions which are on the database but not currently in use.
2.128.1 Syntax
LWLB
──LWLB──┬──────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬───────────────────
└─,MOD=modname─┘ │ ┌─ALL─┐ │
└─,LIST=─┼─AVL─┼──┘
└─USE─┘
Where:
MOD
Identifies the module whose processing objective criteria are to be listed. The value
may be specified as a single module name. If MOD is not specified, the default
processing objective criteria are of the module presently in effect.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters beginning with UCC7R
Required: No
LIST
Specifies the balancing criteria to be listed.
Default: ALL
Required: No
ALL
Processing objective criteria and the values that are currently being used.
AVL
Processing objective criteria values from the current UCC7R module.
USE
Values that are currently being used.
2.128.2 Examples
LWLB
LWLB,MOD=UCC7R133
LWLB,MOD=UCC7R133,LIST=USE
LWLB,LIST=ALL
< LWLB
=
MOD=UCC7R133 DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3331
-----------------------------------JOB CLASS----------------------------------
A 333 D 333 G 333 J 333 M 333 P 333 S 333 V 333 Y 333 1 333 4 333 7 333
B 333 E 333 H 333 K 333 N 333 Q 333 T 333 W 333 Z 333 2 333 5 333 8 333
C 333 F 333 I 333 L 333 O 333 R 333 U 333 X 333 3 333 3 333 6 333 9 333
K L
INITIATORS
Total number of jobs submitted to JES by CA-7 and therefore the number of initi-
ators which should be in use by CA-7 submitted jobs.
TAPE DRIVES
For each type of tape drive, the sum of the numbers from the DB.1 screen for the
jobs which CA-7 has submitted to JES.
CPU UTILIZATION
Average CPU use of the CA-7 submitted jobs.
JOB CLASS
Number of jobs submitted by CA-7 in each of the 36 job classes as entered on the
DB.1 screen.
< LWLB
=
MOD=UCC7R133,LAST CHG-DATE 35/12/33 DATE YY.DDD PAGE 3332
-----------------------------------JOB CLASS-----------------------------------
A 334 D 335 G 331 J 331 M 331 P 331 S 331 V 331 Y 331 1 333 4 333 7 333
B 334 E 331 H 331 K 331 N 331 Q 331 T 331 W 331 Z 331 2 333 5 333 8 333
C 332 F 331 I 331 L 331 O 331 R 331 U 331 X 331 3 331 3 333 6 333 9 333
--TAPE DRIVES--
Tape drive statistics.
NAME
Type of tape drive.
TOT NUMBER AVAILABLE
Total number of actual tape drives available to CA-7.
TOT MAX ALLOWABLE
Maximum number of tape drives that CA-7 controlled jobs may use at any point in
time.
MAX DTS BOOST
Maximum number of priority points to be added to a job's DB.1 (Job) screen pri-
ority in the ready queue if you have defined MIN/MAX DIFF-TO-SCHED jobs in
terms of tape drive usage.
MAX REWARD/PENALTY
Maximum number of priority points that can be earned and the maximum number
of priority points that can be lost by a job in the ready queue because it uses tape
drives.
MIN/MAX DIFF-TO-SCHED
Minimum and maximum number of tape drives that a job must allocate at one time
for that job to be considered difficult to schedule.
MIN/MAX ALLOWABLE/JOB
Minimum and maximum number of tape drives that a job must allocate at one time
to be submitted to run.
--START TIME--
Time statistics.
MAX REWARD
Maximum number of priority points a job can be awarded for being late.
MAX PENALTY
Maximum number of priority points a job can be penalized for being early.
MAX HOURS EARLY
Number of hours early over which the maximum penalty is given.
MAX HOURS LATE
Number of hours late over which the maximum award is given.
RUN TIME FACTOR
A buffer (stated as a percentage) where a job is neither early or late.
--JOB CLASS--
For each of 36 possible scheduling job classes, the maximum number of jobs of
that class that CA-7 may run concurrently. A value of 255 indicates there is not a
limit.
2.129 MAP
Use the MAP command to list the attributes of DASD data sets. This function is avail-
able on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 15 or any other menu or formatted
screen as FUNCTION value UT.15.
2.129.1 Syntax
MAP
──MAP──,DSN=dsname──┬─────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬────────
└─,VOL=volume─┘ │ ┌─DSN─┐ │
└─,LIST=─┴─ALL─┴──┘
Where:
DSN
Identifies the data set to be mapped. The name may be a fully qualified name or a
generic request. The latter is indicated with an asterisk (*) following the last signif-
icant character. (VOL is required for a generic request.) A relative generation
request may be made for a cataloged generation data set if the VOL parameter is
omitted. DSN=* lists all data sets on a volume.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates the volume on which the data set resides.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes - unless a request is made for a fully qualified, cataloged data
set name
LIST
Indicates the type of data to be listed.
Default: DSN
Required: No
DSN
Lists the dsname, number of extents, tracks allocated, tracks used, secondary
allocation quantity, DSORG, record format (RECFM), logical record length
(LRECL), and block size (BLKSIZE).
ALL
In addition to information noted under DSN above, lists the creation date, expira-
tion date, absolute DASD address, type allocation, option code (OPTCD), key
length, key position, password indicators, and unmovable indicators.
There must be a U7volser DD statement in CA-7 execution JCL for the volume con-
taining the data set being mapped or the allocation values are zeros.
2.129.3 Examples
MAP,DSN=SYS1.PROCLIB
MAP,DSN=USER.FILE,VOL=VOLMO1,LIST=ALL
MAP,DSN=SYS1M,VOL=SYSRES
MAP,DSN=USER.INDX1,VOL=VOLMO2,LIST=ALL
MAP,DSN=USER.GDG(-1),LIST=ALL
2.130 MENU
Use the top line MENU command at any time to transfer to the CA-7 Function Menu.
MENU
──MENU──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
< =
---------------------------- CA-7 FUNCTION MENU ------------------------------
FUNCTION ===>
HELP - TUTORIAL
K L
2.131 NOPRMP
Use the NOPRMP top line command to suspend reminder prompting for particular jobs.
Unlike RSVP, which is for a single job, this command is used to suspend all prompting.
NOPRMP can be directed at specific jobs, or all jobs in the queues. This function is
available for CPU jobs through the QM.3 screen. Workstation networks must use the
NOPRMP command.
2.131.1 Syntax
NOPRMP
──NOPRMP──,──┬─JOB=─┬─nnnn─┬──┬─────────────────────────────────
│ ├─ALL──┤ │
│ └─ALLP─┘ │
└─REF=nnnnrrs────┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) for which prompting is to be suspended.
Required: Yes, unless REF is used
nnnn
Indicates the CA-7 job number of a specific job.
ALL
Indicates all jobs in the request, ready, and postprocess queues.
ALLP
Indicates all jobs including those in the preprocess queue.
REF
Specifies a particular workstation network task (and all subsequent workstation tasks
for that network) for which prompting is to be suspended. The LPRE or LPOST
commands display reference numbers.
Required: Yes, unless JOB is used
nnnnrrs
Is the workstation task reference number assigned by CA-7.
nnnn
CA-7 job number.
rr
Relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associated
with the job. For input workstation networks, the value is 00. Leading
zeros may not be omitted.
s
Relative position of the station within the network. The first station is posi-
tion 1.
You may also use the XUPD screen to suppress prompts for a selected job.
2.131.3 Examples
NOPRMP,JOB=17
NOPRMP,JOB=ALL
NOPRMP,REF=1832321
2.132 NXTCYC
Use the NXTCYC top line command to bypass one or more normally scheduled proc-
essing cycles of a CPU job. This bypass may be for a single cycle or for all subsequent
cycles until further notice is provided with another option of the command.
The next time the job is scheduled to run, a message is written to the CA-7 master station
indicating it was not scheduled. See the CA-7 Message Guide for an explanation of these
messages.
2.132.1 Syntax
NXTCYC
──NXTCYC──,JOB=jobname──,SET=─┬─OFF─┬───────────────────────────
├─ON──┤
└─SKP─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job for which scheduling is to be altered. The option must be a job
name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
SET
Indicates which of the options for skipping processing cycles is to be used.
Required: Yes
OFF
Causes all regularly scheduled processing cycles to be skipped, and is so indi-
cated on LJOB and LLOCK displays, until the scheduling indicator is again reset
(SET=ON). When SET=OFF is used to bypass scheduling indefinitely, SET=ON
must be entered to reinstate normal scheduling activity. SET=OFF indicates jobs
that have been specified on a job forecast.
ON
Reinstates normal scheduling previously altered by a SET=SKP or SET=OFF
command. SET=ON may be used to reinstate scheduling before one cycle is
skipped (where SET=SKP has been used).
SKP
Causes only the next regularly scheduled processing cycle to be skipped.
SET=SKP can be used to skip a processing cycle for a job which was demanded
to run ahead of schedule. If SET=SKP is used, the schedule indicator automat-
ically resets to restore normal scheduling activity when one cycle has been
skipped. Jobs with SET=SKP specified appear on forecast screen displays and
are indicated on LJOB and LLOCK displays.
An option to skip the next processing cycle is also available with the DEMAND
command.
2.132.3 Examples
NXTCYC,JOB=CA7JOB1,SET=SKP
NXTCYC,JOB=CA7JOB2,SET=OFF
NXTCYC,JOB=CA7JOB2,SET=ON
2.133 OUT
Use the OUT top line command to indicate the completion of a workstation task. The
OUT command, used after an IN command, uses a reference number for identifying each
station. The reference number is generated by CA-7 each time the network enters the
queue. This number may be obtained by doing an LPRE or LPOST command. This
function is available as the O option on the QM.6 and QM.7 screens.
2.133.1 Syntax
OUT
──OUT──,REF=─┬─nnnnrrs───────┬──────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─,─────┐ │
!nnnnrrs┴─)─┘
└─(──
Where:
REF
Identifies the workstation network task(s) to be logged out.
Required: Yes
nnnnrrs
Identifies a single workstation reference number.
Note: Reference numbers may be obtained by using the LPRE or LPOST com-
mands.
nnnn
CA-7 job number. Leading zeros may be omitted.
rr
Relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associated
with the job. For input workstation networks, the value is 00. Leading
zeros may not be omitted.
s
Relative position of the station within the network. The first station is posi-
tion 1.
(nnnnrrs,...,nnnnrrs)
Identifies up to 10 reference numbers. Must be enclosed in parentheses.
The XPRE, XPOST, XSPRE, and XSPOST online formatted screens may be used when
working with 3270 terminals.
Following is a possible OUT command remark in addition to those discussed under the
IN command in 2.87.2, “IO Command Response” on page 2-212. This appears on the
screen under the heading REMARKS.
NOT LOGGED IN
Explanation: The station identified by the reference number has not been logged in.
User Response: Determine why the station has not been logged in. If the missing login was an
oversight, log the station IN and reenter the OUT request, or use the IO command to log in and log
out together.
2.133.3 Examples
OUT,REF=3311311
Logout workstation 0011011 referenced by CA-7 job 0011, network sequence 01 and
station position 1.
OUT,REF=113311
Same as above, only leading zeros of job number have been omitted.
2.134 POST
Use the POST command to indicate to the CA-7 system that a preexecution requirement
for a job in the request queue has been satisfied. Two categories of requirements may be
satisfied, internal and external. Internal requirements are known within the CA-7 data-
base and controlled by CA-7. An example of an internal requirement would be the com-
pletion of another job controlled by CA-7 whose completion satisfies a requirement for a
dependent job. External requirements are defined in the CA-7 database but not controlled
by CA-7. External requirements must be satisfied by a manual post unless the require-
ment is cataloged in the CA-7 catalog before the using job is scheduled into the request
queue. This function is available through the 2.145, “QM.2 CPU Job Predecessors
Prompt Screen” on page 2-438.
2.134.1 Syntax
POST
──POST──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬──────────────────────────────────────
└─jobnumber─┘
──,─┬─NW=network─────────────────────────────────┬───────────────
├─USR=text───────────────────────────────────┤
├─DEPJOB=jobname─────────────────────────────┤
└─DSN=dataset─┬───────────────────────────┬──┘
└─,─┬─INTERNAL=YES───────┬──┘
│ ┌─,─────┐ │
!numbers┴─)─┘
└─PREQ=(──
Where:
JOB
Indicates the unique CA-7 job name in up to 8 characters, or the job number in up to
4 digits, for which requirements are to be posted. If job name is used and multiple
jobs with the same name are found in the request queue, the POST is rejected and an
error message is issued. The POST command must then be reentered using the CA-7
job number.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
NW
Identifies an input workstation network requirement to be posted as satisfied. Mutu-
ally exclusive with DEPJOB, DSN, and USR. In normal situations, this type of
requirement is posted automatically by CA-7 when the network is logged complete
with a LOGOUT, OUT, or IO command to the last workstation within this input
network.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
USR
Identifies a user-defined description of a requirement to be posted as satisfied. Mutu-
ally exclusive with DEPJOB, DSN, and NW. When used, must match the text used
to define the requirement on the DB.6 screen or with the ADDRQ command.
Note: If the user requirement text contains quotes, parentheses or commas, it cannot
be satisfied with the POST command. It must be posted online with the
QM.2 screen.
Size/Type: 1 to 36 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
DEPJOB
Identifies a predecessor job dependency requirement to be posted as satisfied. Value
must be a specific job name. Mutually exclusive with DSN, NW, and USR. In
normal situations, this type of requirement is posted automatically by CA-7 when the
predecessor job completes its execution successfully. Manual posting would only be
necessary if a job defined as a requirement was not to be run, or ran unsuccessfully
and a successor job is to be run.
The DEPJOB must be posted if it is not currently defined to CA-7 (an external job).
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
DSN
Identifies a data set requirement to be posted as satisfied. Value may be a specific
data set name or a CA-7 data set number. If using a number, only the number may
be specified without the DS prefix. Mutually exclusive with DEPJOB, NW, and
USR.
dsname
Indicates a specific data set name.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
dsnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 data set number.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 numeric characters
INTERNAL
Valid only in combination with DSN to indicate when the data set being posted is
internal to the CA-7 workload. YES is the only acceptable value. Mutually exclu-
sive with NW, USR, DEPJOB, and PREQ. In normal situations, requirements for
internal data sets are posted automatically by CA-7.
Required: No
PREQ
Valid only in combination with DSN to identify up to 11 numeric values to be
included with other CA-7 log data logged as a result of the POST command being
issued. Mutually exclusive with NW, USR, DEPJOB, and INTERNAL. Value(s)
must be coded in sublist form, within parentheses. Up to 11 values separated by
commas may be coded between the parentheses. Each value cannot exceed 4
numeric digits. This optional field can be useful for logging any meaningful
numbers, such as batch numbers, and so forth, which can later be reviewed in the log
data set.
Required: No
If the completion of a requirement is not noted in the CA-7 database, requirements must
be satisfied by a manual POST after the using job is scheduled into the request queue.
When dependencies and requirements for resources and other CA-7 jobs or networks have
been defined in the database, CA-7 handles satisfaction automatically upon the com-
pletion of the requirement.
Manual posting of any requirement is not possible until the using job is in the request
queue.
2.134.3 Examples
For internal data set requirements
POST,JOB=163,DSN=CA7.DSN1,INTERNAL=YES
POST,JOB=12,DSN=15,INTERNAL=YES
POST,JOB=CA7JOB1,DSN=CA7.DSN1,INTERNAL=YES
POST,JOB=163,DSN=CA7.EXTRNL.DSN1
POST,JOB=12,DSN=15
POST,JOB=CA7JOB1,DSN=CA7.BATCH.INPUT1,PREQ=(17,19,23,32)
POST,JOB=CA7JOB3,DEPJOB=CA7JOB1
POST,JOB=19,DEPJOB=CA7JOB1
POST,JOB=CA7JOB3,NW=PAYNTWK
POST,JOB=193,NW=CA7JOB2
2.135 PRINT
Use the PRINT command to produce a month-by-month listing of indicated base calen-
dars. PRINT produces output that reflects the beginning and ending days of each month,
holidays, or any other nonprocessing days that were defined when the calendar was
produced.
2.135.1 Syntax
PRINT
──PRINT──,SCAL=xx──┬──────────┬─────────────────────────────────
└─,YEAR=yy─┘
Where:
SCAL
Used to specify the user-supplied unique characters that identify the base calendar to
be printed. Value is the 2 unique characters used during initial creation of the cal-
endar. These characters provide the xx portion of the base calendar name,
SCALyyxx.
Size/Type: 2 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
YEAR
Used to specify the year of the base calendar to be printed. Value is the last 2 digits
of the base calendar year (00 = 2000). It also provides the yy portion of the base
calendar name, SCALyyxx. This must be the same year specified when the calendar
was initially created.
Size/Type: 2 numeric characters
Default: Current year
Required: No
2.135.3 Example
PRINT,YEAR=33,SCAL=5D
The following figure presents a portion of the output from a PRINT command for a base
calendar with a holiday list.
129+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
133+M,MM MM
131+M,MM CA-7 BASE CALENDAR SCAL99WD MM
132+M,MM FOR YEAR 1999 MM
133+M,MM DATE 98364 MM
134+M,MM MM
135+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
137+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
138+M,MM MM
139+M,MM MONTH 1 JAN MM
143+M,MM MM
141+M,MM SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT MM
142+M,MM MM
143+M,MM (B1) MM
144+M,MM 4 5 6 7 8 MM
145+M,MM 11 12 13 14 15 MM
146+M,MM 18 19 23 21 22 MM
147+M,MM 25 26 27 28 29 MM
148+M,MM (E1) MM
149+M,MM MM
153+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
152+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
153+M,MM MM
154+M,MM MONTH 2 FEB MM
155+M,MM MM
156+M,MM SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT MM
157+M,MM MM
158+M,MM (B2) 2 3 4 5 MM
159+M,MM 8 9 13 11 12 MM
163+M,MM 15 16 17 18 19 MM
161+M,MM 22 23 24 25 26 MM
162+M,MM (E2) MM
163+M,MM MM
164+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
166+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
167+M,MM MM
168+M,MM MONTH 3 MAR MM
169+M,MM MM
173+M,MM SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT MM
171+M,MM MM
172+M,MM (B3) 2 3 4 5 MM
173+M,MM 8 9 13 11 12 MM
174+M,MM 15 16 17 18 19 MM
175+M,MM 22 23 24 25 26 MM
176+M,MM 29 33 (E3) MM
177+M,MM MM
178+M,MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
2.136 PRMP
Use the PRMP top line command to reinstate prompting after a previous NOPRMP
command suspended it. PRMP may be used for an individual network, more than one
network, or an entire queue. This function is available for CPU jobs through the 2.146,
“QM.3 CPU Job Attributes Prompt Screen” on page 2-442. Workstation networks must
use the PRMP command.
2.136.1 Syntax
PRMP
──PRMP──,──┬─JOB=─┬─nnnn─┬──┬───────────────────────────────────
│ ├─ALL──┤ │
│ └─ALLP─┘ │
└─REF=nnnnrrs────┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) for which prompting is to be reinstated.
Required: Yes, unless REF is used (in which case JOB must be omitted)
nnnn
Indicates CA-7 job number.
ALL
Indicates all jobs in the request, ready, and postprocess queues.
ALLP
Indicates all jobs including those in the preprocess queue.
REF
Specifies a particular workstation network task (and all subsequent workstation tasks
for that network) for which prompting is to be reinstated. Reference numbers can be
obtained by using the LPRE or LPOST commands.
Required: Yes, unless JOB is used (in which case REF must be omitted)
nnnnrrs
Is the workstation task reference number assigned by CA-7.
nnnn
CA-7 job number.
rr
Relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associated
with the job. For input workstation networks, the value is 00. Leading
zeros may not be omitted.
s
Relative position of the station within the network. The first station is posi-
tion 1.
When PRMP is used with a reference number, all subsequent stations are affected.
2.136.3 Examples
PRMP,JOB=17
PRMP,JOB=ALL
PRMP,REF=1832322
2.137 PRRNJCL
Use this command to list and optionally delete JCL for all jobs in the prior-run queue that
have JCL retained.
2.137.1 Syntax
PRRNJCL
──PRRNJCL──┬───────────────────┬────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─NO──┐ │
└─,UPDATE=─┴─YES─┴──┘
Where:
UPDATE
Specifies whether JCL for the prior-run queue entries listed is to be deleted to release
that space.
Default: NO
Required: No
NO
Specifies that the prior-run queue entries with JCL retained be listed only.
YES
Specifies JCL is to be deleted in addition to entries being listed.
2.137.2 Examples
< PRRNJCL =
DATE=yy.ddd CA-7 PRIOR-RUN JCL ANALYZE REPORT PAGE NO. 3334
2.138 PRSCF
Use the PRSCF command to free a shared, exclusive, or RCT resource connected to a job
which:
is currently executing
is in ABEND status in the request queue
has already executed and purged from the request queue
2.138.1 Syntax
PRSCF
──PRSCF──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬───,RSRC=resource──┬────────────┬───
└─jobnumber─┘ └─,FORCE=YES─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the name or CA-7 number of the job to which the resource is attached.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes
RSRC
Specifies the fully qualified resource name to free. You may optionally specify * to
indicate all resources connected to the job are to be freed.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
FORCE
FORCE=YES indicates that CA-7 is not to evaluate the availability of the named
resource(s) for this run of the job only. The named resource(s) are NOT used by this
run of the job. This keyword may be used on an exception basis to allow a job in
W-RSRC status to bypass VRM checking for one or more resources defined for it on
the RM.1 screen.
Required: No
2.138.2 Example
< PRSRF,RSRC=RESOURCE.TYPE2.EXEC,JOB=TESTJOBB =
SPOR-35 PRSRCF SUCCESSFUL
RESOURCE : RESOUCE.TYPE2.EXEC
FREED FOR JOB : TESTJOBB
2.139 PRSQA
Use the PRSQA command to activate a corequisite resource. When a job is connected to
a corequisite resource and the resource usage type is N or active, the corequisite resource
must be activated using the PRSQA command.
2.139.1 Syntax
PRSQA
──PRSQA──,RSRC=resource─────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
RSRC
Specifies a fully qualified corequisite resource name.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.139.2 Example
< PRSQA,RSRC=CICSREG8 =
SPOR-39 PRSQA SUCCESSFUL
ACTIVATED.
K L
2.140 PRSQD
2.140.1 Syntax
PRSQD
──PRSQD──,RSRC=resource─────────────────────────────────────────
Where:
RSRC
Specifies a fully qualified corequisite resource name.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
2.140.2 Example
< PRSQD,RSRC=CICSREG8 =
SPOR-37 PRSQD SUCCESSFUL
DEACTIVATED.
K L
2.141 PS
Use the PS command to display the Personal Scheduling screen. Enter PS as the FUNC-
TION value on any other menu or formatted input screen or as a top line command.
2.141.1 Syntax
PS
──PS────────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
See the CA-7 Personal Scheduling Reference Guide for a detailed discussion of this
command and its functions.
WHEN TO SCHEDULE:
PATTERN =>
TIME TO RUN => (3331-2433)
2.142 QJCL
Use the QJCL command to either review JCL for jobs in the request or prior-run queues,
or to modify JCL for jobs in the request queue. Use this facility to make overrides to
JCL even if the override library or scheduled overrides are used. This facilty also accom-
plishes reusing JCL from jobs in the prior-run queue. This function is available on the
2.143, “QM” on page 2-428 as FUNCTION value 5 or on any other menu or formatted
screen as FUNCTION value QM.5.
2.142.1 Syntax
QJCL
──QJCL──,─┬─jobname───┬─────────────────────────────────────────
└─jobnumber─┘
Where:
jobname
Identifies the unique CA-7 job name of the job in the request queue whose JCL is to
be updated.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Identifies the unique CA-7 job number of the job in the request queue whose JCL is
to be updated.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
For additional information on overriding JCL, see the JCLOVRD command in this
chapter, and the JCL-OVRD and USE-OVRD-LIB fields on the DB.1 screen in the CA-7
Database Maintenance Guide. Also see the discussion of the "Edit Facilities" in the CA-7
Database Maintenance Guide.
JCL saved for jobs in the prior-run queue may also be brought into the active area and,
through a series of commands, be saved to a JCL library or stored for jobs in the request
queue to be used for the current execution of the job.
This command results in a screen being returned. See 2.148, “QM.5 Queued JCL
Screen” on page 2-451 for details on that screen.
2.143 QM
Use this screen to access fill-in-the-blank function screens for queue maintenance func-
tions.
< =
----------------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE MENU ------------------------
FUNCTION ===>
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
To select a formatted input screen, provide the appropriate number in the FUNCTION
field and press Enter. The selected screen then appears.
2.143.2 PF Keys
Once a function has been selected on the menu and the function screen is displayed,
program function key 3 (PF3) is temporarily set to return to the QM menu screen. In
native CA-7 VTAM mode, any value that was previously assigned to PF3, by either the
user or CA-7, is temporarily ignored as long as the function screen is being used and
reverts back to the original value after it is used once or after a top line command is
entered.
PF7 and PF8 are similarly temporarily overridden to /PAGE-1 and /PAGE+1 respectively
until PF3 is pressed or a top line command is issued.
Use this screen to list jobs from the queues for purposes of updating the status of the
jobs. There is no equivalent batch function.
< ------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOBS STATUS PROMPT -------------
=
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other screen in the FUNCTION field.
See 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
FILL FUNCTION
Same as FILL keyword parameter for top line command. When used,
the display has this value already entered in the F function field for all
jobs. Default is none. Allowable values are:
C Cancel the job. Depending on the initialization file CANCEL
statement value, a transfer to the REASON FOR CANCEL
screen may occur for each job given this value. See the
REASON FOR CANCEL screen for further discussion.
E Fetch queued JCL, transfer to the edit facility (similar to QM.5)
and return to this screen when finished there.
F Transfer to the CPU JOB IN RESTART STATUS screen (QM.4)
for this job and return to this screen when finished there.
H Put the job in hold status.
J Reverse the JCL override requirement: if there is one, satisfy it;
otherwise, establish one.
P Respond to a deadline prompt.
Q Requeue the job for a restart.
R Release the job from hold status.
S Satisfy a submit time requirement.
U Transfer to the CPU JOB ATTRIBUTES screen (QM.3) for this
job and return to this screen when finished there.
V Reverse VERIFY requirement: if there is one, satisfy it, other-
wise, establish one.
X Transfer to the CPU JOB PREDECESSORS screen (QM.2) for
this job and return to this screen when finished there.
< =
----------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOBS STATUS -----------------
F-JOBNAME--CA7#
BDTEST33 3331 JOB: M
BDTEST31 3332 SEQ: ENTRY
BDTEST32 3333 QUEUE: REQ
LIST: ALL
FUNCTIONS:
C=CANCEL
F=RESTART
H=HOLD
J=JCLOVRD
P=RSVP
Q=REQUEUE
R=RELEASE
S=SUBTM OFF
U=UPDATE
V=VERIFY
X=RQMT POST
E=EDIT QJCL
PROGRAM: QM23 MSG-INDX: 33 -- QM.1-X -- yy.ddd / hh:mm:ss
MESSAGE: ENTER FUNCTION IN 'F' FIELD OR ENTER A COMMAND ON THE TOP LINE
K L
2.144.2.1 Field Descriptions
F Function field
JOBNAME CA-7 job name
CA7# CA-7 job number
JOB: Job name selection criteria
SEQ: Display sequence
QUEUE: Queue that was searched: request, ready, or active
LIST: Display selection criteria
FUNCTIONS: Possible line functions
Job names and numbers are listed below their column heading. Up to four columns of up
to 18 jobs each may appear on each page. Up to 72 jobs per page may appear. Display
sequence and queue values are shown on the right just above a legend of available F
column function values.
To perform an update on any of the listed jobs, enter the desired value from the legend in
the F column just in front of the job you wish to update. Multiple jobs may be selected
before pressing Enter. (If a FILL FUNCTION value was entered on the QM.1 screen,
that value appears in this column for each entry.)
When requested functions are completed, the screen is returned with a message at the
bottom in the MESSAGE area. Functions that were performed without an error show an
* in the F field. Functions that encountered errors show ? in the F field. To simplify
correction of any errors, both * and ? are ignored for input. Only entries with other F
values are processed.
The display continues to reflect the queue status at the time of the initial request. It is
not refreshed after each update. After several updates, it may be desirable to repeat the
initial QM.1 function.
After an update is made, the scrolling capability is disabled. Repeat the initial QM.1
function to establish the scrolling capability.
< =
-------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOBS STATUS (RQMTS) --------------
F-JOBNAME---J--I--E--U--N-SHJV F-JOBNAME---J--I--E--U--N-SHJV
BDTEST31 . . . . . H XXTEST13 . . 1 . . J JOB: M
BDTEST32 1 . 1 2 . XXTEST11 . 1 . . . SEQ: JOBNAME
BDTEST33 . 2 . . . V XXTEST12 . . 1 . . QUEUE: REQ
BDTEST34 . . . . . MSKL LIST: ALL
BDTEST35 . . . . . S
BDTEST36 1 . . . . J FUNCTIONS:
BDTEST37 . . . . . C=CANCEL
BDTEST38 . . . . . S F=RESTART
BDTEST39 . . . . . V H=HOLD
XXTEST31 1 . . . . J=JCLOVRD
XXTEST32 . 3 . 2 . H P=RSVP
XXTEST33 . . 1 . . Q=REQUEUE
XXTEST34 . 1 . . . R=RELEASE
XXTEST35 . . . 1 . J S=SUBTM OFF
XXTEST36 1 . . . . U=UPDATE
XXTEST37 . 1 . . . S V=VERIFY
XXTEST38 2 . . . . X=RQMT POST
XXTEST39 . . 1 . . E=EDIT QJCL
PROGRAM: QM23 MSG-INDX: 33 -- QM.1-M -- yy.ddd / hh:mm:ss
MESSAGE: ENTER FUNCTION IN 'F' FIELD OR ENTER A COMMAND ON THE TOP LINE
K L
2.144.3.1 Field Descriptions
F Function name
JOBNAME CA-7 job name
J Number of outstanding job requirements
I Number of outstanding internal data set requirements
E Number of outstanding external data set requirements
U Number of outstanding user requirements
N Number of outstanding network requirements
The jobs are listed in job name sequence. Line functions can be issued for any job in the
same way as the QM.1-X screen. For security purposes, line functions entered on the
QM.1-M screen are considered to have come from the QM.1-X screen.
The outstanding requirements for each job listed are reflected to the right of the job
name. Categories that can have more than one requirement are two-digit numeric fields.
If the value is zero, a period is displayed. If the value exceeds 99, two asterisks are
displayed to represent an overflow situation (by using the Requirement Post line
command 'X', you can see the total master requirement count). Categories that are yes/no
situations (such as Hold) are represented by the appropriate character for yes or a period
for no.
It is displayed for each C function on the QM.1 screen but only if REASON=OPTIONAL
or REASON=REQUIRED is specified on the initialization file CANCEL statement.
< =
-------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - REASON FOR CANCEL ------------------
REASON:
(MAXIMUM OF 43 CHARACTERS)
K L
2.144.4.1 Field Descriptions
If the installation does not require a reason, pressing Enter without providing a reason
cancels the job without logging any descriptive text. If the installation requires a reason,
the cancellation does not occur until some text is provided. See the initialization file
CANCEL statement for further discussion of the installation's options for this screen.
CA-11 restart reasons are not expanded here like they are on the QM.4 screen for restarts.
Any value entered here is assumed to be descriptive text and is logged as entered.
Use this screen to list the predecessors of jobs and to allow posting those jobs as being
complete or not. No equivalent batch function exists.
< =
----------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOB PREDECESSORS PROMPT -----------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
2 as the FUNCTION on the QM screen.
QM.2 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted screen.
QM.2 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line XRQ command, this screen is returned for
ease of correction and reentry.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other screen in the FUNCTION field.
See 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
< =
-------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOB PREDECESSORS ---------------
JOB: D463XX33 CA-7#: 3332 MCNT: 334
F-TYP-NUMBER-E-DESCRIPTION
HLD JOB HELD IN REQUEST QUEUE
JOB A D463XX31
USR O SAMPLE NEXT-RUN ONLY PREDECESSOR
NWK 333338 D43218ED
K L
2.145.2.1 Field Descriptions
To post a predecessor complete, enter X in the F column in front of the appropriate line
and press Enter. To unsatisfy an already satisfied predecessor, change the existing X to
U.
This screen may also be displayed by the X function of the QM.1 screen.
If this screen was displayed as a result of entering an X on the QM.1 screen, you return
to that screen after any updates are done.
Use this screen to list the current attributes of a job and allow them to be changed. There
is no equivalent batch function.
< =
------------ CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOB ATTRIBUTES PROMPT ------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
3 as the FUNCTION on the QM screen.
QM.3 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted screen.
QM.3 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line XUPD command, this screen is returned for
ease of correction and reentry.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other screen in the FUNCTION field.
See 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
< =
--------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOB ATTRIBUTES ----------------
JOB: D463XX33 CA-7#: 3332 MCNT: 334 QUEUE: REQ
----------RESTART----------- ------------PROMPTING------------
GENERATE CA-11 STEP....... Y ELIGIBLE FOR PROMPTS... N
FORMAT CA-11 CMT.......... Y PROMPT ACKNOWLEDGED.... N
RETAIN JCL IN PRRN QUEUE.. Y LTERM FOR MESSAGES..... MASTER
----------------------------RESOURCES-----------------------------
JOB CLASS............. A JOB PRIORITY.......... 133
ELAPSED TIME (HHMM)... 3331 TAPE DRIVES OF TYPE1.. 334
CPU TIME (MMMSS)...... 33331 TAPE DRIVES OF TYPE2.. 333
DEADLINE TIME This value is composed of two fields in the format yyddd and
hhmm respectively, and is the date and time that a job must start
or the job is flagged as LATE.
DUE-OUT TIME This value is composed of two fields in the format yyddd and
hhmm respectively, and is the date and time that a job must com-
plete or the job is flagged as LATE.
SUBMIT TIME This value is composed of two fields in the format yyddd and
hhmm respectively. Null values indicate the job has no submit
time-of-day requirement. To establish a requirement, enter
appropriate data. To remove an existing submit time-of-day
requirement, set this value to precede the current date and time-
of-day.
MAINID This value should be of the form ALL, SYn, or /SYn. It indi-
cates to which CPU the job is submitted. (See MAINID on the
DB.1 screen for the job.) For example, SY1 means CPU #1 and
/SY1 means NOT CPU #1, as follows:
SYn CPU number to be used.
/SYn CPU number of CPU not to be used.
ALL Any CPU may be used. This field cannot be modified
after a job has been submitted.
JOB HELD This value is Y or N and indicates hold status. This applies only
to jobs in the request queue or the ready queue if not already
submitted to OS.
MANUAL VERIFICATION REQUIRED
This value is Y or N and indicates manual verification require-
ment status. This applies only to jobs in the request queue.
JCL OVERRIDES REQUIRED
This value is Y or N and indicates a JCL override verification
status. This applies only to jobs in the request queue.
GENERATE CA-11 STEP
This value is Y or N and identifies whether a CA-11 step should
be generated. This field cannot be modified after a job has been
submitted.
FORMAT CA-11 CMT
This value is Y or N and identifies if F processing is to be done
by the generated CA-11 step. This field cannot be modified after
a job has been submitted.
RETAIN JCL IN PRRN QUEUE
This value is Y or N and indicates whether the JCL is to be
retained in the PRRN queue. (See RETAIN-JCL on the DB.1
screen for the job.)
ELIGIBLE FOR PROMPTS
This value is Y or N and indicates if the job should be prompted
if late. (See PROMPTS on the DB.1 screen for the job.)
PROMPT ACKNOWLEDGED
This value is Y or N and indicates if a late prompt has been
acknowledged. Any attempt to acknowledge a prompt when one
has not been received is ignored.
LTERM FOR MESSAGES
This field identifies the logical terminal to receive status and
prompting messages for this job. (See LTERM on the DB.1
screen for the job.) Value is a maximum of 8 characters.
JOB CLASS The value is any single alphanumeric character. It indicates the
CA-7 job class. (See CLASS on the DB.1 screen for the job.)
This field cannot be modified after a job has been submitted.
ELAPSED TIME This numeric field indicates the average elapsed time for the job
in hhmm format. The value is from 0 to 23 for hh and from 0 to
59 for mm. This field cannot be modified after a job has been
submitted.
CPU TIME This numeric field indicates the average CPU time use for the job
in mmmss format. The value is from 0 to 999 for mmm and
from 0 to 59 for ss. This applies only to jobs in the request
queue.
JOB PRIORITY This numeric field indicates the original CA-7 workload bal-
ancing current job priority. The value is from 0 to 255.
TAPE DRIVES OF TYPE 1
This numeric field indicates the number of tape drives of Type 1
needed for the job. The value is from 0 to 255.
TAPE DRIVES OF TYPE 2
This numeric field indicates the number of tape drives of Type 2
needed for the job. The value is from 0 to 255.
After all values have been entered, press Enter and the updates are made. A message
indicates what action was taken.
You may also display this screen using the U function of the QM.1 screen.
If this screen is displayed as a result of entering a U on the QM.1 screen, return is to that
screen after any updates are done.
Use this screen to list jobs and allow them to be restarted. The equivalent batch
command is RESTART.
< =
-------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOB IN RESTART STATUS PROMPT ---------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
4 as the FUNCTION on the QM screen.
QM.4 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted screen.
QM.4 as a top line command.
F as the function on the QM.1 screen.
If an error is encountered with a top line XRST command, this screen is returned for
ease of correction and reentry.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other screen in the FUNCTION field.
See 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
If CA-11 is available to assist with a restart, the screen returned is similar to this.
CA-11 Installed
< =
------------ CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOB IN RESTART STATUS ------------
JOB: D463XX33 CODE: JCLERR LAST-STEP: MCNT: 331
CA-7#: 3332 JES#: 17349 NODE-NAME: LOCAL
REASON:
-- -- FORCE COMPLETE
Request the proper function(s) by placing an X in the space provided and pressing Enter.
The following describes the functions that may appear on the screen.
REASON Always appears on the screen. This is a required entry field if
REASON=YES is specified in the CA-7 initialization file
RESTART statement or if CA-11 requires a reason for restarts.
See the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide for further information
on the initialization file. If the CA-11 reason-for-rerun table is
available, an attempt is made to expand any code of up to 4 char-
acters that is entered. If the CMT member is found, the reason
entered is moved to the CMT.
RESUBMIT FOR PRODUCTION
Always appears on the screen. Used by itself to simply resubmit
the job with no changes. When CA-11 is installed and the job is
found on the CMT data set, this function clears restart fields in
the CMT.
FORCE COMPLETE
Always appears on the screen. If used, the job is processed as if
a good end-of-job had occurred. This causes triggering and
requirement posting for other dependent jobs. Job triggering and
posting occur. If CA-11 is installed and the CMT member is
found, this also clears the CMT flags.
CA-11 RESTART/RERUN
If the CMT member is found, information specified in these
fields update the CMT member. If the RMS step has not exe-
cuted, RESUBMIT should be used instead of RESTART.
CMT STATUS Used to provide a message describing the job status as found in
the CMT. Also used to report that the CA-11 interface is not
available and why.
SET PARM DATA FOR RMS AND RESUBMIT
Can be used only if CA-7 inserted the RMS procedure. Used to
define new CA-11 PARM data for the rerun. No edits are per-
formed on this field. The CA-11 CMT is not updated.
DO NOT INSERT RMS PROC BUT RESUBMIT
Can be used only if CA-7 inserted the RMS procedure. Causes
resubmittal without the RMS procedure being inserted. Overrides
DB.1 screen option. The CA-11 CMT is not updated. This
option should only be used for the first resubmission of a job.
RESUBMIT FOR PRODUCTION should be used for any subse-
quent resubmissions.
CA-11 Not Installed: If CA-11 is not installed, the following is an example of the
screen.
< =
------------ CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - CPU JOB IN RESTART STATUS ------------
JOB: D463XX33 CODE: JCLERR LAST-STEP: MCNT: 331
CA-7#: 3332 JES#: 17349 NODE-NAME: LOCAL
REASON:
-- -- FORCE COMPLETE
Use this screen to list queued JCL so that it can be updated. There is no equivalent batch
function.
< =
------------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - QUEUED JCL --------------------
FUNCTION: (APPEND,APPENDP,CLEAR,EDIT,FE,FETCH,
FETCHP,FPE,REPL,SAVE)
JOB:
K L
To display, enter:
5 as the FUNCTION on the QM screen.
QM.5 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted screen.
QM.5 as a top line command.
QJCL as a top line command.
E for a job on the QM.1 screen.
If an error is encountered with a top line QJCL command, this screen is returned for
ease of correction and reentry.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other screen in the FUNCTION field.
See 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
If this screen was displayed as a result of entering an E on the QM.1 screen, return is to
that screen after any updates are done.
Use this screen to list input network tasks that are to be updated. There is no equivalent
batch function.
< =
-------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - INPUT NETWORKS PROMPT --------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
6 as the FUNCTION on the QM screen.
QM.6 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted screen.
QM.6 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with top line XPRE or XSPRE commands, this screen is
returned for ease of correction and reentry.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other screen in the FUNCTION field.
See 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
Function values may be entered in the FL. portion of the screen to assign the same func-
tion for all records. It may also be entered in front of an individual entry to perform the
function for only that entry.
Function values may be mixed on the same screen. For example, after the screen is first
displayed, you may enter function values, in the field that precedes each line on the
screen, to log in to one entry, log out another, and cancel yet another with a single screen
command.
After a station has been logged out or canceled, it continues to be displayed for this
request. It may be necessary to reissue the command for an updated display. However,
no function value may be input for that entry.
< =
----------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - INPUT NETWORKS ------------------
POS: FL: INITS:
F --REF-- JOBNAME- NETWORK- STATION- SUBID--- DESC---- REMARKS--------------M
3332331 D463XX33 D43218ED CONTROL PAY31 WEEK1
K L
2.149.2.1 Field Descriptions
Once the QM.6 update screen has been displayed, the POS, FL, and INITS fields on the
screen can be used to perform certain functions. The use of these fields and their accept-
able values are as follows:
POS: This indicates position of the screen. Available values are:
NOP No processing - clears screen of input values.
PF Page forward.
Request updates by entering the desired value in the F field in front of the desired entry.
Multiple tasks may be updated if so desired.
After all values have been entered, press Enter and the updates are made. REMARKS
fields and MESSAGE field at the bottom indicate what action took place.
When finished, you may enter a command on the top line to transfer to some other func-
tion. Refer also to 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
< =
----------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - INPUT NETWORKS ------------------
POS: FL: INITS:
F---REF---SUBID----DESC-----EC
3332331 PAY31 WEEK1
K L
The F, REF, SUBID, and DESC fields have the same meaning as on the 1-up display.
The EC field provides a 2-digit number corresponding to the REMARKS field on the
1-up display as follows:
01 INVALID CODE - the F value given is unknown
02 REF# NOT FOUND - could not locate the REF number requested
03 ALREADY LOGGED IN - can only log in a task once
05 NOT IN PROCESS - can only log out an active task
06 NOT HELD - can only release a 'held' task
07 NOT PROMPTED - can only respond if the task was prompted
08 HELD - the task is now in 'hold' status
09 ALREADY LOGGED OUT - can only log out a task once
10 ALREADY HELD - can only 'hold' a non-held task
11 ALREADY ACKNOWLEDGED - can only respond to a prompt once
Request updates by entering the desired value in the F field in front of the desired entry.
Multiple tasks may be updated if so desired.
After all values have been entered, press Enter and the updates are made. EC fields and
MESSAGE field at the bottom indicate what action took place.
Use this screen to list output network tasks that are to be updated. There is no equivalent
batch function.
< =
------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - OUTPUT NETWORKS PROMPT --------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
7 as the FUNCTION on the QM screen.
QM.7 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted screen.
QM.7 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with top line XPOST or XSPOST commands, this screen is
returned for ease of correction and reentry.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other screen in the FUNCTION field.
See 2.143.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-429 for other options.
Function values may be mixed on the same screen. For example, after the screen is first
displayed; you may enter function values in the blank field that precedes each line on the
screen, to log in to one entry, log out another, and cancel yet another with a single screen
command.
After a station has been logged out or canceled, it continues to be displayed until a new
display is requested. However, no function value may be input for that entry.
< =
----------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - OUTPUT NETWORKS -----------------
POS: FL: INITS:
F --REF-- JOBNAME- NETWORK- STATION- SUBID--- DESC---- REMARKS--------------M
3333311
K L
2.150.2.1 Field Descriptions
Once the QM.7 update screen has been displayed, the POS, FL, and INITS fields on the
screen can be used to perform certain functions. The use of these fields and their accept-
able values are as follows:
POS: This indicates position of the screen. Allowable values are:
NOP No processing - clears screen of input values.
PF Page forward.
TOP Position to the top of the screen.
ONE Display in 1-up format (one record per line); return from TWO.
TWO Display in 2-up format (two records per line).
FL: Indicates a fill character for processing the records. See the previous dis-
cussion of the FILL parameter for allowable options.
INITS: This performs the same function as the INITS parameter of the LOGIN
and LOGOUT commands discussed in 2.108, “LOGIN/LOGOUT” on
page 2-305. You can enter the initials for the operator processing network
records here.
F Indicates the function column in which updates are requested. Refer to the
FILL WITH values on the QM.7 screen for values allowed here.
REF Indicates the CA-7 assigned number for this task.
JOBNAME Indicates either:
JOB keyword value given when the network was initiated with a
DMDNW command.
Name of the CPU job predecessor if the network was initiated as a
result of the predecessor job being initiated.
NETWORK Indicates the name of this network in the database.
STATION Indicates the station at which this task is to be performed.
SUBID Indicates either:
SUBID keyword value given when the network was initiated with a
DMDNW command.
SUBID value for the SUB-ID field on the DB.3.4 screen.
DESC Indicates the DESC keyword value given when the network was initiated
with a DMDNW command.
Request updates by entering the desired value in the F field in front of the desired entry.
Multiple tasks may be updated if so desired.
After all values have been entered, press Enter and the updates are made. REMARKS
fields and MESSAGE field at the bottom indicate what action took place.
< =
----------------- CA-7 QUEUE MAINTENANCE - OUTPUT NETWORKS -----------------
POS: FL: INITS:
F---REF---SUBID----DESC-----EC
3333311
K L
2.150.3.1 Field Descriptions
The F, REF, SUBID, and DESC fields have the same meaning as on the 1-up display in
2.150.2.1, “Field Descriptions” on page 2-461.
The EC field provides a 2-digit number corresponding to the REMARKS field on the
1-up display as follows:
01 INVALID CODE - the F value given is unknown
02 REF# NOT FOUND - could not locate the REF number requested
03 ALREADY LOGGED IN - can only log in a task once
05 NOT IN PROCESS - can only log out an active task
06 NOT HELD - can only release a held task
07 NOT PROMPTED - can only respond if the task was prompted
08 HELD - the task is now in hold status
09 ALREADY LOGGED OUT - can only log out a task once
10 ALREADY HELD - can only hold a nonheld task
11 ALREADY ACKNOWLEDGED - can only respond to a prompt once
Request updates by entering the desired value in the F field in front of the desired entry.
Multiple tasks may be updated if so desired.
After all values have been entered, press Enter and the updates are made. EC fields and
MESSAGE field at the bottom indicate what action took place.
2.151 RELEASE
Use the RELEASE top line command to indicate that normal scheduling activities may
now be resumed for jobs or queues on HOLD. See 2.85, “HOLD” on page 2-203.. This
function is available for CPU jobs on the QM.1, QM.2, and QM.3 screens. It is available
for workstation networks on the QM.6 and QM.7 screens.
2.151.1 Syntax
RELEASE
──RELEASE──,──┬─JOB=─┬─jobname───┬──┬───────────────────────────
│ ├─jobnumber─┤ │
│ └─refnumber─┘ │
└─Q=─┬─REQ─┬──────────┘
└─RDY─┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the individual job or workstation network to be released. JOB is required
to release a specific job. It must be omitted if Q is specified. The value for a CPU
job may be entered as the specific job name or the CA-7 job number.
Required: Yes, unless Q is used
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
refnumber
The value for a workstation network task must be entered as the CA-7 assigned
reference number in the format nnnnrrs where:
nnnn
CA-7 job number.
rr
Relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associated
with the job. For input workstation networks, the value is 00.
s
Relative position of the station within the network. The first station would
be position 1.
Q
Indicates the contents of an entire queue are to be released. Q must be omitted if
JOB is specified.
Required: Yes, unless JOB is used
REQ
Request queue hold status.
RDY
Ready queue hold status.
A job may be in hold status due to a previous request by a HOLD command or the hold
may be permanently defined in the database. In either case, the RELEASE can be used.
A release request by job name causes all jobs and/or workstation networks with that name
to be released. There may be multiple jobs with the same name.
2.151.3 Examples
RELEASE,JOB=CA7JOB9
RELEASE,JOB=163
RELEASE,Q=REQ
RELEASE,JOB=3378312
2.152 REMIND
Use the REMIND top line command to schedule free-form reminder messages, generated
separately through the edit facility, to workstations at a predetermined time. For addi-
tional information, see 2.125, “LRMD” on page 2-385. A free-form message can be
defined to communicate anything to a workstation. The workstation operator is
prompted, repeatedly if necessary, to review the defined text.
2.152.1 Syntax
REMIND
──REMIND──,STATION=station──,TIME=hhmm──┬─────────────┬──────────
└─,DATE=yyddd─┘
──┬──────────────┬───────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,SUBID=subid─┘
Where:
STATION
Specifies the logical terminal name (station) to which reminder text in the active area
is to be directed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
TIME
Indicates the time-of-day at which reminder text in the active area is to be sent to the
STATION.
Required: Yes
hh
Indicates the hour (0 through 23).
mm
Indicates the minutes (0 through 59).
DATE
Specifies the Julian date when reminder text in the active area is to be sent to the
STATION. If DATE is not specified, the current date is used. If the time-of-day
(TIME value) is past and no date is specified, the next day is used.
Required: No
yy
Indicates the year.
ddd
Indicates the Julian day.
SUBID
Specifies a SUB-ID to further qualify the STATION.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
The reminder remains in the CA-7 preprocess queue, with a job name in the format
RMD#nnnn, until a LOGOUT or CANCEL is entered. When the reminder is issued at
the specified time-of-day (or immediately as just described), it is reissued for each
reprompt cycle until a LOGOUT or CANCEL is done.
2.152.3 Examples
REMIND,STATION=INPUT,TIME=3833
REMIND,STATION=MAIL,TIME=1633,DATE=33287
2.153 RENAME
Use the RENAME command to rename a DASD data set. This function is available on
the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 3 or on any other menu or formatted screen as
FUNCTION value UT.3. This command neither renames PDS members nor CA-7 data-
base data sets.
2.153.1 Syntax
RENAME
──RENAME──,DSN=dsname──,NEWNAME=newname──┬─────────────┬────────
└─,VOL=volume─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the old fully qualified name of the data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
NEWNAME
Indicates the new fully qualified name to be assigned to the data set.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates the volume on which the data set resides. The volume on which the data
set resides must be available to CA-7.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: No if data set is cataloged
2.153.2 Examples
RENAME,DSN=USER.FILE1,NEWNAME=USER.FILEX,VOL=VOLM31
RENAME,DSN=USER.FILE1,NEWNAME=USER.FILE2
2.154 REQUEUE
Use the REQUEUE top line command to move jobs from the ready or active queues back
to the request queue. This allows the use of the CA-7 job restart facilities after certain
JCL or CPU failures, or job cancellation out of a CPU through the OS console. This
function is available as the Q option in 2.144, “QM.1 CPU Jobs Status Prompt Screen”
on page 2-430.
2.154.1 Syntax
REQUEUE
──REQUEUE──┬────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬──────────────
└─,CPU=smfid─┘ └─,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬──┘
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──┬───────────┬────────
└─,MAINID=─┬─ALL──┬──┘ └─,Q=─┬─ACT─┬──┘ └─,TYPE=JCL─┘
├─SYn──┤ └─RDY─┘
└─/SYn─┘
Where:
CPU
Used with JOB to specify the CPU ID of active queue jobs which are to be
requeued. The value identifies the CPU and corresponds to the CPU field displayed
on the LQ command (the SMF identifier). CPU cannot be used with MAINID.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: No
JOB
Specifies the job to be moved back to the request queue, given a restart requirement,
and flagged as having been requeued. If JOB is used alone, both the active and
ready queues are searched for the specified job. If JOB is used with Q, the search is
restricted to the indicated queue.
Required: No
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
MAINID
Used with JOB to indicate that only those jobs in the ready queue with this MAINID
are to be requeued. Value must be specified as a single MAINID name. MAINID
cannot be used with CPU.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
ALL
Indicates all MAINIDs are to be considered.
SYn
Where n indicates a CPU assigned number as defined in the initialization file
CPU statement. See the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide for further informa-
tion on the initialization file. The value of n may range from 1 to 7.
/SYn
Where n indicates a CPU assigned number. The / indicates "not this MAINID."
The value of n may range from 1 to 7.
Q
Used with JOB to indicate in which queue the job search is to occur.
Required: No
ACT
Indicates the active queue.
RDY
Indicates the ready queue.
TYPE
Indicates the job should be flagged, once it returns to the request queue with a status
of JCLERR instead of REQUE. If not coded, the status reflects REQUE.
Certain VRM resources acquired by the job may be freed when the REQUEUE command
is issued. If the resource is defined on the RM.1 screen as SHR, EXC, or RCT and if it
is to be freed at abnormal termination (A or F), the resource is freed when the job is
requeued.
If JOB is not specified, CA-7 requeues all jobs which meet the Q, MAINID, or CPU
criteria.
In the event of a system failure which strands jobs in the CA-7 active queue, the requeue
function must be used to place the jobs in restart status.
2.154.3 Examples
REQUEUE,JOB=1234
REQUEUE,JOB=9999,Q=RDY
REQUEUE,JOB=9999,CPU=CPU1
REQUEUE,JOB=9999,MAINID=SY2
REQUEUE,CPU=CPU1
2.155 RESANL
Use the RESANL command to cause an analysis of all specified jobs in the specified
systems against the correct number of tape drives needed based on job profiles in the
CA-7 database.
2.155.1 Syntax
RESANL
──RESANL──┬─────────────────────┬──┬────────────────────────┬────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ │ ┌─M───────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname──┼──┘ └─,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼──┘
└─jobname#─┘ └─systemname#─┘
──┬──────────┬──┬───────────────────┬────────────────────────────
└─,TYPE=DS─┘ │ ┌─NO──┐ │
└─,UPDATE=─┴─YES─┴──┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which an analysis is to be performed.
Size/Type 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Causes all jobs to be analyzed.
jobname
Is a single job name.
jobname*
Is a generic job name terminated with an asterisk.
SYS
Specifies the system name(s) for which an analysis is to be performed.
Size/Type 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Causes all systems to be analyzed.
systemname
Is a system name.
systemname*
Is a generic system name terminated with an asterisk.
TYPE
Specifies data set information. When CA-7 is analyzing a data set, an attempt is
made to examine the data set's catalog entry. If a data set is not cataloged, CA-7
uses the information about the data set that is stored in the job data set. When
TYPE=DS is specified, CA-7 uses the dataset data set information instead of the job
data set information when a catalog entry is not available.
Required: No
UPDATE
Specifies whether those jobs being analyzed should have their WLB tape drive
requirements updated to match their job profiles. The profiles agree with the last
LOAD function performed.
Default: NO
Required: No
NO
Indicates no updates are to be made to the database.
YES
Indicates updates are to be made to the database in addition to providing a list.
2.156 RESCHNG
Use the RESCHNG command in a CA-7 trailer step to free tape drives that are no longer
needed. When workload balancing is scheduling jobs, the high-water mark for tape
drives is reserved until job completion, unless this command is used. Using this
command, the trailer step can be inserted in the job anytime after the maximum number
of tape drives is no longer needed.
2.156.1 Syntax
RESCHNG
──RESCHNG──┬──────────────┬──┬──────────┬──┬──────────┬─────────
└─,JOB=jobname─┘ └─,TP1=nnn─┘ └─,TP2=nnn─┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the name of the job to which the change applies. The job must be in the
active queue. JOB is required unless the command is entered from SASSTRLR
(trailer step).
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, unless command is from SASSTRLR
TP1
Indicates the maximum TAPE1 requirements for the remainder of the job.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 255
Required: No
TP2
Indicates the maximum TAPE2 requirements for the remainder of the job.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 255
Required: No
2.156.3 Examples
RESCHNG,TP1=13
Changes number of TYPE1 tape drives in use to 10. Frees all but 10 tape drives (used
by the previous steps) for scheduling other jobs.
RESCHNG,TP1=333,TP2=333
Changes number of TYPE1 and TYPE2 tape drives in use to 0. Frees all tape drives
(used by the previous steps) for scheduling other jobs.
2.157 RESOLV
Use the top line RESOLV command to create or modify processing schedules for jobs or
workstation networks which are to be scheduled on a date/time basis. Work which is
scheduled by a trigger or on-request work which is DEMANDed or RUN has no direct
relationship to a base calendar and therefore does not require the use of this function.
You can also request the RESOLV command from the DB.2.1 and DB.2.2 screens. Those
screens are used to define schedule criteria and the name of the default base calendar to
which the schedules apply. The RESOLV command is then used to perform a resolution
process using the specified schedule criteria and the base calendar(s). Processing sched-
ules are thus completed, defining the specific dates on which the processing is to be per-
formed. Scheduling begins automatically when the first date in the RESOLVed schedule
arrives. (These schedules can be further modified using the DB.2.7 function. Other tem-
porary or onetime changes can also be accomplished through other commands such as
NXTCYC and so forth.)
The RESOLV command selects the schedule members to be processed before actual
schedule resolution activity begins. The JOB and NW parameters are used to identify the
job and network candidates for resolution of schedules. If JOB and NW are omitted, all
jobs and input networks are considered candidates. Two criteria are used for selecting the
schedules to be resolved for those candidates identified:
The SCAL value specified in the RESOLV command is matched with the base cal-
endar references in the schedule data.
The OLDYR value specified in the RESOLV command is matched with the base
calendar year in the schedule data.
Schedules can be RESOLVed for January through December of the current year, or for
July of the current year through June of the next year. See the YEAR parameter in
2.157.1, “Syntax” on page 2-479.
Before CA-7 can automatically schedule a job, it needs to know the exact dates the job is
to be processed. The RESOLV command takes the specified scheduling information and
compares it to the processing days defined in the base calendar(s) to calculate the exact
processing days. When doing a schedule resolution, CA-7 looks at the scheduling infor-
mation in the following sequence:
1. All positive schedule values for DAILY, WEEKLY, MONTHLY, ANNUAL, and
SYMETRIC.
2. All negative schedule values for WEEKLY, MONTHLY, and ANNUAL.
3. ROLL option. (process based on calendar definition)
4. INDEX field. (process based on calendar definition)
2.157.1 Syntax
RESOLV
──RESOLV──┬────────────────────────────┬─────────────────────────
└─,─┬─JOB=─┬─M────────┬───┬──┘
│ ├─jobname──┤ │
│ └─jobname#─┘ │
└─NW=─┬─NW.network─┬──┘
└─NW.────────┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────────────────
└─,DUPDATE=─┬─YES─┬──┘ └─,OLDYR=─┬─M──┬──┘
└─NO──┘ └─yy─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────────┬────────────────────────
│ ┌─NO──┐ │ └─,SCAL=─┬─M──┬──┘
└─,PRINT=─┴─YES─┴──┘ └─xx─┘
──┬─────────────────┬──┬──────────┬──────────────────────────────
│ ┌─YES─┐ │ └─,YEAR=yy─┘
└─,TEST=─┴─NO──┴──┘
Where:
JOB
Limits selection for resolution to the job(s) specified. When JOB is specified, NW
must be omitted. If both are omitted, all job and input network schedules are candi-
dates for resolution. Value may be either a specific job name or a generic name
which identifies multiple jobs beginning with the specified characters. An asterisk
(*) must be used to delimit the generic job name. It may appear in any of the 8
positions but must immediately follow the last significant character of the job name
requested. For example, AB* causes all jobs beginning with AB to be selected for
resolution. JOB=* causes all job schedules to be selected for resolution.
Required: No (cannot be used with NW)
*
Select all job schedules for resolution.
jobname
Select a specific job name.
jobname*
Select a generic job name (with * used to delimit).
NW
Limits selection for resolution to the input network(s) specified. If used, JOB must
be omitted. If both are omitted, all job and input network schedules are candidates
for selection. When used, value must be one of the following:
Required: No (cannot be used with JOB)
NW.network
Identifies a specific network name to be selected.
NW.
Indicates all input networks are to be considered for resolution. This value must
be terminated with a period.
DUPDATE
Indicates whether specific duplicate day messages (SRC1-137) should be produced
each time a given day is scheduled by two or more schedule IDs for the same
job/network.
Required: No. The default is NO unless the extended resolve message option
has been set in the user profile (see 2.25, “/PROF” on page 2-53).
OLDYR
Specifies the year currently defined in the schedule member data (the value supplied
by YEAR in the previous resolution which updated the schedule member). Only
those candidate schedule members whose year data matches the OLDYR value are
selected for resolution. If used, value must be one of the following:
Default: If omitted, only those schedule members which have not previously
been resolved or whose schedules have expired are selected.
Required: No
yy
Indicates a specific year.
*
Indicates all years and all schedules.
PRINT
Specifies whether a month-by-month schedule day calendar is to be displayed after
resolution of the defined member is complete. If used, value must be either
PRINT=YES or PRINT=NO.
Default: NO
Required: No
SCAL
Value is the xx portion of the base calendar name, SCALyyxx. The SCAL value
must also match the base calendar identifier (SCAL) specified in any SCHID of the
schedule definition for the individual job(s) or network(s). This value is used during
the selection process of resolution to determine which schedule members are to be
resolved.
Required: No (unless JOB and NW are omitted)
*
Indicates all SCALs.
xx
Indicates a specific SCAL.
TEST
Indicates whether schedule members are to be updated as a result of the resolution
process. TEST=YES and TEST=NO are the only allowable values.
Default: YES
Required: No
YES
Normal resolution occurs and all messages are printed, but no updating of the
database occurs. This option can be used at year-end or whenever a base cal-
endar is changed to see the results of the resolution activity, without actually
changing the schedule mask or affecting the current schedule process.
NO
Normal resolution occurs and all messages are printed, and updating of the data-
base occurs.
YEAR
Identifies the year of the base calendar(s) against which the schedule is resolved.
Value is the number which is specified by the yy portion of the base calendar name,
SCALyyxx. When a schedule is successfully updated, the YEAR value becomes part
of the schedule data (see OLDYR). If the YEAR parameter is not specified, the
current year is assumed to be the year from the system internal date and time.
Also, if YEAR is not coded on the RESOLV, a check is made to see if the RESOLV
is made within the period January 1 through June 30 as determined from system date
and time. If so, the schedule is resolved against January through December of the
current year. If a RESOLV is done within the period July 1 through December 31,
the schedule is resolved against July 1 through December 31 of the current year and
January 1 through June 30 of the next year. This requires the existence of base
calendars for both calendar years involved. If a required base calendar is not avail-
able, an error message is issued, and the schedule member is not resolved.
YEAR is optional. If YEAR is specified, the resolution is made against January
through December of the year specified.
Size/Type: 2 numeric characters
Default: Current year
Required: No
Note: If year= is specified, only the current year should be used.
When the RESOLV command is entered in the FUNCTION field, a resolution is per-
formed for a 12-month period. The current year is divided into 6-month intervals. This
means if a RESOLV is entered between January 1 and June 30, the resolution looks at
the period January 1 through December 31. If a RESOLV is entered between July 1 and
December 31, the resolution attempts to look at July 1 through June 30 of the next year.
If next year's base calendar is not defined, you get error message SRC2-02 BASE CAL-
ENDAR SCALyyxx NOT FOUND. At this time, add subparameter YEAR=yy to the top
line RESOLV command already displayed, where yy is the current year.
If JOB=* or NW=NW. is specified, all job or input network schedule definitions are
resolved based on the other RESOLV parameters. This command can run for a long time
and generate a large amount of output. The long-running RESOLV commands should be
issued using the batch terminal interface.
2.157.3 Examples
Example 1
RESOLV,YEAR=33,SCAL=31,TEST=NO,PRINT=YES
Causes all schedule members which reference base calendar SCAL0001 to be selected.
TEST=NO indicates the schedule members are actually updated. A printout of the
schedule day calendar is also requested.
Example 2
RESOLV,YEAR=33,SCAL=PR,NW=NW.INNET1,PRINT=YES,OLDYR=99
Causes selection of the schedule member for input network INNET1 if 1999 is the year
currently defined in the schedule member. The schedule selected is resolved for 2000
(SCAL00PR) and the resulting schedule day calendar is printed. Due to the absence of
TEST=NO, the TEST=YES default takes effect, and the schedule member is not updated
in the database.
Example 3
RESOLV,YEAR=33,SCAL=AC,OLDYR=M,TEST=NO
Causes all schedule members which reference base calendar SCAL00AC to be selected
for resolution. Previous resolution year data is not considered (OLDYR=*). The
schedule members are updated but calendars are not printed.
Example 4
RESOLV,SCAL=32
Causes all schedule members which reference base calendar 02, and that have never been
previously resolved, to be selected. Resolution would be for the current calendar year
unless the command is issued from July 1 through December 31. It would then use the
last six months of the current calendar year and the first six months of the following year
to cover a 12-month period. All other RESOLV function parameters assume default
values in this example.
Example 5
RESOLV,JOB=M,OLDYR=M,TEST=NO
Causes all job schedules to be resolved for the current 12-month period. The schedule
members are updated with the results of this RESOLV command. All calendars refer-
enced by job schedules are used to process this RESOLV.
2.158 RESTART
Use the RESTART top line command to restart a job awaiting restart in the request
queue. This function is available as the F option on 2.144, “QM.1 CPU Jobs Status
Prompt Screen” on page 2-430. You can also use 2.147, “QM.4 CPU Job In Restart
Status Prompt Screen” on page 2-446 to accomplish a job restart. If CA-11 is used, the
CMT is updated with the appropriate restart data. See the CA-7 Interfaces Guide for
further discussion related to CA-11.
If CA-11 is not installed, the starting and ending steps have no significance, nor does
USAGE, PROCESS, CONDCD, or SUP11STP.
2.158.1 Syntax
RESTART
──RESTART──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬───┬───────────────────┬───────────
└─jobnumber─┘ │ ┌─NO──┐ │
└─,BYPGDG=─┼─YES─┼──┘
├─VER─┤
└─CAT─┘
──┬──────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬──┬───────────┬───────
└─,CONDCD=nnnn─┘ │ ┌─NO──┐ │ └─,LCC=nnnn─┘
└─,FORCECOMP=─┴─YES─┴──┘
──┬────────────────┬──┬─────────────────┬─────────────────────────
└─,LSTP=stepname─┘ └─,LPSTP=procname─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬───────────────────┬───────────────────
└─,PROCSTRT=procname─┘ └─,PROCEND=procname─┘
──┬───────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬───────
└─,PROCESS=code─┘ └─,REASON=text─┘ └─,STPEND=stepname─┘
──┬─────────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬────────────
└─,STPSTRT=─┬─stepname─┬──┘ │ ┌─NO──┐ │
├─MRERUNM──┤ └─,SUP11STP=─┴─YES─┴──┘
├─MCMTM────┤
└─MRESUBPM─┘
──┬─────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────────────
└─,USAGE=code─┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the unique CA-7 job name or job number of the job to be restarted. The
job must be in the request queue.
Required: Yes
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
BYPGDG
Indicates whether CA-11 should bypass GDG logic on a restart/rerun. Value may be
NO, YES, VER, or CAT.
Default: CA-11 default value
Required: No
CONDCD
Indicates an optional CA-11 condition code to be set by the CA-11 step when the
rerun is executed. This option is honored only if CA-11 is in use and CA-7 is
inserting the RMS step. See the INSERT-RMS field on the DB.1 screen.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters from 0 to 4095
Required: No
FORCECOMP
Indicates if the job is to be flagged as normally completed. If FORCECOMP=YES,
the job's previous abnormal status is ignored, and normal job completion processing
is performed instead of a restart. Value may be NO or YES.
Default: NO
Required: No
LCC
Indicates an optional condition code value that replaces the last condition code value
for the step referenced by the LSTP and, optionally, LPSTP keyword(s). This option
is honored only if CA-11 is in use.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters from 0 to 4095
Default: 0
Required: No
LSTP
Indicates an optional step name that has its last condition code value reset in the
CA-11 CMT. LSTP and LCC must be coded if LPSTP is specified. LSTP requires
that a STPSTRT value be specified and that the LSTP stepname occurs in the job's
JCL prior to the STPSTRT stepname. This option is honored only if CA-11 is in use.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
LPSTP
Indicates an optional step name referencing a procedure that has its last condition
code value reset in the CA-11 CMT. If LPSTP is used, LSTP and LCC must also be
coded. This option is honored only if CA-11 is in use.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
PROCSTRT
Indicates an optional step name referencing a procedure where processing is to start.
If PROCESS=R and PROCSTRT are used, STPSTRT must also be coded. This
option is honored only if CA-11 is in use.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
PROCEND
Indicates an optional step name referencing a procedure where processing is to end.
If PROCESS=R and PROCEND are used, STPEND must be coded. This option is
honored only if CA-11 is in use.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
PROCESS
Indicates an optional CA-11 processing function code character to be used in the
restart/rerun. This option is honored only if CA-11 is in use and CA-7 is inserting
the RMS step. See the INSERT-RMS field on the DB.1 screen. Value may be F, P,
S, N, O or R.
Size/Type: 1 alpha character
Default: P
Required: No
REASON
Specifies a reason for the restart. If the CA-11 Reason-for-Rerun module is avail-
able, a code of up to 4 characters may be input and it is expanded. Any reason input
or expanded is copied to the run log. This field is optional unless CA-11 requires a
reason or REASON=YES was specified in the RESTART statement in the initializa-
tion file. See the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide for more information on the
initialization file.
Size/Type: 1 to 40 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
STPEND
Indicates an optional step name or number at which processing is to end. If not
specified, the last step of the job is assumed to be the ending step. STPEND must be
coded if PROCEND is specified. This option is honored only if CA-11 is in use.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
STPSTRT
Indicates an optional step name or number at which processing is to start. If
STPSTRT is not coded, the first step of the job is assigned to be the starting step.
STPSTRT must be coded if PROCSTRT is specified. This option is honored only if
CA-11 is in use.
Required: No
stepname
Specifies the step name or number at which processing is to start.
*CMT*
Indicates the job is to restart with the step values currently on the CMT record.
*RERUN*
Indicates the total job is to be rerun. If there are no restartable steps, *RERUN*
must be specified.
*RESUBP*
Indicates the job's CMT record is set to production, and then the job is sub-
mitted.
SUP11STP
Indicates if insertion of the CA-11 RMS step is to be suppressed. If the job is resub-
mitted with SUP11STP=YES, the CA-11 step is not inserted. Only valid if CA-7 is
inserting the CA-11 step. See the INSERT-RMS field on the DB.1 screen. Value
may be NO or YES.
Default: NO
Required: No
USAGE
Indicates an optional CA-11 usage code of the character to be used in the
restart/rerun. See CA-11 documentation for values. This option is honored only if
CA-11 is in use and CA-7 is inserting the RMS step. See the INSERT-RMS field on
the DB.1 screen.
Size/Type: 1 alphanumeric character
Required: No
2.159 RM
The following table gives a brief description of the RM commands. For more informa-
tion, see the CA-7 Database Maintenance Guide where they are fully described.
Screen Purpose
RM Select the virtual resource management functions.
RM.1 Job Resource Management List, add, update, or delete resource connections by
job. It generates the VRM static type J and R
records maintained on the VRM database component.
RM.2 Job Resource Cross Reference List jobs using resources. The jobs can be listed by a
fully qualified resource name or by a generic key.
RM.3 Active Job Resources Display Display active resources by job. The jobs can be
listed generically or with fully qualified job names.
RM.4 Pending Resources Job Display Display all pending resources with an associated job
name. A pending resource is a nonfreed resource
connected to a job which has already executed and
has been purged from the request queue. This
resource can only be freed by using the PRSCF
command. The pending resources can be listed using
a generic or fully qualified resource name.
RM.5 Jobs Waiting on Resources Display jobs waiting for resources. It can be used to
show the resources that a job is waiting for when the
job shows a status of W-RSRC on the List Queue
(LQ) display.
RM.6 Corequisite Resources List List active corequisite resources.
RM.7 Resource Count Resource Management List, add, update, or delete a resource count type
resource.
2.160 RQMT
Use the RQMT command to cause all index entries for PRED nodes to be reviewed for
cross reference. The second node of the names are jobs identified as requirements for
other jobs by DB.3 commands. The dependent and predecessor jobs exist as database
entries with applicable schedule IDs and lead times.
If necessary, PRED index entries are created, modified, or deleted according to existing
requirements for the jobs defined in the database.
2.160.1 Syntax
RQMT
──RQMT──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.160.3 Examples
< RQMT =
DATE=yy.ddd CA-7 RQMT ANALYZE REPORT PAGE NO. 3331
THE PRED INDEX ENTRIES FOR THE FOLLOWING JOBS ARE NEWLY CREATED:
HEGENER1 HEUNIVD T2LIB123 T2TMSBK1 T21USLIB
THE PRED INDEX ENTRIES FOR THE FOLLOWING JOBS ARE MODIFIED:
BZPR131 HEBACPRT HEBACSMF HEBACTAB HEDASDPR HEDETASD HEDETASM
HEDETASM HEFRYMAN HEFRYMNW HEKOMDDS HEKOMDMS HEKOMDWS HERECAPR
HES33231 HETAPEDS HEWEKSAS IFCS233E PCMOUNTM PCMOUNTT PCNPRIME
PCPRIME PCRPDAY PCTMSSCR PRUCC331 PRUCC333 ROSDAILY T2DASDWK
T2LIB116 T2LIB119 T2MVSPG1 T2SMAILS T2TMSLS1 T2TSOPK2 WLPR131
THE PRED INDEX ENTRIES FOR THE FOLLOWING JOBS ARE DELETED:
PCEREPD TGAD TGAE TGAX TGAY
2.161 RQVER
Use the RQVER command to review internal JOB/DSN requirements for request queue
jobs which have not been satisfied.
2.161.1 Syntax
RQVER
──RQVER──┬─────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ │ ┌─3333─┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname──┼──┘ └─,MAXJOBS=─┴─nnnn─┴──┘
└─jobname#─┘
──┬────────────────────────┬──┬───────────────────┬──────────────
│ ┌─M───────────┐ │ │ ┌─NO──┐ │
└─,SYS=─┼─systemname──┼──┘ └─,UPDATE=─┴─YES─┴──┘
└─systemname#─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the job name(s) for which an analysis is to be performed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Causes all jobs to be analyzed.
jobname
Is a single job name.
jobname*
Is a generic job name terminated with an asterisk.
MAXJOBS
Indicates the maximum number of jobs which may be in the request, ready, and
active queues when this function is executed.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters with a maximum value of 4000
Default: 300
Required: NO
Note: If the number of jobs in the request queue exceeds the MAXJOBS value,
then no updating (satisfying) of requirements occurs.
SYS
Specifies the system name(s) for which an analysis is to be performed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: *
Required: No
*
Causes all systems to be analyzed.
systemname
Is a system name.
systemname*
Is a generic system name terminated with an asterisk.
UPDATE
Specifies whether to update (satisfy) missing JOB/DSN requirements and adjust
master requirements counts in the queue records for jobs reviewed.
Default: NO
Required: No
NO
Specifies no updating.
YES
Specifies updating.
2.162 RSVP
Use the RSVP top line command to acknowledge receipt of a prompt, and to suspend
further prompting for that deadline. Both input and output workstations can use this
command. This function is available as the P option on the
2.144, “QM.1 CPU Jobs Status Prompt Screen” on page 2-430,
2.149, “QM.6 Input Networks Prompt Screen” on page 2-453, and
2.150, “QM.7 Output Networks Prompt Screen” on page 2-459.
When CA-7 detects a workstation activity which has not been logged in or out by the
scheduled time, a message is issued. This message notifies the workstation of the late
status of the activity specified. If the activity for which the station is being prompted is
on schedule, the response should be a LOGIN or LOGOUT. If the activity is late and the
workstation is aware of the late status but unable to do anything new to correct it, the
repetitive prompting can be suspended by acknowledging receipt of the message with the
RSVP command.
2.162.1 Syntax
RSVP
──RSVP──,─┬─JOB=jobnumber─┬───┬─────────────┬────────────────────
└─REF=nnnnrrs───┘ └─,NW=network─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬─────────────────────────
└─,STATION=station─┘ └─,SUBID=subid─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the unique CA-7 job number assigned to the task when it entered the
queue.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes, unless REF is used
REF
Specifies workstation network task reference number of the station to which the
RSVP applies. When REF is specified, other operands are ignored.
Required: Yes, if JOB is not used
nnnn
CA-7 job number. Leading zeros may be omitted.
rr
Relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associated with
the job. Leading zeros may not be omitted.
s
Relative position of the station within the network. The first station is position
1.
NW
Identifies the network for which the RSVP is being entered. If used, the value must
be the workstation network name in up to 8 characters. NW is required if JOB is
used for an output workstation network. NW must be omitted if REF is used instead
of JOB.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, if JOB is used
STATION
Specifies the station to which the RSVP applies. If used, the value must be the
station name. STATION is required if JOB is used for an output workstation
network. It must be omitted if REF is used.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes, if JOB is used
SUBID
Further identifies the network to which the RSVP applies. If used, the value must be
a SUBID name. It may not be used with REF. If omitted, spaces are assumed.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
The XPRE, XSPRE, XSPOST, and XPOST screens may also be used to perform this
function when working with 3270 terminals.
The RSVP top line command is used to respond to or acknowledge late status prompts
for a single job. It suspends further prompting for the job until the next scheduled dead-
line. This is different from NOPRMP, which suspends prompting for all remaining dead-
lines for that task.
RSVP may also be used to suspend prompting when a job has unsatisfied requirements.
RSVP also suspends prompting of the abnormal completion messages for jobs that fail.
2.162.3 Examples
RSVP,JOB=17,STATION=KEYPNCH
RSVP,JOB=163,NW=REPTDSTR,SUBID=PAYR1234,STATION=BURSTRM
RSVP,REF=11311
Use the RUN top line command to force immediate scheduling of a job without verifying
the availability of any input requirements or performing the updates which normally
follow successful job completion. The RUN command is similar to the DEMAND
command except that DEMAND is normally used to run a job out of turn on a onetime
basis. When DEMAND is used, input requirement checking is performed and database
updating is done upon completion of the job. When RUN is used, no requirement
posting or job triggering occurs.
The RUNH command indicates the job is to be placed in CA-7 hold status.
2.163.1 Syntax
RUN RUNH
──┬─RUN──┬──,JOB=jobname──┬──────────────────────────┬───────────
└─RUNH─┘ └─,ARFSET=─┬─arfsetname─┬──┘
└─MMNONEMM───┘
──┬──────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬─────────────┬───────────────────
(1)
└─,CLASS=x─┘ └─,DOTM=hhmm─┘ └─,FROMNODE── ─┘
──┬──────────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──┬────────┬──────────
(1)
└─,─┬─JCLID=nnn─────┬──┘ └─,LEADTM=hhmm─┘ └─,REF── ─┘
└─JCLLIB=&x...x─┘
──┬──────────────────┬──┬────────────┬──┬───────────┬────────────
│ ┌─1───┐ │ └─,TIME=hhmm─┘ └─,TYPE=RES─┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
Note:
1 You cannot specify this keyword. See 2.163.2, “Usage Notes” on page 2-498.
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job to be submitted. The value must be a job name. If the job has not
been defined in the CA-7 database, this name must also match the member name for
the JCL unless the job is defined in the database. See also JCLID.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
ARFSET
Identifies the ARF set name which is used for this run of the job. If **NONE** is
specified, no ARF processing is performed for this run of the job.
Size/Type 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters or **NONE**
Required: No
CLASS
Specifies the workload balancing class for resource checking.
Size/Type 1 alphanumeric character
Required: No
DOTM
Specifies a due-out time-of-day for the job. If omitted, the current time (when
command is processed) plus the lead time is used.
Required: No
hhmm
Is the time-of-day where hh is the hours (0 to 24) and mm is minutes (0 to 59).
Leading zeros are not required.
JCLID
Identifies the JCL data set which contains the execution JCL to be submitted. If
used, the value must be a numeric INDEX associated with the desired JCL data set
(on the JCL statement in the initialization file). See the CA-7 Systems Programmer
Guide for further information on the initialization file. This field or the JCLLIB field
is required if the job is not defined in the database. JCLID and JCLLIB are mutually
exclusive.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 0 to 254
Required: No, unless job is not defined in database
JCLLIB
Identifies the JCL data set which contains the execution JCL to submitted. If used,
the value must be a symbolic INDEX associated with the desired JCL data set (on
the JCL statement in the initialization file). See the CA-7 Systems Programmer
Guide for further information on the initialization file. This field or the JCLID field
is required if the job is not defined in the database. JCLID and JCLLIB are mutually
exclusive.
Size/Type: 2 to 16 alphanumeric characters beginning with ampersand (&)
Required: No, unless job is not defined in database
Note: A dynamic allocation failure on a JCL data set specified by JCLLIB causes
the job to enter the request queue in SKELETON status.
LEADTM
Specifies the lead (processing) time required for the job to run. If omitted, 1 hour is
used.
Required: No
hhmm
Is the time where hh is hours (0 to 23) and mm is minutes (0 to 59). Leading
zeros are not required.
SCHID
Indicates the schedule ID to be used for evaluating JCL overrides which are sched-
uled with the #Jx or #Xx commands. If used, the value must be a schedule ID
number.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 1 to 255
Default: 1
Required: No (unless the SCHEDULE statement in the initialization file speci-
fies SCHID=YES, then this parameter is required)
TIME
Establishes a submit time-of-day requirement for the job.
Required: No
hhmm
Is the time-of-day where hh is hours (0 to 23) and mm is minutes (0 to 59).
Leading zeros are not required.
TYPE
Indicates the job is being scheduled for rerun. The value must be specified as
shown. TYPE=RES is optional. If used, a restart requirement is placed on the job,
and the job has to be manually restarted. (See 2.143, “QM” on page 2-428, 2.204,
“XRST” on page 2-580, and 2.158, “RESTART” on page 2-484.)
Required: No
If TYPE=RES is specified in the RUN command, the CA-7 restart facilities, QM.4
screen, or RESTART command may be used to restart or rerun the job.
If workload balancing is used, the job is run under the default WLB class for RUN if the
CLASS= keyword is not specified. (See the description of the RUNCLASS parameter on
the OPTIONS statement in the initialization file in the CA-7 Systems Programmer Guide.)
REF and FROMNODE are reserved keywords that are not considered valid input unless
generated by CA-7 internally. These keywords may not be coded on online, batch, or
trailer terminal transactions. They are reserved for special functions but are described
here because they may occur in master station messages.
If REF is specified, the job does NOT wait for restart in the request queue following
abnormal job completion.
2.163.3 Examples
RUN,JOB=CA7JOB5
RUN,JOB=CA7JOB1,TYPE=RES
RUNH,JOB=CA7JOB4,DOTM=1533,LEADTM=35,SCHID=27
2.164 RUNNW
Use the RUNNW top line command in place of the DMDNW command to force initi-
ation of input or output networks. When used for input networks, no requirement posting
or job triggering occurs. When used for output networks, no association is made to the
CPU job.
2.164.1 Syntax
RUNNW
──RUNNW──,NW=network──┬────────────┬──┬───────────┬──────────────
└─,DESC=text─┘ └─,JOB=name─┘
──┬──────────────┬──┬──────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬───────
└─,LEADTM=hhmm─┘ │ ┌─1───┐ │ └─,SUBID=subid─┘
└─,SCHID=─┴─nnn─┴──┘
Where:
NW
Specifies the network name to be scheduled. The value must be the network name
used when the network was defined in the database.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
DESC
Supplies additional identifying free-form information up to 8 characters. This value
is displayed on the QM.6, QM.7, LPRE, and LPOST screens.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
JOB
Supplies a name to be assigned to the network. If neither SUBID nor JOB is speci-
fied, JOB defaults to DMD#nnnn, where nnnn is the CA-7 assigned job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Default: SUBID
Required: No
LEADTM
Specifies a lead (processing) time for calculating deadline start time of the first
station in the network.
Required: No
hhmm
Is the time where hh specifies hours (0 to 99) and mm specifies minutes (0 to
59). Leading zeros not required.
SCHID
Identifies which network schedule ID is to be used.
Size/Type: 1 to 3 numeric characters from 1 to 255
Default: 1
Required: No
SUBID
Supplies an additional identifying name for the network when it enters the queue.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
Required: No
2.164.3 Examples
RUNNW,NW=RECPTS
RUNNW,NW=REPTS,SUBID=PAYR1234,DESC=PAYDATA
RUNNW,NW=REPTS,SCHID=27,LEADTM=3125
2.165 RUSH
Use the RUSH top line command to flag jobs in the queues as being needed as soon as
possible. The flag is for subsequent display information only, displaying the word RUSH
on displays, and has no direct effect on the processing cycle.
Once a job is flagged with the RUSH command, the job indicates RUSH in the STATUS
field on LQ type displays as long as it is ready to run and it is not late. Should it
become late, the STATUS field shows LATE. Other values appear if any error is
awaiting resolution.
2.165.1 Syntax
RUSH
──RUSH──,──┬─JOB=─┬─jobnumber─┬──┬──────────────────────────────
│ ├─ALL───────┤ │
│ └─ALLP──────┘ │
└─REF=nnnnrrs─────────┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the jobs to be flagged as critical.
Required: Yes, unless REF is used
jobnumber
Indicates a job number to be selected.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
ALL
Indicates all jobs in the request, ready, and postprocess queues.
ALLP
Indicates same as ALL but includes all networks in the preprocess queue as well.
REF
Specifies workstation task reference number of the station to which the command
applies.
Required: Yes, unless JOB is used
nnnn
CA-7 job number. Leading zeros may be omitted. Reference numbers may be
obtained by using the LPRE or LPOST commands.
rr
Relative sequence of the network in relation to other networks associated with
the job. Leading zeros may not be omitted.
s
Relative position of the station within the network. The first station is position
1.
2.166 SCHDMOD
2.166.1 Syntax
SCHDMOD
──SCHDMOD───────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.167 SCRATCH
Use the SCRATCH command to scratch an expired DASD data set. The SCRATCHP
command scratches a data set even if it is date protected. This function is also offered on
the UT Menu screen as function 4.
2.167.1 Syntax
SCRATCH SCRATCHP
──┬─SCRATCH──┬──,DSN=dsname──┬─────────────┬────────────────────
└─SCRATCHP─┘ └─,VOL=volume─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set. A relative generation request may
be made for a cataloged generation data set. This command does not scratch PDS
members.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
VOL
Indicates the volume on which the data set resides. The volume must be available to
CA-7. If the catalog is used, the data set is uncataloged if the scratch is successful.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Default: System catalog
Required: No
This command does not remove data sets from the CA-7 database.
A DD statement of the following form must exist in the CA-7 JCL for each volume to be
accessed:
//U7volser DD UNIT=uuuuuuuu,DISP=SHR,VOL=SER=xxxxxx
The ddname is U7 followed by the volume serial number (volser). An ALLOC command
or function 11 on the UT Menu screen may be used if the needed DD statement was not
included in the JCL.
2.167.3 Examples
SCRATCH,DSN=USER.FILE1
SCRATCH,DSN=USER.FILE2,VOL=VOLMO1
SCRATCHP,DSN=USER.DATE.PROT,VOL=VOLMO2
SCRATCH,DSN=USER.GDG(3)
2.168 SPACE
Use the SPACE command to list information on available space on DASD volumes avail-
able to CA-7. This function is available on the UT Menu screen as FUNCTION value 16
or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNCTION value UT.16.
2.168.1 Syntax
SPACE
──SPACE──,VOL=─┬─ALL──────────┬─────────────────────────────────
├─volume───────┤
│ ┌─,────┐ │
!volume┴─)─┘
└─(──
Where:
VOL
Indicates the volume(s) for which space information is to be displayed.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
ALL
Specifies all volumes available to CA-7 by way of //U7nnnnnn DD statements.
volume
Identifies a specific volume.
(volume,...,volume)
Identifies up to five volumes and must be enclosed in parentheses.
2.168.2 Examples
SPACE,VOL=ALL
SPACE,VOL=VOLMO1
SPACE,VOL=(VOLMO1,VOLMO2,VOLMO4,VOLMO7)
Displayed for each volume are unit name, UCB address, device code, user count, reserve
count, number of free cylinders, number of free tracks, and the largest contiguous extent.
2.169 SSCAN
Use the SSCAN top line command to review schedule scan options or to alter the way in
which schedule scan performs its scheduling functions. Schedule scan is an automatic
scheduling facility and can be altered as follows:
Schedule scan can be forced to run ahead of schedule, either to bring more work into
the queues, or to reissue prompts for overdue jobs or workstation activities.
The time parameters which govern schedule scan execution may be modified online.
The format of initial requirements scan output and prompt messages may be abbrevi-
ated. Jobs are scanned as they enter the request queue to see if any requirements are
satisfied. This is the initial requirements scan.
The due-out time of all newly scheduled work can be delayed as it enters the queue.
Schedule scan can cause all new work to enter the queue in CA-7 hold status.
Schedule scan can cause posting of the ARF dispatcher.
Any change made to parameters controlling schedule scan execution does not take effect
until the appropriate schedule scan activity runs.
2.169.1 Syntax
SSCAN
──SSCAN──┬─────────────┬──┬──────────┬──┬────────────────────┬───
└─,DATE=yyddd─┘ └─,INCR=hh─┘ │ ┌─3────┐ │
└─,LEADTM=─┴─mmmm─┴──┘
──┬──────────────┬──┬────────────────┬──┬────────────┬────────────
└─,PEREND=hhmm─┘ └─,PERSTART=hhmm─┘ └─,QDWELL=mm─┘
──┬─────────────┬──┬───────────┬──┬────────────────┬──────────────
└─,REPRMPT=mm─┘ └─,RETRY=mm─┘ └─,SCAN=function─┘
──┬──────────┬──┬────────────┬───────────────────────────────────
└─,SPAN=hh─┘ └─,TIME=hhmm─┘
Where:
DATE
Used with PERSTART to cause schedule scan to go back and repeat functions that
were performed on a previous date. This is useful in a recovery situation to cause
work that may have been lost to again be brought into the queues. A system clock
error which caused work to be skipped can also be handled in this manner. DATE is
optional but, when specified, must be the beginning Julian date for which schedule
scan functions are to be performed.
Note: If the date needs to be set forward (future), an SSCAN command with
TIME=0, must be entered followed by another SSCAN command with
DATE=0, PERSTART=hhmm before the SSCAN command with the future
date.
INCR
Changes the time interval to elapse between schedule scan wake-ups. The INCR
value must not be greater than the SPAN value.
Size/Type: 1 to 2 numeric characters from 1 to 24 hours
Required: No
LEADTM
Specifies a number of minutes to be added globally to the schedule times of all the
work entering the queue. If 0 is specified, no change is made to the scheduled times
for the work.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters from 0 to 1440
Default: 0
Required: No
Note: Does not apply to preprocessing work or demanded jobs.
PEREND
Used with PERSTART and DATE to set an ending time for schedule scan functions.
Must be the time-of-day desired in the hhmm format. When PEREND is used, the
automatic wake-up of schedule scan is disabled. The SSCAN,SCAN=SCH command
or a startup of CA-7 must be used to force schedule scan to run. After schedule scan
is complete, automatic wake-up is still disabled. This allows another PEREND time
to be entered, if necessary. To resume automatic wake-up of schedule scan, use
SSCAN,TIME= specifying a time when schedule scan is to wake-up. A new field
appears under NEXT SCAN PERIOD START TIME when this parameter is in
effect.
PERSTART
Used with DATE to set schedule scan functions back to a previous time. Must be
the time-of-day desired in hhmm format.
QDWELL
Specifies an additional number of minutes to be added to the lead time, as an addi-
tional safety factor, to ensure that scheduling requirements can be met between the
queue entry and deadline times.
Size/Type: 1 to 2 numeric characters from 1 to 59 minutes
Required: No
REPRMPT
Specifies a number of minutes to elapse between a prompt message and each subse-
quent reprompt. If REPRMPT=0, the reprompt function of schedule scan is sus-
pended.
Size/Type: 1 to 2 numeric characters from 1 to 59 minutes
Required: No
RETRY
Specifies a number of minutes between wake-ups for reattempting to attach JCL and
requirements for jobs in RETRY status. Jobs are in RETRY status when a dynamic
allocation (SVC99) failure occurs during scheduling (that is, date schedules, triggers
or DEMAND commands). If 0 (zero) is specified, the RETRY function is sus-
pended.
Size/Type: 1 to 2 numeric characters from 1 to 59 minutes
Required: No
SCAN
Indicates the type of schedule scan function to be performed.
Required: No
ABR
Abbreviates the format of initial requirements scan output and prompt messages.
ARF
Causes posting of the ARF dispatcher.
COM
Forces a completion processing cycle to run and check for completed jobs.
HLD
Forces all jobs to be placed in CA-7 hold status as they enter the queue. Jobs
must then be released on a job-by-job basis. The effect of SCAN=HLD may be
disabled by SCAN=REL.
LNG
Restores the normal format of initial requirements scan output and prompt mes-
sages.
REL
Disables the effect of a previous SCAN=HLD.
REP
Forces immediate reprompting for jobs and workstation activities which are late.
RET
Forces a skeleton retry cycle. See the RETRY parameter for more information
on RETRY.
SCH
Forces schedule scan to run and add more work to the queues. This function
activates schedule scan if it is not active.
SPAN
Changes the number of hours which schedule scan is to look forward, during each
wake-up, for jobs that must be added to the queue. The SPAN value must not be
less than the INCR value.
Size/Type: 1 to 2 numeric characters from 1 to 24 hours
Required: No
TIME
Specifies the next wake-up time-of-day for schedule scan to bring jobs into the
queues. This value is normally determined by adding the INCR value to the previous
scan. If 0 is specified for TIME, this function of schedule scan is disabled. If the
time specified is less than the current time, the next day is assumed.
Required: No
hhmm
Is the time-of-day where hh represents hours (0 to 24) and mm represents
minutes (0 to 59).
All values identified by keywords can be reviewed by entering SSCAN with no parame-
ters.
2.169.3 Examples
SSCAN,SCAN=REP,REPRMPT=5
SSCAN,QDWELL=33
SSCAN,SPAN=3,INCR=2
SSCAN,TIME=1933
< SSCAN
=
CURRENT SCHEDULE SCAN VALUES
----------------------------
K L
2.170 START
Use the START top line command to resume normal job flow in the request and ready
queues after a previous STOP command was issued to halt job flow. A START
command is required to reestablish normal queue activity following a STOP command.
2.170.1 Syntax
START
──START──,Q=─┬─ALL─┬────────────────────────────────────────────
├─RDY─┤
└─REQ─┘
Where:
Q
Identifies the queue(s) to be restarted after a previous STOP command was issued.
Required: Yes
ALL
Causes both the request and ready queues to be restarted.
RDY
Causes the ready queue to be restarted.
REQ
Causes the request queue to be restarted.
2.170.2 Examples
START,Q=REQ
START,Q=RDY
START,Q=ALL
2.171 STOP
Use the STOP top line command to temporarily suspend normal job movement in either
the request or ready queues, or both.
2.171.1 Syntax
STOP
──STOP──,Q=─┬─ALL─┬─────────────────────────────────────────────
├─RDY─┤
└─REQ─┘
Where:
Q
Identifies the queue(s) to be suspended. Queues may be restarted with the START
command.
Required: Yes
ALL
Causes both the request and ready queues to be suspended.
RDY
Causes the ready queue to be suspended.
REQ
Causes the request queue to be suspended.
Stopping the ready queue prevents submission of any jobs for execution on the CPU(s).
Movement of jobs into the ready queue continues normally unless the request queue is
also stopped.
2.171.3 Examples
STOP,Q=REQ
STOP,Q=RDY
STOP,Q=ALL
2.172 SUBMIT
Use the SUBMIT top line command to modify and expedite the process of job sub-
mission for jobs which already reside in the queues. This may be accomplished in two
ways:
All outstanding input requirements for the specified jobs may be posted as satisfied.
Optionally, by specifying EXPRESS=YES, a priority may be set for a specific job,
ensuring that the job is submitted ahead of other jobs also ready for submission.
2.172.1 Syntax
SUBMIT
──SUBMIT──┬────────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──────────────────
└─,JOB=jobnumber─┘ └─,EXPRESS=YES─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the CA-7 job number of the job whose requirements are to be posted as
satisfied.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: No
EXPRESS
Indicates the job is to be placed ahead of all other jobs (those without
EXPRESS=YES) for submission. Must be coded as shown. Not valid if workload
balancing is being used. Use of EXPRESS=YES does not establish an increased
execution priority for a job. Rather, it ensures that nonexpress jobs are not submitted
ahead of a job flagged as an express job.
Required: No
Note: If no keywords are specified, CA-7 job submission is activated, and if CA-11 is
used, it verifies that the interface is still active. If the interface is not active, then
a WTOR is issued. CA-7 is in a wait state until the operator replies.
2.172.2 Examples
SUBMIT,JOB=163
SUBMIT,JOB=163,EXPRESS=YES
SUBMIT
2.173 SUBSCH
Use the SUBSCH top line command to adjust schedules to advance the overall processing
of the system. A user-supplied increment of up to 24 hours can be subtracted from the
scheduled start and due-out times. This command can establish earlier deadlines for the
start and due-out times of one or all jobs in a queue. This is only possible after the job
or workstation activity has entered the queue.
2.173.1 Syntax
SUBSCH
──SUBSCH──,──┬─JOB=─┬─nnnn─┬──┬──,TIME=mmmm─────────────────────
│ ├─ALL──┤ │
│ └─ALLP─┘ │
└─REF=nnnnrrs────┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job(s) for which schedule times are to be adjusted.
Required: Yes, unless REF is used
nnnn
CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
ALL
All jobs in the request, ready, and postprocess queues.
ALLP
All jobs including those in the preprocess queue.
REF
Specifies a particular workstation network task within a network and all subsequent
stations for which schedules are to be adjusted. Reference numbers may be obtained
by using the LPRE or LPOST commands.
Required: Yes, unless JOB is used
nnnnrrs
Is the workstation reference number assigned by CA-7.
nnnn
CA-7 job number. Leading zeros may be omitted.
rr
Relative network sequence for this job number. Leading zeros may not be
omitted.
s
Relative station position within the network. The first station is position 1.
TIME
The amount of time to be subtracted from the deadline start and due-out times of the
job(s) or workstation(s) indicated.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters from 1 to 1440
Required: Yes
When SUBSCH is used to adjust schedules, prompting is based on the adjusted deadline
start and due-out times.
To delay schedule times, see 2.39, “ADDSCH” on page 2-78. The XUPD screen may
also be used to perform this function for individual jobs from a 3270 terminal.
The use of SUBSCH has no effect on when a job is submitted but can make a job show
as "late" earlier.
2.173.3 Examples
SUBSCH,JOB=143,TIME=123
SUBSCH,JOB=ALLP,TIME=723
SUBSCH,REF=12311,TIME=633
2.174 SUBTM
This function is available through the 2.146, “QM.3 CPU Job Attributes Prompt Screen”
on page 2-442 and can be satisfied through the 2.144, “QM.1 CPU Jobs Status Prompt
Screen” on page 2-430.
Use the SUBTM command to modify the required submit time-of-day for a CPU job in
the request queue. These modifications are permitted:
Add a specific submit time requirement where none was previously defined.
Remove a defined submit time requirement.
Change an existing submit time requirement to either earlier or later than defined.
2.174.1 Syntax
SUBTM
──SUBTM──,JOB=jobnumber──┬────────────┬─────────────────────────
└─,TIME=hhmm─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the CA-7 assigned job number of the job for which a submit time-of-day
requirement is to be added, modified, or removed.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes
TIME
Specifies the new submit time-of-day in hours and minutes. TIME is required to add
a submit time-of-day requirement if none exists or to change an existing requirement.
If TIME is omitted, an existing submit time-of-day restriction is removed.
Required: No
hhmm
Is the time-of-day where hh is hours (0 to 24) and mm is minutes (0 to 59).
Maximum is 2400.
If the value given is less than the current time (when the command is processed), the
submit day is incremented by one.
2.174.2 Examples
SUBTM,JOB=163
SUBTM,JOB=163,TIME=1833
2.175 TIQ
If you have CA-1 installed on your system, you can use the TIQ command to directly
interact with CA-1. See the CA-7 Interfaces Guide for more information on the
CA-7/CA-1 interface and the TIQ command.
2.176 TRIG
Use the TRIG command to cause index entries to be reviewed and, if needed, update
cross-reference pointers to the following database elements:
JDEP Entries for jobs which trigger other jobs.
AUTO Entries for data sets and input networks which trigger jobs.
TRGD Entries for jobs that are triggered by other jobs, networks, or data sets.
If necessary, TRGD entries are created, modified, or deleted according to existing JDEP
and AUTO entries.
2.176.1 Syntax
TRIG
──TRIG──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
2.176.3 Examples
< TRIG =
DATE=yy.ddd CA-7 TRIG ANALYZE REPORT PAGE NO. 3331
THE TRGD INDEX ENTRIES FOR THE FOLLOWING JOBS ARE NEWLY CREATED:
NONE
THE TRGD INDEX ENTRIES FOR THE FOLLOWING JOBS ARE MODIFIED:
APJ233 APJ333 APJ331 APJ332 APJ353 APJ433 APJ413
APJ411 APJ412 APJ413 APJ533 APJ531 APJ532 APJ633
BRCOMM33 BRCOMM34 BZPR331 BZPR431 BZPR531 DEAMREST HEGENER1
HEGENER2 HEGENER5 HEGENER6 IFACTVTY IFCSBKP1 IFCSFLMO IFCSTSTM
IFCS333 IFCS333H IFCS333L IFCS355 IFCS363 IFCS373 IFCS373Q
IFCS514 IFCS514H IFCS613 IFCS633 IFCS6332 IFCS643 IFCS663C
UDENSPEC UDENSUSP UDEN183 UDEN923 UDEN921 UDEN928 UDEN929
UDEN931 UDEN933 UDJOEM WLPR331 WLPR431 WLPR531
THE TRGD INDEX ENTRIES FOR THE FOLLOWING JOBS ARE DELETED:
TGAB TGAC TGAD TGAE TGAF
2.177 UNC
Use the UNC command to uncatalog a data set. This function is available on the UT
Menu screen as FUNCTION value 5 or on any other menu or formatted screen as FUNC-
TION value UT.5.
2.177.1 Syntax
UNC
──UNC──,DSN=dsname──┬──────────────┬────────────────────────────
└─,CVOL=volume─┘
Where:
DSN
Indicates the fully qualified name of the data set which is to be uncataloged. A
relative generation request may be made for a generation data set. After uncata-
loging the data set, its index is deleted if it is no longer being used by other data
sets.
Size/Type: 1 to 44 alphanumeric characters
Required: Yes
CVOL
Indicates the volume containing the catalog.
Size/Type: 1 to 6 alphanumeric characters
Default: SYSRES volume
Required: No
2.177.2 Examples
UNC,DSN=USER.FILE1
UNC,DSN=USER.GDG(+3)
UNC,DSN=USER.FILE2,CVOL=ALTCAT
2.178 UT
Use the CA-7 Utilities Menu screen to obtain the online menu of available utility func-
tions.
< =
--------------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES MENU -----------------------------
FUNCTION ===>
DATASET SEARCH:
13 - FIND DSN ON DASD
K L
To display, enter:
UT as a top line command.
UT as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
Each function on the screen has an equivalent top line command. Each selection on the
menu screen receives the same security validation as its equivalent top line command.
Menu functions and their equivalent CA-7 top line commands are as follows:
1 - AL/ALC 11 - ALLOC
2 - CAT 12 - DEALLOC
3 - RENAME 13 - DMPDSCB
4 - SCRATCH/SCRATCHP 14 - LISTDIR
5 - UNC 15 - MAP
6 - BLDG 16 - SPACE
7 - DLTX 17 - DMPDSN
8 - CONN 18 - DMPCAT
9 - DCONN 19 - LOC
13 - FIND
A formatted function screen is returned for each function by entering the appropriate
FUNCTION value and pressing Enter. Details of those screens are given in the fol-
lowing discussions.
2.178.2 PF Keys
Once a function has been selected on the menu and the function screen is displayed,
program function key 3, PF3 is temporarily set to return to the UT menu screen. In
native CA-7 VTAM mode, any value that was previously assigned to PF3, by either the
user or CA-7, is temporarily ignored as long as the function screen is being used and
reverts back to the original value after it is used once or after a top line command is
entered.
PF7 and PF8 are similarly temporarily overridden to /PAGE-1 and /PAGE+1 respectively
until PF3 is pressed or a top line command is issued.
Use this screen to allocate and optionally catalog a DASD data set.
< =
-------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - ALLOCATE DATASET ----------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
VOLSER: (BOTH DSNAME AND VOLSER ARE REQUIRED)
SPACE ALLOCATION:
TYPE: (C=CYL, DEFAULT IS T=TRK)
PRIMARY: (REQUIRED, UP TO 5 DIGITS)
SECONDARY: (OPTIONAL, UP TO 4 DIGITS)
DIR BLOCKS: (FOR PDS ONLY, UP TO 4 DIGITS)
DCB INFORMATION:
RECFM: (REQUIRED, E.G., FB, ETC.)
LRECL: (REQUIRED, UP TO 5 DIGITS)
BLKSIZE: (REQUIRED, UP TO 5 DIGITS)
K L
To display, enter:
1 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.1 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.1 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line AL/ALC command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
< =
--------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - CATALOG DATASET -----------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED)
K L
To display, enter:
2 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.2 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.2 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line CAT command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
VOLSER 2
VOLSER 3
VOLSER 4
VOLSER 5
Up to 5 volumes on which the data set resides. At least one VOLSER is
required.
UNIT NAME
Unit name of the type of device on which the data set resides. The unit
name must be defined in SASSUTBL. (For example, 3350, DISK, SYSDA.)
This field must be omitted if DEVICE field is used; otherwise, it is required.
DEVICE Hexadecimal device code similar to those defined in SASSUTBL. This field
must be omitted if UNIT NAME field is used; otherwise, it is required.
FILE SEQ
Label sequence number. If omitted, 0 (zero) is assumed for DASD and 1 is
assumed for tape data sets.
Required: No
CVOL VOLSER containing the catalog.
Default: SYSRES
< =
--------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - RENAME DATASET -----------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED)
NEW
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED)
K L
To display, enter:
3 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.3 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.3 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line RENAME command, this screen is
returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
< =
--------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - SCRATCH DATASET -----------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(FULLY-QUALIFIED SPECIFIC NAME)
K L
To display, enter:
4 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.4 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.4 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with top line SCRATCH or SCRATCHP this screen is
returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
< =
-------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - UNCATALOG DATASET ----------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(FULLY-QUALIFIED SPECIFIC NAME)
K L
To display, enter:
5 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.5 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.5 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line UNC command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Use this screen to build an index for a generation data group (GDG).
< =
--------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - BUILD GDG INDEX ----------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
INDEX:
(REQUIRED, FULL INDEX NAME)
NUMBER OF
ENTRIES: (CATALOG ENTRIES, REQUIRED, UP TO 3 DIGITS, MAX 255)
DELETE
WHEN FULL: (A = ALL ENTRIES, DEFAULT = ONLY OLDEST ENTRY)
K L
To display, enter:
6 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.6 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.6 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line BLDG command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
This screen does not support VSAM or ICF catalogs because the IEHPROGM-type func-
tion uses an older form of catalog interface. Only CVOL catalogs are supported at this
time.
< =
---------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - DELETE INDEX ------------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
INDEX:
(REQUIRED, FULL INDEX NAME)
K L
To display, enter:
7 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.7 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.7 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line DLTX command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
This screen does not support VSAM or ICF catalogs because the IEHPROGM-type func-
tion uses an older form of catalog interface. Only CVOL catalogs are supported at this
time.
Use this screen to connect high-level indexes from the SYSRES catalog to another
catalog.
< =
-------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - CONNECT A CATALOG ---------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
8 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.8 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.8 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line CONN command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
This screen does not support VSAM or ICF catalogs because the IEHPROGM-type func-
tion uses an older form of catalog interface. Only CVOL catalogs are supported at this
time.
Use this screen to disconnect high-level indexes from the SYSRES catalog.
< =
------------------ CA-7 UTILITIES - DISCONNECT A CATALOG --------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
9 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.9 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.9 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line DCONN command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
This screen does not support VSAM or ICF catalogs because the IEHPROGM-type func-
tion uses an older form of catalog interface. Only CVOL catalogs are supported at this
time.
Use this screen to search DASD volumes for copies of a given data set.
< =
-------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - FIND DSN ON DASD -----------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(FULLY-QUALIFIED SPECIFIC NAME)
K L
To display, enter:
10 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.10 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.10 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line FIND command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Up to 40 occurrences of the data set are shown in the body of the screen in
VOLSER/YY.DDD format. The YY.DDD indicates the Julian date the data set was
created on for that particular VOLSER.
If more than 40 occurrences are found, a message indicates that is the case. To see more
than the 40 occurrences listed on the screen, enter the request as a top line FIND
command. A different display is returned listing each occurrence.
Use this screen to allocate a DASD volume not defined by a U7xxxxxx DD statement in
the CA-7 JCL.
< =
-------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - ALLOCATE VOLUME ------------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
VOLSER: (REQUIRED)
K L
To display, enter:
11 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.11 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.11 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line ALLOC command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Use this screen to deallocate a DASD volume previously allocated with function 11 on
the UT Menu screen or with a top line ALLOC command.
< =
-------------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - DEALLOCATE VOLUME ---------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
VOLSER: (REQUIRED)
K L
To display, enter:
12 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.12 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.12 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line DEALLOC command, this screen is
returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Use this screen to display the Format 1 data set control block (DSCB) for a given data
set.
< =
------------------ CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY FORMAT 1 DSCB --------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED)
K L
The following display shows the VOLSER value even if it was not entered originally.
Below the two heading lines, the 101 bytes beginning at offset hex '2C' in the DSCB are
shown in both hexadecimal and character form. The PROGRAM value at the bottom of
the screen indicates UTL1 since that module accessed and formatted the DSCB informa-
tion.
< =
------------------ CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY FORMAT 1 DSCB --------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME: SYS2.PROCLIB
(REQUIRED)
K L
To display, enter:
13 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.13 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.13 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line DMPDSCB command, this screen is
returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
< =
----------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY DIRECTORY INFO --------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED)
K L
To display, enter:
14 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.14 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.14 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line LISTDIR command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
< =
------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY DATASET ATTRIBUTES MAP ---------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED; SPECIFIC NAME, GENERIC NAME, RELATIVE GDG OR M)
K L
To display, enter:
15 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.15 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.15 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line MAP command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Use this screen to display available space information for volumes available to CA-7.
< =
-------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY AVAILABLE DASD SPACE -----------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
K L
To display, enter:
16 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.16 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.16 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line SPACE command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Use this screen to display physical records from a given data set or a PDS directory.
< =
-------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY PHYSICAL DATA RECORDS ---------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED)
RELATIVE
RECORD
NUMBER: (UP TO 4 DIGITS)
K L
To display, enter:
17 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.17 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.17 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line DMPDSN command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Use this screen to display the first catalog block for a given data set.
< =
------------------ CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY CATALOG BLOCK --------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED)
K L
To display, enter:
18 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.18 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.18 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line DMPCAT command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
Use this screen to display catalog entries for one or more data sets.
< =
----------------- CA-7 UTILITIES - DISPLAY CATALOG ENTRIES ------------------
FUNCTION ===> (LEAVE BLANK TO EXCEPT TO TRANSFER)
DSNAME:
(REQUIRED; SPECIFIC NAME, GENERIC NAME OR RELATIVE GDG)
K L
To display, enter:
19 as the FUNCTION on the UT screen.
UT.19 as the FUNCTION on any other menu or formatted input screen.
UT.19 as a top line command.
If an error is encountered with a top line LOC command, this screen is returned.
To exit:
Position the cursor to the top line and enter a CA-7 command.
Provide the name of some other menu or formatted input screen in the FUNCTION
field.
See 2.178.2, “PF Keys” on page 2-525 for other options.
A generic request for data sets whose catalog entries are in the master catalog receive the
message that the data set is not found. This is a restriction of SVC 26 which is used to
process this command.
2.198 VERIFY
Use the VERIFY command to establish or satisfy a manual verification requirement for a
currently scheduled run of the job in the request queue prior to its execution. A verifica-
tion requirement is established for the currently scheduled run to ensure completion of
some unusual activity prior to job submission. Under ordinary circumstances, the data-
base maintenance DB.1 screen is used to establish a verification requirement through the
VERIFY field. The #VER control statement can also be used for this purpose.
2.198.1 Syntax
VERIFY
──VERIFY──,JOB=jobnumber──,SET=─┬─ON──┬─────────────────────────
└─OFF─┘
Where:
JOB
Specifies the CA-7 assigned job number of the job for which a verification require-
ment is to be established or satisfied.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
Required: Yes
SET
Sets the verification requirement.
Required: Yes
ON
Establishes a manual verification requirement which did not previously exist.
OFF
Indicates a previously established manual verification requirement is satisfied and
may be removed. A verification requirement no longer appears on the require-
ments list in the request queue.
2.198.2 Examples
VERIFY,JOB=163,SET=ON
VERIFY,JOB=163,SET=OFF
2.199 XPOST
Use the XPOST top line command to return a screen which lists output network entries
from the postprocess queue. The screen which is returned allows you to update the
screen information. Perform logging in by entering a function code for the appropriate
screen entry and pressing Enter. See also 2.205, “XSPOST” on page 2-581.
This function is available through 2.150, “QM.7 Output Networks Prompt Screen” on
page 2-459.
2.199.1 Syntax
XPOST XSPOST
──┬─XPOST──┬──┬────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬───────
└─XSPOST─┘ └─,FILL=function─┘ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘ └─,STN=─┼─station──┼──┘
└─network#─┘ └─station#─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M──────┐ │
└─,SUBID=─┼─subid──┼──┘
└─subid#─┘
Where:
XPOST
Lists output workstation network entries.
XSPOST
Same as XPOST, but abbreviates and lists twice as many entries on the screen.
FILL
Identifies a character that is to be inserted in the function field which precedes each
entry on the formatted screen when the screen is initially formatted for display. This
facilitates performing the same function for many networks. See 2.150, “QM.7
Output Networks Prompt Screen” on page 2-459 for a discussion of the available
values and how they are used.
JOB
Indicates the job(s) for which the list of postprocess queue records is desired. Up to
17 entries are listed per screen for the XPOST command.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all job names.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number or a range of job numbers specified as
nnnn-nnnn.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
NW
Identifies the network(s) for which records are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all networks.
network
Indicates a specific network name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
network*
Indicates a generic type request.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
STN
Identifies the station(s) for which records are to be listed. The default is all logical
terminal names connected to the physical terminal which issued the request. For
example, logical terminals BALANCE and DECOLLAT are assigned to physical ter-
minal HTERM1. If XPOST was entered from HTERM1, all postprocess queue
records for stations BALANCE and DECOLLAT would be displayed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all logical terminal names connected to the physical terminal where the
XPOST command is entered.
station
Indicates a specific station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
station*
Indicates a generic type request.
SUBID
Identifies the sub-IDs for which records are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all sub-IDs.
subid
Indicates a specific sub-ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
subid*
Indicates a generic type request.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
The display continues to reflect the queue entries at the time of the initial request. It may
be necessary to reissue the original request to get an updated display.
2.199.3 Examples
XPOST,STN=M
XSPOST,JOB=DUSAXM
XPOST,JOB=DUSAMRUN,FILL=I
2.200 XPRE
Use the XPRE top line command to return a screen which lists Input Network entries
from the preprocess queue and allow the user to update that network information.
Logging in or logging out can be performed by entering a function code for the appro-
priate screen entry and pressing Enter. This command may also be used for prompting
workstations and interrupting and resuming a network. See also 2.206, “XSPRE” on
page 2-582.
This function is available through 2.149, “QM.6 Input Networks Prompt Screen” on
page 2-453.
2.200.1 Syntax
XPRE XSPRE
──┬─XPRE──┬──┬────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬────────
└─XSPRE─┘ └─,FILL=function─┘ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │
└─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬────────────────────┬──┬─────────────────────┬─────────────────
│ ┌─M────────┐ │ │ ┌─M────────┐ │
└─,NW=─┼─network──┼──┘ └─,STN=─┼─station──┼──┘
└─network#─┘ └─station#─┘
──┬─────────────────────┬────────────────────────────────────────
│ ┌─M──────┐ │
└─,SUBID=─┼─subid──┼──┘
└─subid#─┘
Where:
XPRE
Lists input workstation network entries.
XSPRE
Same as XPRE, but abbreviates and lists twice as many entries on the screen.
FILL
Identifies a character to be inserted in the function field which precedes each entry
on the formatted screen when the screen is initially formatted for display. This facil-
itates performing the same function for many networks. See 2.149, “QM.6 Input
Networks Prompt Screen” on page 2-453 for a discussion of the available values for
FILL and how they are used.
JOB
Indicates the job(s) for which the list of preprocess queue records is desired. Up to
17 entries are listed per screen for the XPRE screen.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all job names in the preprocess queue.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number or a range of job numbers specified as
nnnn-nnnn.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
NW
Identifies the network(s) for which records are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all networks.
network
Indicates a specific network name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
network*
Indicates a generic type request.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
STN
Identifies the station(s) for which records are to be listed. The default is all logical
terminal names connected to the physical terminal which issued the request. For
example, logical terminals KEYPUNCH and VERIFY are assigned to physical ter-
minal HTERM1. If XPRE was entered from HTERM1, all preprocess queue records
for stations KEYPUNCH and VERIFY would be displayed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all logical terminal names.
station
Indicates a specific station name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
station*
Indicates a generic type request.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
SUBID
Identifies the sub-IDs for which records are to be listed.
Default: *
Required: No
*
Indicates all sub-IDs.
subid
Indicates a specific sub-ID.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
subid*
Indicates a generic type request.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
The display continues to reflect the queue entries at the time of the initial request. It may
be necessary to reissue the original request to get an updated display.
2.200.3 Examples
XPRE,NW=KEYPM,FILL=C
XSPRE,JOB=TESTM
Use the XQ, XQJ, XQN, and XQM commands display jobs in the request, ready or
active queues and allow the status of those jobs to be updated. The CANCEL, HOLD,
RELEASE, and REQUEUE command functions, in addition to others, can also be per-
formed on the XQ, XQJ, XQN, and XQM screens with a single function character. It is
also possible to transfer from any of these screens to the XRST screen if a job requires a
restart. These commands are valid only from online 3270 type terminals. Each
command provides a different display sequence as follows:
XQ Lists the jobs in the order in which they occur in the queue.
XQJ Lists the jobs in job name sequence.
XQN Lists the jobs in CA-7 job number sequence.
XQM Lists the jobs in job name sequence with a requirements summary. (LIST=ANY
is the default for XQM. This is different from the other XQ screens where
LIST=ALL is the default.)
Some requirements can be satisfied directly on these screens. Control can also be passed
to other screens such as XRQ and XUPD, from which control functions can be per-
formed.
This function is available through 2.144, “QM.1 CPU Jobs Status Prompt Screen” on
page 2-430.
2.201.1 Syntax
XQ XQJ XQN XQM
──┬─XQ──┬──┬────────────────┬──┬──────────────────────┬──────────
├─XQJ─┤ └─,FILL=function─┘ │ ┌─M─────────┐ │
├─XQN─┤ └─,JOB=─┼─jobname───┼──┘
└─XQM─┘ ├─jobname#──┤
└─jobnumber─┘
──┬───────────────┬──┬──────────────┬──┬────────────────────┬────
└─,LIST=options─┘ │ ┌─REQ─┐ │ └─,SEQ=─┬─ENTRY───┬──┘
└─,Q=─┼─RDY─┼──┘ ├─NUMBER──┤
└─ACT─┘ └─JOBNAME─┘
Where:
XQ
Lists the jobs in the order in which they occur in the queue.
XQJ
Lists the jobs in job name sequence.
XQN
Lists the jobs in CA-7 job number sequence.
XQM
Lists the jobs in job name sequence with a requirements summary.
FILL
Identifies the character to be inserted in the function fields when the formatted screen
is initially displayed. This option facilitates performing the same function for many
jobs. See 2.144, “QM.1 CPU Jobs Status Prompt Screen” on page 2-430 for a dis-
cussion of the available values for FILL and how they are used.
JOB
Indicates the job(s) for which information is to be listed from the request, ready, and
active queues.
Required: No
Default: *
*
Indicates all jobs.
jobname
Indicates a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobname*
Indicates a generic job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 7 alphanumeric characters terminated with an asterisk
jobnumber
Indicates a specific CA-7 job number or a range of job numbers specified as
nnnn-nnnn.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
Specifies the outstanding requirements selection criteria.
ALL
List all jobs regardless of outstanding requirements. This is the default for XQ,
XQJ, and XQN.
ANY
List only those jobs with at least one requirement. This is the default for XQM.
BINT
List only those jobs which have internal data set requirements, but no unsatisfied
job requirements.
EXT
List only those jobs with external data set requirements.
HLD
List only those jobs with a hold requirement.
INT
List only those jobs with internal data set requirements.
JCLO
List only those jobs with a JCL override requirement.
JOB
List only those jobs with job requirements.
NWK
List only those jobs with network requirements.
REST
List only those jobs in restart status.
SKEL
List only those jobs in skeleton status.
SUB
List only those jobs with submit-time requirements.
USR
List only those jobs with user requirements.
VER
List only those jobs with a verify requirement.
Q
Identifies the queue for which jobs are to be listed.
Default: REQ
Required: No
ACT
Specifies the active queue.
RDY
Specifies the ready queue.
REQ
Specifies the request queue.
SEQ
Indicates the sequence that the jobs should be listed in. You can use this option to
change the default sequence for the XQM command (default is job name sequence).
ENTRY
Lists jobs in the order in which they occur in the queue.
JOBNAME
Lists jobs in job name sequence.
NUMBER
Lists jobs in CA-7 job number sequence.
The XQM command results in the QM.1-M screen display with the job name and a
summary of the outstanding requirements for each job. See 2.144.3, “QM.1-M CPU Job
Requirements” on page 2-435 for an example.
2.201.3 Examples
XQ
XQ,JOB=DUSAM
XQJ
XQJ,Q=ACT
XQN
XQN,JOB=12-17,FILL=C
XQM,LIST=INT
2.202 XREF
Use the XREF command to indicate that all data set and/or network entries are to be
analyzed for incomplete using-job references.
2.202.1 Syntax
XREF
──XREF──┬────────────────┬──┬───────────────────┬───────────────
│ ┌─AL─┐ │ │ ┌─NO──┐ │
└─,TYPE=─┼─DS─┼──┘ └─,UPDATE=─┴─YES─┴──┘
└─NW─┘
Where:
TYPE
Specifies the type of entries to be reviewed.
Default: AL
Required: No
AL
Indicates both network and data set entries (ALL) are to be reviewed.
DS
Indicates data set entries.
NW
Indicates network entries.
UPDATE
Specifies whether any updates are to be made to the database for incomplete refer-
ences.
Default: NO
Required: No
NO
Specifies no updates are to be made to the database.
YES
Specifies updates are to be made to the database in addition to being listed.
Note: UPDATE=YES is valid only with TYPE=NW or TYPE=AL.
2.203 XRQ
Use the XRQ command to display the requirements of a job in the request queue for
possible updating. This command is valid online only. Job requirements that have been
satisfied are shown with a prefix of X on the returned XRQ screen. Requirements may
be posted or unposted with the screen.
The XRQ screen may be accessed from the XQ, XQJ, XQN, or XQM screens.
This function is available through 2.145, “QM.2 CPU Job Predecessors Prompt Screen”
on page 2-438.
2.203.1 Syntax
XRQ
──XRQ──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬───┬───────────┬──────────────────────
└─jobnumber─┘ └─,LIST=ALL─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies a request queue job for which requirements are to be listed.
Required: Yes
jobname
Specifies a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Specifies a CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
LIST
If specified, all requirements are listed. Those that are satisfied are prefixed by an X.
Default: List only requirements not satisfied
Required: No
2.203.2 Examples
XRQ,JOB=DUSAXX31
XRQ,JOB=5,LIST=ALL
2.204 XRST
Use the XRST top line command to display the restart (QM.4) screen for a particular job.
A job must be in restart status to use this screen. The user can initially schedule a job
for restart processing using TYPE=RES on the DEMAND command.
The QM.4 screen may also be accessed from the XQ, XQJ, XQN, or XQM screen.
This function is available through 2.147, “QM.4 CPU Job In Restart Status Prompt
Screen” on page 2-446 where the available functions are discussed.
2.204.1 Syntax
XRST
──XRST──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬─────────────────────────────────────
└─jobnumber─┘
Where:
JOB
Identifies the job to be displayed.
Required: Yes
jobname
Specifies a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Specifies a CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
When CA-11 is installed and the interface for automatic CMT updating is installed, CA-7
attempts to use the QM.4 screen fields to update the CMT directly before submitting the
job. See the CA-7 Interfaces Guide for information on installing the interface for CA-11
and for further discussion related to CA-11.
2.205 XSPOST
The XSPOST command has the same function as the QM.7 screen and the XPOST
command. However, it lists up to 34 postprocess queue entries per screen in "2- up"
format. See 2.150, “QM.7 Output Networks Prompt Screen” on page 2-459 and the
2.199, “XPOST” on page 2-568 for discussions of options and format.
2.206 XSPRE
The XSPRE command has the same function as the QM.6 screen and the XPRE
command. However, it lists up to 34 preprocess queue entries per screen in "2-up"
format. See 2.149, “QM.6 Input Networks Prompt Screen” on page 2-453 and the 2.200,
“XPRE” on page 2-571 for discussions of options and format.
2.207 XUPD
Use the XUPD command to display job type queue records for jobs in the request queue.
This command is valid only from an online 3270 type terminal. Any of the job charac-
teristics appearing on the screen can be modified by positioning the cursor at the appro-
priate field and entering a new value. Updates are for one run only. They do not change
information in the CA-7 database. The characteristics displayed can be reviewed and/or
permanently changed with the DB.1 screen.
This function is available through 2.146, “QM.3 CPU Job Attributes Prompt Screen” on
page 2-442.
2.207.1 Syntax
XUPD
──XUPD──,JOB=─┬─jobname───┬─────────────────────────────────────
└─jobnumber─┘
Where:
JOB
Indicates the job to be listed from the request queue.
Required: Yes
jobname
Specifies a specific job name.
Size/Type: 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters
jobnumber
Specifies a CA-7 job number.
Size/Type: 1 to 4 numeric characters
2.207.3 Examples
XUPD,JOB=DUSAXX31
XUPD,JOB=12
2.208 XWLB
Use the XWLB command, included in the workload balancing facility, for making tempo-
rary changes in selection parameters. You can view existing workload balancing values
with the LWLB screen.
2.208.1 Syntax
XWLB
──XWLB──────────────────────────────────────────────────────────
A formatted screen results from this command, displaying the current parameters.
Changes can be made by positioning the cursor to the desired field. These changes are
only temporary. They remain in effect until either another load module is called or they
are changed again using this screen. Permanent changes to selection parameters require
regeneration of the macros.
< XWLB
=
MOD: UCC7RDFL --CLASS BAR AND USE--
CL BAR USE CL BAR USE
----- INITIATORS ----- --------- TAPE DRIVES -------- A: 255 333 S: 255 333
TOT JOBS SUBMITTED 333 NAME: TAPEDR1 TAPEDR2 B: 255 333 T: 255 333
TOT JOBS ACTIVE... 333 CURR IN-USE...... 333 333 C: 255 333 U: 255 333
TOT INITS AVAL.... 313 TOTAL AVAILABLE.. 313 313 D: 255 333 V: 255 333
MIN JOBS MUST RUN. 255 MAX REWARD....... 323 323 E: 255 333 W: 255 333
MAX PENALTY...... 323 323 F: 255 333 X: 255 333
--------- CPU -------- MIN DIFF-TO-SCHED 333 333 G: 255 333 Y: 255 333
CURR %UTL/JOB 333.333 MAX DIFF-TO-SCHED 333 333 H: 255 333 Z: 255 333
IDEAL %UTL/JOB 338 MAX BOOST FOR DTS 333 333 I: 255 333 3: 255 333
MAX REWARD........ 323 MIN ALLOWABLE/JOB 333 333 J: 255 333 1: 255 333
MAX PENALTY....... 323 MAN ALLOWABLE/JOB 255 255 K: 255 333 2: 255 333
TOT MAX ALLOWABLE 312 312 L: 255 333 3: 255 333
----- START TIME ----- M: 255 333 4: 255 333
MAX REWARD........ 323 ----- THRESHOLD PRIORITY ----- N: 255 333 5: 255 333
MAX PENALTY....... 323 DEFAULT THRESHOLD JOB PRTY 133 O: 255 333 6: 255 333
MAX LATE (HRS).... 312 SPECIAL CLASS #1 CL PRT P: 255 333 7: 255 333
MAX EARLY(HRS).... 312 SPECIAL CLASS #2 CL PRT Q: 255 333 8: 255 333
RUN TIME FACTOR... 313 SPECIAL CLASS #3 CL PRT R: 255 333 9: 255 333
PROGRAM: QM63 MSG-INDEX: 33 -- WB.X -- 33.333 / 16:26:14
MESSAGE: CHANGE VALUES OR ENTER A COMMAND ON THE TOP LINE
K L
MAX REWARD Indicates the maximum reward for being late. Must be
numeric and between 0 and 255. Corresponds to MXREW on
STARTIME macro.
MAX PENALTY Indicates the maximum penalty for being early. Corresponds
to MXPEN on STARTIME macro. Must be numeric and
between 0 and 255.
MAX LATE (HRS) Indicates the number of hours the job has to be late to gain the
maximum reward. Corresponds to MXLAT on STARTIME
macro. Must be numeric and between 0 and 12.
MAX EARLY (HRS) Indicates the number of hours the job has to be early to gain
the maximum penalty. Corresponds to MXERL on
STARTIME macro. Must be numeric and between 0 and 12.
RUN TIME FACTOR Indicates the value of the factor to be applied to the runtime of
the job to determine whether the job is to be considered late or
early. Corresponds to RUNTF on STARTIME macro. Must
be numeric and between 0 and 100.
TAPE DRIVES Indicates the lines following this contain information about
TYPE1 and TYPE2 of tape drives. The first value is for
TYPE1 and the second for TYPE2. The input fields under this
heading relate to the specifications for the TAPE1 and TAPE2
macros. No input is allowed for this field.
NAME Indicates the names of the two types of tape drives. Corre-
sponds to NAME specification. Must be alphanumeric, up to 8
characters.
CURR IN-USE Indicates the number of tape drives in use. This is for infor-
mation only and no input is allowed.
TOTAL AVAILABLE Indicates the actual number of tape drives available to CA-7
controlled jobs. Corresponds to TOTAV. Must be numeric
and between 0 and 255.
MAX REWARD Indicates the maximum reward for tape drive use. Corresponds
to MXREW. Must be numeric and between 0 and 255.
MAX PENALTY Indicates the maximum penalty for drive use. Corresponds to
MXPEN. Must be numeric and between 0 and 255.
MIN DIFF-TO-SCHED Indicates the minimum number of tape drives considered diffi-
cult to schedule. Corresponds to MNDTS. Must be numeric
and between 0 and 255.
MAX DIFF-TO-SCHED
Indicates the maximum number of tape drives considered diffi-
cult to schedule. Corresponds to MXDTS. Must be numeric
and between 0 and 255.
Index X-1
CAT command 2-98, 2-529 Commands (continued)
Catalog DEMANDH 2-110
DASD data set 2-80 DIRECT 1-16, 2-116
data set 1-16, 2-98, 2-101 DISPLAY 1-13, 2-14
Dataset screen 2-529 DLTX 2-118, 2-539
CCI terminal interface 2-41 DMDNW
CHANGE command 2-8 and input network activities 2-206
Changing function 1-20
CPUs 2-116, 2-443 syntax and examples 2-119
MAINID of job in queue 1-16, 2-116, 2-443 DMP1 2-26
user's UID security level 2-72 DMPCAT 2-121, 2-562
Changing selection parameters DMPDSCB 2-122, 2-552
RESCHNG 2-476 DMPDSN 2-123, 2-560
WLB 2-73 DUMP 2-27
XWLB 2-585 ECHO 1-13, 2-28
CLOSE command 2-10 FALL 2-125
CMT updating 2-580 FETCH 2-29
Comma FIND 2-129, 2-545
repeat symbol, use in 1-9 FJOB 2-131
Command FLOWD 2-137
examples, keywords 2-1 FLOWL 2-138
format 2-1 FPOST 2-140
Commands FPRE 2-142
ADDRQ 1-16, 2-76 FQALL 2-145
ADDSCH 1-16, 1-20, 2-78 FQJOB 2-148
AL 2-80, 2-526 FQPOST 2-151
ALC 2-80, 2-526 FQPRE 2-153
ALLOC 2-82, 2-547 FQRES 2-155
APA 2-83 FQSTN 2-159
AR.3 2-90 FQTAPE 2-161
ARFP 2-88 FRES 2-163
ARTS 2-89 FRJOB 2-169
ASSIGN 2-2 FRQJOB 2-175
AUTO 2-4 FSTN 2-180
BLDG 2-91 FSTRUC 2-182
BRO 1-13, 2-6 FTAPE 2-185
CALMOD 2-93 FWLP 2-188
CANCEL 1-17, 1-21, 2-94 GRAPHc 2-195
CAT 2-98, 2-529 HELP 2-200
CHANGE 2-8 HOLD
CLOSE 1-13 interrupting and resuming jobs 1-17
function 1-13 interrupting and resuming networks 1-21
setting PF or PA key 2-51 syntax and examples 2-203
syntax and examples 2-10 IN 1-18, 2-205
CONN 2-100, 2-541 IO 1-18, 1-20, 2-211
COPY 1-13, 2-12 JCL 2-30
CTLG 1-16, 2-101 JCLOVRD 1-16, 2-214
DB 2-106 LACT 1-14, 2-216
DCONN 2-108, 2-543 LACTR 1-15, 2-223
DEALLOC 2-109, 2-549 LARF, List ARFSETs 2-227
DEMAND LARFQ, List ARF queue 2-233
controlling schedules 1-16 LCTLG 1-14, 1-20, 2-236
overview, syntax, and examples 2-110
Index X-3
Commands (continued) Corequisite resources 1-17, 2-423
SCRATCH 2-504, 2-533 CPU
SCRATCHP 2-504, 2-533 changing with DIRECT command 2-116
SHUTDOWN 2-64 Job Attributes Prompt screen 2-442
SPACE 2-506, 2-558 Job In Restart Status screen 2-448
SSCAN 1-17, 2-508 Job Predecessors Prompt screen 2-438
START 1-18, 2-67, 2-512 Job Restart Status Prompt screen 2-446
STOP 1-18, 2-69, 2-513 Job Status Prompt screen 2-430
SUBMIT 1-17, 2-515 Jobs Status screen 2-433
SUBSCH 1-17, 1-20, 2-517 Creating
SUBTM 1-16, 2-519 processing schedules for
SWAP 2-71 jobs scheduled on date/time basis 2-478
TIQ 2-521 workstation networks scheduled on date/time
TRIG 2-522 basis 2-478
UID 2-72 Critical Path Management (CPM)
UNC 2-523, 2-535 FLOWD command 2-137
UT 2-524 FLOWL command 2-138
VERIFY 1-16, 2-566 CTLG command 1-16, 2-101
WLB 2-73
WTO 2-75
XPOST 1-19, 2-568 D
XPRE 1-19, 2-571 DASD
XQ 1-16, 2-574 allocating with AL command 2-80
XQJ 1-16, 2-574 dislaying attributes with UT.15 2-556
XQM 1-16, 2-574 listing attributes with MAP command 2-403
XQN 1-16, 2-574 log files 2-71
XREF 2-578 Data set inquiries 1-14
XRQ 1-16, 2-579 Data sets
XRST 1-17, 2-580 CA-Librarian 2-290
XSPOST 1-19, 2-581 CA-Panvalet 2-290
XSPRE 1-20, 2-582 listing with LCTLG command 2-236
XUPD 1-16, 2-583 listing with LDSN command 2-242
XWLB 2-585 Database
Completion of workstation task 1-20, 2-305, 2-410 contents 1-14
Component status 1-13, 2-14 inquiry 1-14
CONN command 2-100, 2-541 DB command 2-106
Connect a Catalog screen 2-541 DB.1 screen 2-566
Connecting high-level index 2-100 DB.2.1 screen
Consolidate entries in catalog 1-16, 2-101 defining
Control statements calendar schedule criteria and base calendar 2-478
"#JCL" 2-214 DB.2.2 screen
"#JI" 2-214 defining
"#JO" 2-214 calendar schedule criteria and base calendar 2-478
"#VER" 2-566 DB.3.4 screen
"#XI" 2-214 and ADDRQ command 2-76
"#XO" 2-214 and output networks 2-207
Controlling job submission 1-17 DCONN command 2-108, 2-543
Controlling schedules 1-16 Deactivating corequisite resources 1-17, 2-424
COPY command 2-12 Deactivating workload balancing 2-73
Copying entries in catalog 2-101 DEALLOC command 2-109, 2-549
Deallocate Volume screen 2-549
Index X-5
DUMP command 2-27 Forecasting (continued)
Dynamic allocation 2-82 using FSTN command 2-180
worksheets 1-39
Forecasting job flow structures 1-36
E Format
ECHO command 2-28 3270-type terminal 1-13
Echo input data 1-13, 2-28, 2-30 blocks, RELINKing 2-15
Enhancements 1-1 of commands 2-1
Example commands, screens 2-1 FORMAT statement 2-17
Expediting job submission 1-16, 2-515 FPOST command 2-140
FPRE command 2-142
FQALL command 2-145
F FQJOB command 2-148
FALL command 2-125
FQPOST command 2-151
FETCH command 2-29
FQPRE command 2-153
FETCH function, QM.5 screen 1-17, 2-427
FQRES command 2-155
FETCHP function, QM.5 screen 2-452
FQSTN command 2-159
FIND command 2-129, 2-545
FQTAPE command 2-161
Find DSN on DASD screen 2-545
Freeing
Finding copies of data set 2-129
a resource 1-17
FJOB command 2-131
shared or exclusive resource 2-421
Flag rush job 1-17, 1-20, 2-501
FRES command 2-163
FLOWD command 2-137
FRJOB command 2-169
FLOWL command 2-138
FRQJOB command 2-175
Forcing
FSTN command 2-180
immediate scheduling of CPU job 1-16, 2-110
FSTRUC command 2-182
initiation of network 1-20, 2-499
FTAPE command 2-185
Forecast commands
Function Menu screen 2-405
See also Forecasting
FWLP command
FALL 2-125
format 2-188
FJOB 2-131
notes 2-192
FPOST 2-140
output 2-193
FPRE 2-142
FQALL 2-145
FQJOB 2-148 G
FQPOST 2-151 GDG
FQPRE 2-153 adding 2-104
FQRES 2-155 BLDG command 2-91
FQSTN 2-159 copying 2-105
FQTAPE 2-161 deleting 2-104
FRES 2-163 index 2-91
FRJOB 2-169 replacing 2-104
FRQJOB 2-175 UT.6 screen 2-537
FSTN 2-180 General
FSTRUC 2-182 operating commands 1-13, 2-1
FTAPE 2-185 status information 1-14, 2-216
Forecasting system commands 1-13
See also Forecast commands GRAPHc command 2-195
from the database 1-30 GROUP statement
options 1-23 using with /CLOSE 2-10
resources 1-37 GROUP statement, initialization file 2-10
using FJOB command 2-131
Index X-7
Listing (continued)
L preprocess queue 2-315
LACT command reminder information 1-15, 1-17, 2-385
database contents inquiry 1-14 resource requirements for job(s)
queue contents inquiry 1-14 in active queue 1-15, 2-223
syntax and examples 2-216 in database 1-14, 1-15, 2-288
LACTR command 1-15, 2-223 in queues 1-15, 2-344
LARF command 2-227 in queues or database 1-14, 1-15, 2-374
LARFQ command 2-233 in ready queue 1-15, 2-357
LCTLG command 1-14, 1-20, 2-236 in request queue 1-15, 2-370
LDSN command 1-14, 2-242 resources and connected jobs 1-17
LDTM command 2-247 schedule information 1-15, 1-20, 2-388
LIST command 1-17, 2-254 sequential data set records 1-14, 1-15, 2-242, 2-308
LISTDIR command 2-257, 2-554 user application data set information 1-14
Listing user profile 2-53, 2-56
active queue 2-216 workload balancing information 1-15
attributes of DASD data set 2-403 LJCK command 1-15, 2-259
base calendars 2-416 LJCL command 1-15, 2-262
catalog contents 2-304 LJES command 1-14, 2-264
completed LJOB command, syntax and examples 2-268
job information 1-14, 1-20, 2-376 LJOBR command 1-14, 1-15, 2-288
workstation network information 1-14, 1-20, 2-376 LLIB command 1-15, 2-290
data set LLOCK command 1-15, 2-292
elements which are locked 1-15, 2-292 LNTWK command
information 1-14, 2-236, 2-242 function 1-20
database information for application 1-14, 2-396 syntax and examples 2-296
JCL LOAD command
for job 1-15, 2-262 creating job profile data 2-300
information for job 2-259 LOAD process
job information usage considerations 2-302
from active queue 1-14, 2-216, 2-330 LOADH command 2-300
from CA-7 database 1-14, 2-268 LOC command 2-304, 2-564
from prior-run queue 1-14, 2-326 LOG command 2-33
from ready queue 1-14, 2-330, 2-348 Log data set 2-33
from request queue 1-14, 2-330, 2-361 Log data sets
from run log 1-14, 2-376 swapping 2-71
job priority information 1-15, 2-361 Log data sets, adding to 1-13
jobs waiting for restart 1-17, 2-254 Logging
member of in 1-20, 2-205
CA-LIBRARIAN data set 1-15, 2-290 out 1-20
CA-PANVALET data set 1-15, 2-290 Logical terminals 2-2
PDS 1-14, 2-308 LOGIN command
output network information and IN command 2-206
from CA-7 database 1-20, 2-296 and RSVP command 2-492
from postprocess queue 1-14, 1-19, 1-21 function 1-19
from preprocess queue 1-14, 1-19, 1-21 syntax and examples 2-305
from run log 1-20, 2-376 LOGOFF command
PDS logging off CA-7 2-34
directory information 2-257 return to VTAM 2-10
member names 2-257 LOGON command 2-35
Performance Management information 1-15, 2-399
postprocess queue 2-310
Index X-9
Notifying system that (continued) Personal Scheduling 2-425
job requirement satisfied 1-16, 2-412 PF key
manual verification requirement satisfied 1-16, 2-566 assignment 1-13, 2-51
preexecution requirement satisfied 1-16, 2-412 defaults 2-52
NXTCYC command 1-16, 2-408 listing 2-25
NXTMSG command 2-40 PFnn command 2-51
Placing job in request queue 1-16, 2-110
POST command 1-16, 2-412
O Posting ARF dispatcher with schedule scan 2-508
On-request scheduling 1-20 Posting satisfied job requirement 1-16, 2-412
Online Postprocess queue, listing 2-310
utility screens Postprocessing tasks 1-20
UT 2-524 Predecessor requirements
UT.1 2-526 dependency 2-489
UT.10 2-545 Preexecution requirements
UT.11 2-547 listing 2-348
UT.12 2-549 posting 1-16, 2-412
UT.13 2-551 Preprocess queue 2-315
UT.14 2-554 Preprocessing tasks 1-20
UT.15 2-556 Prev Station Not Complete comment 2-209
UT.16 2-558 Preventing submission of jobs 2-513, 2-514
UT.17 2-560 PRINT command 2-416
UT.18 2-562 Prior-run JCL report 2-420
UT.19 2-564 Prior-run queue
UT.2 2-529 listing with LPRRN command 2-326
UT.3 2-531 PRRNJCL command 2-420
UT.4 2-533 PRMP command 1-17, 1-20, 2-418
UT.5 2-535 Processing days, base calendar 2-416
UT.6 2-537 Producing month-by-month listing of base
UT.7 2-539 calendar(s) 2-416
UT.8 2-541 Production control 1-20
UT.9 2-543 PROF command 2-53
OPEN command 2-41 PROFS command 2-56
OPERID command 2-43 Programs
OPERIDS command 2-44 comma
OUT command 1-19, 1-20, 2-410 repeat symbol, use in 1-9
Output Networks Prompt screen 2-459 parentheses
syntax diagrams, use in 1-7
punctuation
P syntax diagrams, use in 1-6
PA key
SASSSLIW (LARF) 2-227
assignment 1-13, 2-49
SASSSLIY (LARFQ) 2-233
defaults 2-50
Prompt response 1-17, 1-20, 2-492
listing 2-25
Prompting commands 1-17, 1-20
PAGE command 2-47
PRRNJCL command 2-420
PAnn command 2-49
PRSCF command 1-17, 2-421
Parameters, APA graph 2-195
PRSQA command 1-17, 2-423
Parameters, keywords 2-1
PRSQD command 1-17, 2-424
Parentheses
PS command 2-425
syntax diagrams, use in 1-7
PS screen 2-425
Password 2-35
Index X-11
Reviewing SCRATCH command 2-504, 2-533
JCL in request or prior-run queues 1-17, 2-426 Scratch Dataset screen 2-533
schedule scan options 1-17, 2-508 Scratching DASD data set 2-504
RM command 2-488 SCRATCHP command 2-504, 2-533
ROLL field Screens
resolving schedules 2-478 sample of commands 2-1
RQMT command 2-489 Screens, sample 2-1
RQVER command 2-490 Search DASD volume(s) for copies 2-129
RSVP command 1-17, 1-20, 2-492 Security 2-35
RUN command 1-16 /LOGON command 2-35
controlling schedules 1-16 modifying operator 2-8
syntax and examples 2-495 Sending
RUNH command 1-16, 2-203, 2-495 displayed page 1-13, 2-13
controlling schedules 1-16 message to logical terminal 1-13, 2-37
syntax and examples 2-495 message to OS master console 2-75
RUNNW command 1-20, 2-499 SHUTDOWN command 2-64
RUSH command 1-17, 1-20, 2-501 Simultaneous log in and log out 2-211
SPACE command 2-506, 2-558
SSCAN command 1-17, 2-508
S SSCN field 2-336
Sample START command 1-18, 2-67, 2-512
screen results of commands 2-1 Start of workstation task 1-19, 2-305
Sample commands, screens 2-1 STOP command 1-18, 2-69, 2-513
SASSSLIW, LARF Command 2-227 Submission process, modify 1-17, 2-515
SASSSLIY, LARFQ Command 2-233 SUBMIT command 1-17, 2-515
Satisfying Submit time-of-day, modify 1-16, 2-519
JCL override requirement 1-16, 2-214 SUBSCH command 1-17, 1-20, 2-517
job requirements 1-16, 2-412 SUBTM command 1-16, 2-519
manual verification requirement 1-16, 2-566 Subtract from scheduled time 1-17, 1-20, 2-517
preexecution job requirement 1-16, 2-412 Summary of enhancements 1-1
SAVE command, text editor 2-214 Suspend
SCAL normal job flow 1-18, 2-513
parameter 2-480 prompting 1-17, 2-406, 2-492
SCAL parameter 2-480 SWAP command 2-71
SCHDMOD command 2-503 Syntax diagrams
Schedule reading (how to) 1-6—1-11
control commands 1-16, 1-20
immediate
job processing 1-16, 2-110 T
network processing 1-20, 2-119 Tape drive resource analysis 2-474
inquiries 1-15 Temporary JCL change commands 1-17, 2-426
job without verifying requirements or performing Terminals
updates 1-17, 2-495 closing 2-10
reminder messages 1-17, 1-20, 2-468 reassigning 2-2
Schedule scan TEST parameter 2-479
controlling schedules with SSCAN 1-17 Text editor 2-214
posting ARF dispatcher 2-508 TIQ command 2-521
SSCAN syntax and examples 2-508 Top line
Scheduling activities command format, APA 2-199
interrupting 1-17, 1-18, 2-203 commands 2-1
modifying 1-21, 2-203 graph commands 2-195
resuming 1-17, 1-21, 2-466
Index X-13
Workstation (continued)
network inquiries 1-15
tasks 1-19, 2-305, 2-410
Workstation network control
Writing data to log data set 1-13, 2-33
WTO command 2-75
X
XI statement 2-214
XO statement 2-214
XPOST command 1-19, 2-568
XPRE command 1-19, 1-20, 2-571
XQ command 1-16, 2-574
XQJ command 1-16, 2-574
XQM command 1-16, 2-574
XQN command 1-16, 2-574
XREF command 2-578
XRQ command 1-16, 2-579
XRST command 1-17, 2-580
XSPOST command 1-19, 1-20, 2-581
XSPRE command 1-19, 1-20, 2-582
XUPD command 1-16, 2-583
XWLB command 2-585
Y
YEAR parameter 2-481